1 . $Cambridge: exim/doc/doc-docbook/spec.xfpt,v 1.24 2007/08/29 13:37:28 ph10 Exp $
3 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
5 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
6 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
7 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
9 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
10 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
11 . unwanted vertical space.
12 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
19 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
25 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
26 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
28 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
33 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
34 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
35 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40 . This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
41 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
45 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
46 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing. Remember that
47 . the <bookinfo> element must also be updated for each new edition.
48 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
50 .set previousversion "4.67"
53 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
54 .set I " "
57 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
58 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
59 . provided in the xfpt library.
60 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
62 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name
64 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
66 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
67 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be roman.
69 .flag &!! "</emphasis>†<emphasis>"
70 .flag &!? "</emphasis>‡<emphasis>"
72 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
73 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
74 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
84 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
85 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
89 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
90 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
91 . --- the small number of other 2-column tables override it.
93 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
94 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
97 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
98 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
99 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
103 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
107 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
115 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
116 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
117 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
118 . --- ID that ties them together.
121 &<indexterm role="concept">&
122 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
124 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
130 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
131 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
133 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
139 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
143 &<indexterm role="option">&
144 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
146 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
152 &<indexterm role="variable">&
153 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
155 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
161 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
163 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
166 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
167 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for Ascii
169 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
173 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
174 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
175 <date>23 August 2007</date>
176 <author><firstname>Philip</firstname><surname>Hazel</surname></author>
177 <authorinitials>PH</authorinitials>
178 <affiliation><orgname>University of Cambridge Computing Service</orgname></affiliation>
179 <address>New Museums Site, Pembroke Street, Cambridge CB2 3QH, England</address>
180 <revhistory><revision>
181 <revnumber>4.68</revnumber>
182 <date>23 August 2007</date>
183 <authorinitials>PH</authorinitials>
184 </revision></revhistory>
185 <copyright><year>2007</year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
190 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
191 . This chunk of literal XML implements index entries of the form "x, see y" and
192 . "x, see also y". However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
193 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
194 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
196 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
199 <indexterm role="variable">
200 <primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
201 <see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
203 <indexterm role="concept">
204 <primary>address</primary>
205 <secondary>rewriting</secondary>
206 <see><emphasis>rewriting</emphasis></see>
208 <indexterm role="concept">
209 <primary>Bounce Address Tag Validation</primary>
210 <see><emphasis>BATV</emphasis></see>
212 <indexterm role="concept">
213 <primary>Client SMTP Authorization</primary>
214 <see><emphasis>CSA</emphasis></see>
216 <indexterm role="concept">
217 <primary>CR character</primary>
218 <see><emphasis>carriage return</emphasis></see>
220 <indexterm role="concept">
221 <primary>CRL</primary>
222 <see><emphasis>certificate revocation list</emphasis></see>
224 <indexterm role="concept">
225 <primary>delivery</primary>
226 <secondary>failure report</secondary>
227 <see><emphasis>bounce message</emphasis></see>
229 <indexterm role="concept">
230 <primary>dialup</primary>
231 <see><emphasis>intermittently connected hosts</emphasis></see>
233 <indexterm role="concept">
234 <primary>exiscan</primary>
235 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
237 <indexterm role="concept">
238 <primary>failover</primary>
239 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
241 <indexterm role="concept">
242 <primary>fallover</primary>
243 <see><emphasis>fallback</emphasis></see>
245 <indexterm role="concept">
246 <primary>filter</primary>
247 <secondary>Sieve</secondary>
248 <see><emphasis>Sieve filter</emphasis></see>
250 <indexterm role="concept">
251 <primary>ident</primary>
252 <see><emphasis>RFC 1413</emphasis></see>
254 <indexterm role="concept">
255 <primary>LF character</primary>
256 <see><emphasis>linefeed</emphasis></see>
258 <indexterm role="concept">
259 <primary>maximum</primary>
260 <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
262 <indexterm role="concept">
263 <primary>monitor</primary>
264 <see><emphasis>Exim monitor</emphasis></see>
266 <indexterm role="concept">
267 <primary>no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis></primary>
268 <see>entry for xxx</see>
270 <indexterm role="concept">
271 <primary>NUL</primary>
272 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
274 <indexterm role="concept">
275 <primary>passwd file</primary>
276 <see><emphasis>/etc/passwd</emphasis></see>
278 <indexterm role="concept">
279 <primary>process id</primary>
280 <see><emphasis>pid</emphasis></see>
282 <indexterm role="concept">
283 <primary>RBL</primary>
284 <see><emphasis>DNS list</emphasis></see>
286 <indexterm role="concept">
287 <primary>redirection</primary>
288 <see><emphasis>address redirection</emphasis></see>
290 <indexterm role="concept">
291 <primary>return path</primary>
292 <seealso><emphasis>envelope sender</emphasis></seealso>
294 <indexterm role="concept">
295 <primary>scanning</primary>
296 <see><emphasis>content scanning</emphasis></see>
298 <indexterm role="concept">
299 <primary>SSL</primary>
300 <see><emphasis>TLS</emphasis></see>
302 <indexterm role="concept">
303 <primary>string</primary>
304 <secondary>expansion</secondary>
305 <see><emphasis>expansion</emphasis></see>
307 <indexterm role="concept">
308 <primary>top bit</primary>
309 <see><emphasis>8-bit characters</emphasis></see>
311 <indexterm role="concept">
312 <primary>variables</primary>
313 <see><emphasis>expansion, variables</emphasis></see>
315 <indexterm role="concept">
316 <primary>zero, binary</primary>
317 <see><emphasis>binary zero</emphasis></see>
323 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
324 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
325 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
326 . chapter "Introduction"
327 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
329 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
330 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
331 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
332 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
334 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
335 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
336 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
337 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
338 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and Unixware.
339 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
340 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
342 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
343 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
344 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
346 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
347 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
348 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
350 The use, supply or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
351 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of the program,
352 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
353 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
354 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
356 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
357 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
358 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
359 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
360 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
362 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
363 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
364 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
365 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
369 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
371 .cindex "documentation"
372 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version; of Exim.
373 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
374 renditions of the document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
375 capable of showing a change indicator.
378 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
379 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
380 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
381 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
382 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
383 Furthermore, the manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
384 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
387 .cindex "books about Exim"
388 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
389 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
390 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
391 (&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
393 This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
394 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
395 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
396 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
398 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
399 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
400 Debian-specific features in the file
401 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
402 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
405 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
406 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
408 As the program develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
409 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
410 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
411 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
412 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
414 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
415 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
416 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
417 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
419 All changes to the program (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
420 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
422 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
423 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
424 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
428 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
429 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
430 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
431 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
432 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
433 .row &_pcrepattern.txt_& "specification of PCRE regular expressions"
434 .row &_pcretest.txt_& "specification of the PCRE testing program"
435 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
436 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
439 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
440 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
441 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
445 .section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
448 The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
449 Cambridge's FTP site, whose contents are described in &'Where to find the Exim
450 distribution'& below. In addition, there is a web site and an FTP site at
451 &%exim.org%&. These are now also hosted at the University of Cambridge. The
452 &%exim.org%& site was previously hosted for a number of years by Energis
453 Squared, formerly Planet Online Ltd, whose support I gratefully acknowledge.
457 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
458 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
459 online information is the Exim wiki &new("(&url(http://wiki.exim.org))"),
460 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
461 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
464 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &new("&url(http://bugs.exim.org)"). You can use
465 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
466 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
470 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
471 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
472 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
475 .row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
476 .row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
477 .row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
478 .row &'exim-future@exim.org'& "Discussion of long-term development"
481 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
482 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
483 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
484 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
485 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
488 &url(http://lists.alioth.debian.org/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
490 Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
493 .section "Exim training" "SECID4"
495 .cindex "training courses"
496 Training courses in Cambridge (UK) used to be run annually by the author of
497 Exim, before he retired. At the time of writing, there are no plans to run
498 further Exim courses in Cambridge. However, if that changes, relevant
499 information will be posted at &url(http://www-tus.csx.cam.ac.uk/courses/exim/).
502 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
503 .cindex "bug reports"
504 .cindex "reporting bugs"
505 Reports of obvious bugs &new("can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
506 via the Bugzilla (&url(http://bugs.exim.org)).") However, if you are unsure
507 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
508 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
512 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
514 .cindex "distribution" "ftp site"
515 The master ftp site for the Exim distribution is
517 &*ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/email/exim*&
521 &*ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim*&
523 The file references that follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at
524 these sites. There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
525 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
527 Within the &_exim_& directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
528 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
529 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
530 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
533 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
535 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The two
536 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
537 The &_.bz2_& file is usually a lot smaller than the &_.gz_& file.
539 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
540 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
541 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
542 The distributions are currently signed with Philip Hazel's GPG key. The
543 corresponding public key is available from a number of keyservers, and there is
544 also a copy in the file &_Public-Key_&. The signatures for the tar bundles are
547 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.sig_&
548 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.sig_&
550 For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
551 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
552 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
554 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
555 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
556 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
557 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
559 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
560 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
561 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
562 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
564 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
565 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
568 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
570 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
571 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
572 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
573 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
574 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
575 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
576 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
578 .cindex "domainless addresses"
579 .cindex "address" "without domain"
580 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
581 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
582 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
583 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
586 .cindex "transport" "external"
587 .cindex "external transports"
588 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
589 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
590 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
591 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
592 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
593 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
595 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
596 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
597 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
600 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
601 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
602 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
603 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
604 a number of common scanners are provided.
608 .section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
609 Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
610 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
611 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
612 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
613 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
616 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
617 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
618 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
619 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
620 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
621 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
622 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
623 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages on the queue) do so in Exim's own
624 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
625 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
626 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
627 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
629 Control of messages on the queue can be done via certain privileged command
630 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
631 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
632 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
636 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
637 .cindex "terminology definitions"
638 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
639 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
640 It is the last part of a message, and is separated from the &'header'& (see
641 below) by a blank line.
643 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
644 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
645 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
646 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
647 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
648 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
649 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
650 rise to further bounce messages.
652 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
653 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
654 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
657 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
658 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
659 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
662 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
663 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
664 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
666 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
667 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
668 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
669 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
670 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
671 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
672 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
673 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
675 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
676 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
677 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
678 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
679 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
680 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
683 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
684 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
685 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to that
686 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
687 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
689 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
690 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
691 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
692 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
693 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
694 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
696 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
697 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
700 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
701 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery,
702 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
703 Exim's case the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
704 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
706 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
707 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
708 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
709 is used by other MTAs, and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
710 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
712 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
713 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
714 messages on its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
715 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
716 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
717 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
724 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
725 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
727 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
728 .cindex "incorporated code"
729 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
731 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
734 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the Exim
735 monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright ©
736 University of Cambridge. The source is distributed in the directory
737 &_src/pcre_&. However, this is a cut-down version of PCRE. If you want to use
738 the PCRE library in other programs, you should obtain and install the full
739 version of the library from
740 &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
742 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
743 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
744 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
745 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
746 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
747 following statements:
750 Copyright © 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
752 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
753 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
754 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
756 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
757 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
758 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
759 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
760 restrictions applied to it).
763 .cindex "SPA authentication"
764 .cindex "Samba project"
765 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
766 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
767 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
768 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
772 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
773 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
774 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
775 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
776 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
777 conditions expressed therein.
780 Copyright © 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
782 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
783 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
787 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
788 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
790 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
791 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
792 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
795 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
796 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
797 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
798 details, please contact
800 Office of Technology Transfer
801 Carnegie Mellon University
803 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
804 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
805 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
808 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
811 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
812 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(http://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
814 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
815 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
816 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
817 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
818 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
819 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
820 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
825 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
828 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
829 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
830 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
831 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
834 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
835 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
839 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
840 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
841 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
842 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
843 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
844 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
845 software without specific, written prior permission.
847 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
848 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
849 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
850 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
851 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
852 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
857 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
858 not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
859 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
866 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
867 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
869 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
870 "Receiving and delivering mail"
873 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
874 .cindex "design philosophy"
875 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
876 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
877 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
878 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
879 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
880 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
883 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
884 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
885 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
886 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
887 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
888 unsolicited junk, and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
889 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
892 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
893 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
894 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
895 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
896 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
897 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
898 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
899 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
900 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
903 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
904 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
906 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
907 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
908 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
909 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
911 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
912 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
913 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
914 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
915 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
917 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
918 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
919 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
921 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
922 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
923 runs at the start of every delivery process.
928 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
929 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
930 .cindex "Sieve filter"
931 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
932 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
933 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
934 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
935 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
936 of filtering are available:
939 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
942 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
943 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
946 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
950 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
951 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
952 .cindex "format" "of message id"
953 .cindex "id of message"
958 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is sixteen
959 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
960 example &`16VDhn-0001bo-D3`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
961 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
962 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
963 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
964 id is used to construct file names, and the names of files in those systems are
965 not always case-sensitive.
967 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
968 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
969 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
970 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
971 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
972 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
976 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
977 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
978 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
979 way of representing the date and time of day).
981 After the first hyphen, the next six characters are the id of the process that
982 received the message.
984 There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
986 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
987 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
988 time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
989 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
990 systems), the units are 1/1000 of a second.
992 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by 200 (100) and added to
993 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 1/200
998 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
999 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1000 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1001 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1002 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1005 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1006 .cindex "receiving mail"
1007 .cindex "message" "reception"
1008 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1009 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1010 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1011 there are several possibilities:
1014 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1015 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1016 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1018 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1019 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1020 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1021 command. This is so-called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1022 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1023 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1025 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1026 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1027 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1028 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1029 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1031 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1032 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1033 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1034 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1038 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1039 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1040 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1041 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1042 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1043 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1044 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1045 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender address
1046 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1047 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1048 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1049 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1050 users to change sender addresses.
1052 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1053 checking by the non-SMTP ACL, if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1054 (either over TCP/IP, or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1055 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1056 individual recipients, or the entire message, can be rejected if local policy
1057 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1058 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1060 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1061 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1062 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1063 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1064 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1065 message is received.
1071 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1072 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1073 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1074 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1075 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1076 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1077 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1078 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1080 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1081 By default all these message files are held in a single directory called
1082 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1083 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1084 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1085 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1086 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1087 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1088 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1089 affect file system performance.
1091 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1092 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1093 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1094 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1095 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1097 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1098 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1099 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1100 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1101 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1102 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1103 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1104 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1105 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1106 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1107 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1108 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1112 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1113 .cindex "message" "life of"
1114 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1115 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1116 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1117 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1118 cannot proceed &-- for example, when a message can neither be delivered to its
1119 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1120 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1122 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1123 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1124 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1125 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1126 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1129 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1130 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1131 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1132 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1133 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
1135 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1136 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1137 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1138 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1139 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1140 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1141 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator, and are normally
1142 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1143 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1144 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1147 .cindex "journal file"
1148 .cindex "file" "journal"
1149 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1150 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1151 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1152 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1153 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1154 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1155 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1156 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1158 Should the system or the program crash after a successful delivery but before
1159 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1160 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1161 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1162 deliveries caused by crashes.
1166 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1167 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1168 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1169 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1170 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1171 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1172 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1173 specify which ones are included in the binary. Run time options specify which
1174 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1176 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1177 Each driver that is specified in the run time configuration is an &'instance'&
1178 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1179 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1180 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1181 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1182 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1183 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1184 the driver's features in general.
1186 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1187 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1188 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1189 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1192 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1193 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1194 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1195 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1196 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1197 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1199 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1200 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1201 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1202 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1203 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1204 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1206 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1207 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1208 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1211 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1212 addresses in domains that are not recognized specially by the local host. These
1213 are typically addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1214 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1215 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1216 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1217 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1218 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1219 configured to fail the address.
1221 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1222 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1223 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1224 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1225 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1226 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1228 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1229 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1230 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1231 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1232 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1233 the address is bounced.
1237 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1238 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1239 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1240 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1241 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1242 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1243 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1244 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1246 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1247 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1248 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1249 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1250 sends all messages to a message-scanning program, unless they have been
1251 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1252 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1253 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1258 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1259 .cindex "router" "running details"
1260 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1261 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1262 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1263 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1264 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1265 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1269 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1270 transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1271 original address ceases,
1272 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1273 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1274 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1275 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1276 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1279 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1280 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1281 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1282 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1283 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1285 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1286 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default the address
1287 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1288 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1289 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1291 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1292 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1293 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1294 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1295 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1297 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1298 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1299 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1301 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1302 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1303 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1304 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1306 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1307 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1310 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1311 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1312 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1313 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1314 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1316 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1317 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1318 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1319 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1320 facility for this purpose.
1323 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1324 .cindex "case of local parts"
1325 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1326 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1327 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1328 and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1329 check, local parts are treated as case-sensitive. This happens only when
1330 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1331 routed addresses are shown.
1335 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1336 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1337 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1338 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1339 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1340 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1343 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1344 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1345 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1346 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1347 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1348 of any other conditions.
1350 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1351 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1352 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1354 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1355 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1356 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1357 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1359 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1360 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1361 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1362 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1363 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1365 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1366 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1368 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1369 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1371 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1372 of domains that it defines.
1374 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1375 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1376 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1377 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1378 the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1379 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1380 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1381 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1382 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
1383 &$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
1385 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1386 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1388 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1389 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1390 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1391 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1392 remaining preconditions.
1394 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1395 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1396 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1397 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1398 could lead to confusion.
1400 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1401 set of addresses that it defines.
1403 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1404 specified files is tested.
1406 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1407 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1408 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1409 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1413 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1414 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1415 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1416 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1417 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1418 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1419 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1423 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1424 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1425 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1428 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1429 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1430 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1431 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1432 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1434 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1435 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1437 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1438 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1439 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1440 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1441 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1442 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1445 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router in turn, subject to
1446 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1447 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1448 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1449 processed entirely independently of each other.
1451 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1452 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1453 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1454 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1455 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1456 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1457 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1458 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1459 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1461 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1462 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1463 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1464 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1465 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1466 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1467 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1468 addresses to the same domain.
1470 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1471 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1472 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1473 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1474 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1475 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1476 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1477 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1479 .cindex "queue runner"
1480 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1481 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1482 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1483 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1484 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1485 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1486 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1487 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1488 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1490 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1491 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1492 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1493 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1494 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1495 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1497 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1498 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1499 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1500 messages to other addresses.
1502 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1503 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1504 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1507 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1508 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1509 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1515 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1516 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1517 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1518 .cindex "queue runner"
1519 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1520 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1521 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1522 intervals, or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1523 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1524 first attempt will remain on your queue for ever. A queue runner process works
1525 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1526 passed its retry time.
1527 You can run several queue runners at once.
1529 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1530 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1531 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1532 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1533 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1538 .section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
1539 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1540 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1541 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1542 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1543 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1544 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1545 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1546 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1549 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1550 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1551 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1554 .cindex "hints database"
1555 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1556 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1557 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1558 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1564 .section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
1565 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1566 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1567 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1568 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1569 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1570 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1571 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1572 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1573 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1574 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1576 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1577 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1578 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1581 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1582 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1583 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1584 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1585 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1586 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1587 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1592 .section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
1593 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1594 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1595 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
1596 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1597 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1598 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1599 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1605 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1606 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1608 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1609 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1611 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1612 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1613 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1614 &_exim-&version;_&) into which the following files are placed:
1617 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1618 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1620 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1621 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1622 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1623 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1627 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1628 following subdirectories are created:
1631 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1632 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1633 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1634 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1635 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1636 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1637 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1640 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
1641 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1642 that may be useful to some sites.
1645 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1646 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1647 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1648 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1649 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1650 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1652 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1653 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1654 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1655 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1656 overridden if necessary.
1659 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1660 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1661 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1662 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1663 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1664 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1665 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1667 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1668 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1669 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1670 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1671 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1672 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1673 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1674 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1676 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1677 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1678 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1679 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1680 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1681 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1682 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1683 Berkeley DB library.
1685 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1686 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1690 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1691 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1693 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1694 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1695 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1696 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1697 file name is used unmodified.
1699 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1700 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1701 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1702 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1704 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1705 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1706 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1708 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1709 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1710 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while, but the latest versions are now
1711 numbered 4.&'x'&. Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased. All
1712 versions of Berkeley DB can be obtained from
1713 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/).
1715 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1716 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1717 &url(http://download.sourceforge.net/tdb). It has its own interface, and also
1718 operates on a single file.
1722 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1723 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1724 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1725 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1726 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1730 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, and for tdb you set USE_TDB. An
1731 error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1733 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1734 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1735 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1736 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1737 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1738 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1740 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1741 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1742 in one of these lines:
1747 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1748 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1749 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1750 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1753 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1754 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1756 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1757 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1761 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1762 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1763 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1764 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1765 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1766 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1767 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1768 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1769 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1770 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1771 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1772 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1774 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1775 without them. They are the location of the run time configuration file
1776 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1777 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1778 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1779 a colon-separated list of file names; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1781 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1782 at run time, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1783 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1784 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1785 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at run time, so that errors
1786 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1789 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1790 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1791 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1792 facilities, you need to set
1794 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1796 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1797 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1800 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1801 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1802 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1803 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1804 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1805 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1806 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1808 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1809 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1810 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1811 configuration files, for example to change the name of the C compiler, which
1812 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1817 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1818 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1820 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1821 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1822 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1823 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1824 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1825 (default ISO-8859-1). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1826 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1828 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1829 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1830 &url(http://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1831 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1832 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1836 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1840 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1841 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1842 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1843 .cindex "SUPPORT_TLS"
1844 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1845 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1846 Exim can be built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1847 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support legacy clients that expect to
1848 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1849 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1852 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1853 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1856 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1859 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1861 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1862 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1865 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1866 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1868 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1869 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1873 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1875 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1876 library and include files. For example:
1880 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1881 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
1883 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
1884 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
1885 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
1890 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
1891 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
1892 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
1893 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
1894 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
1895 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
1896 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
1897 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
1898 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
1899 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
1900 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
1903 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
1904 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
1905 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
1907 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control files is
1908 &"exim"&. For example, the line
1910 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
1912 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
1913 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
1914 All other connections are denied. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
1919 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
1920 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
1921 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
1922 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
1923 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
1924 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
1927 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
1928 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
1929 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
1930 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
1931 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&. It is not known
1932 if anyone is actually using A6 records. Exim has support for A6 records, but
1933 this is included only if you set &`SUPPORT_A6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
1934 support has not been tested for some time.
1938 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
1939 .cindex "build directory"
1940 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
1941 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
1942 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
1943 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
1944 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
1945 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
1946 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
1948 &*Warning*&: The &%-j%& (parallel) flag must not be used with &'make'&; the
1949 building process fails if it is set.
1951 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
1952 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
1953 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
1954 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
1955 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
1956 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
1957 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
1958 directory, should this ever be necessary.
1960 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
1961 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
1962 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
1966 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
1967 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
1968 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
1969 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
1970 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
1971 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
1972 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
1976 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
1977 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
1978 given in addition to the short output.
1982 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
1983 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
1984 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
1985 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
1986 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
1987 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
1988 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
1991 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
1992 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
1994 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
1995 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
1996 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
1997 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
1999 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2000 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2001 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2002 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2003 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2004 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2005 and are often not needed.
2007 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2008 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2009 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2010 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2011 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2012 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2013 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2014 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2015 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2018 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2019 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2020 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2021 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2025 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2026 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2027 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2028 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2029 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2030 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2031 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2032 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2033 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2034 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2035 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2036 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2037 containing the lines
2042 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2043 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2045 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2046 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2047 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2050 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2051 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2052 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2053 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2054 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2055 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2056 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2057 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2058 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2059 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2065 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2066 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2067 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2068 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2069 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2070 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2071 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2072 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause run time configuration
2075 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2076 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2077 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2081 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2082 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2084 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2085 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2086 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2087 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2088 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2089 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2092 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2093 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2095 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2096 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2099 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2100 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2102 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2103 definition of all three of these variables into your
2104 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2107 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2108 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2109 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2110 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2112 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2113 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2114 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2115 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2116 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2119 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2120 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2121 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2122 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2123 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2126 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2128 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2129 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2130 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2131 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2132 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2133 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2137 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2138 .cindex "building Eximon"
2139 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2140 where the files that are involved are
2142 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2143 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2144 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2145 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2146 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2147 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2149 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2150 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2151 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2152 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2153 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2154 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2155 LOG_DEPTH at run time.
2159 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2160 .cindex "installing Exim"
2161 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2162 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2163 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2164 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2165 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2166 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2167 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2168 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2169 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2170 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2171 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2172 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2174 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2175 Exim's run time configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2176 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2177 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2178 by the installation script. If a run time configuration file already exists, it
2179 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2180 alternative files, no default is installed.
2182 .cindex "system aliases file"
2183 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2184 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2185 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2186 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2187 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2188 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2189 and outputs a comment to the user.
2191 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2192 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2193 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2194 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2195 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2197 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2198 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2199 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2200 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2201 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2204 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2205 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2208 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2210 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2211 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2212 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2213 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2214 but this usage is deprecated.
2216 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2217 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2218 &'convert4r4'&, or the &'pcretest'& test program. You will probably run the
2219 first of these only once (if you are upgrading from Exim 3), and the second
2220 isn't really part of Exim. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2221 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2222 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2224 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2225 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2226 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2227 for example &_exim-&version;-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2228 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2229 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2230 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2232 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2233 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2234 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2237 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2239 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2240 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2241 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2242 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2245 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2247 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2248 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2251 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2252 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2254 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2258 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2260 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2262 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2263 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2264 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2266 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2271 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2272 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2273 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2274 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2275 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the ftp site (see section
2278 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2279 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2280 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2284 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2285 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2286 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2287 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2288 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2294 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2295 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2296 Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
2297 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2298 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2302 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2303 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2304 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2305 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2306 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2309 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2311 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2313 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2315 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2316 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2317 user agent. For example:
2319 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2320 From: user@your.domain.example
2321 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2322 Subject: Testing Exim
2324 This is a test message.
2327 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2328 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2329 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2331 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2332 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2333 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2334 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2335 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2336 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2338 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2340 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2341 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2342 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2343 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2344 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2346 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2347 .cindex "lock files"
2348 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2349 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2350 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2351 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2352 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2353 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2354 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2355 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2356 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2357 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2358 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2359 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2361 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2362 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2363 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2364 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2365 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2368 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2369 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2370 within the run time configuration, all other file and directory names
2371 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2375 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2376 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2377 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2378 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2379 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2380 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2381 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2382 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2383 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2384 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2385 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2386 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2387 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2389 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2390 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2391 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2392 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2393 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2394 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2397 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2398 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2399 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2400 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2402 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2403 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2404 favourite user agent.
2406 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2407 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2408 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2409 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2410 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2411 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2415 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2416 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2417 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2418 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2419 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2420 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2421 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2422 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2428 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2429 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2430 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2432 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2434 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2435 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2436 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2437 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2438 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2440 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2442 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2444 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2445 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2446 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2451 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2452 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2454 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2455 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2456 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2457 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2458 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2459 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2460 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2461 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2462 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2465 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2467 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2468 were present before any other options.
2469 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2471 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2472 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2473 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2476 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2477 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2478 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2482 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2483 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2484 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2487 .cindex "queue runner"
2488 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2489 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2490 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2492 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2493 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2494 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2495 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2496 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2497 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2498 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2499 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2502 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2503 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2504 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2505 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2506 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2507 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2510 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2511 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2512 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2513 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2514 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2515 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2517 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2518 .cindex "envelope sender"
2519 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2520 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2521 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2522 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2523 users to set envelope senders.
2525 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
2526 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
2527 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2528 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2529 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2531 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2532 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2533 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2534 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2535 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2536 that are available to trusted users.
2538 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2539 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2540 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2541 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2542 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2544 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2545 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2546 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2547 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2549 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2550 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2551 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2552 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2554 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2555 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2560 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2561 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2562 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2568 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2569 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2570 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2571 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2572 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2573 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2574 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2575 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2577 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2578 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2579 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2580 . creates a man page for the options.
2581 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2584 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2591 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2592 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2593 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2594 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2597 .oindex "&%--help%&"
2598 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2599 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2602 .vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
2604 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2605 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2606 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2607 clean; it ignores this option.
2612 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2613 .cindex "queue runner"
2614 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2615 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2616 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2618 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2619 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2620 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2621 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2623 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2624 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2625 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2626 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2628 When a listening daemon
2629 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2630 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2631 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2632 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2633 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2634 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2637 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2638 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2639 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2643 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2644 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2645 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2646 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2647 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2648 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2649 because these are reread each time they are used.
2653 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2654 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2658 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2659 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2660 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2661 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2662 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2663 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2665 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2666 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2667 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2668 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2669 test data. A line history is supported.
2671 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2672 continuations. As in Exim's run time configuration, white space at the start of
2673 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2674 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2675 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2676 message-specific values (such as &$sender_domain$&) are set, because no message
2677 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2679 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2680 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2681 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2682 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2684 .vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
2686 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2687 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2688 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2689 of a file. For example:
2691 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2693 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2694 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2695 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2696 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2697 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2698 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2699 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2702 .vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
2704 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2705 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2706 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2707 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2708 system filters are recognized.
2710 .vitem &%-bf%&&~<&'filename'&>
2712 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2713 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2714 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2715 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2716 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2717 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2718 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2719 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2722 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2723 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2724 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2726 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2728 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2729 variables that are used by the user filter.
2731 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2736 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2737 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2738 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2741 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2742 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2743 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2744 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2746 When testing a filter file,
2747 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2748 .cindex "envelope sender"
2749 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2750 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2751 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2752 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2753 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2756 .vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
2758 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2759 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2760 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2763 .vitem &%-bfl%&&~<&'local&~part'&>
2765 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2766 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
2767 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
2768 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
2769 actually being delivered.
2771 .vitem &%-bfp%&&~<&'prefix'&>
2773 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2774 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2777 .vitem &%-bfs%&&~<&'suffix'&>
2779 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
2780 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
2783 .vitem &%-bh%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2785 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
2786 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
2787 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
2788 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
2789 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
2790 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
2791 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
2792 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
2793 after a full stop. For example:
2795 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
2796 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
2798 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
2799 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
2800 conversion to the canonical form is
2801 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
2803 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
2804 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
2805 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
2806 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
2807 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
2811 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
2812 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
2813 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
2816 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
2817 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
2818 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
2820 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
2821 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
2822 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
2823 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
2824 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
2825 session were authenticated.
2827 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
2828 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
2829 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
2831 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
2832 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
2833 specialized SMTP test program such as
2834 &url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
2836 .vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
2838 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
2839 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
2840 updating the callout cache database.
2844 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2845 .cindex "building alias file"
2846 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
2847 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
2848 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
2849 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
2850 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
2853 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
2854 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
2855 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
2856 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
2857 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
2858 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
2863 .cindex "local message reception"
2864 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
2865 locally-generated message on the current input. The recipients are given as the
2866 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
2867 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
2868 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
2869 if no other conflicting option is present.
2871 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
2872 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
2873 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
2874 suppressing this for special cases.
2876 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
2877 the non-SMTP ACL. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details.
2879 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
2880 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
2881 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
2884 .cindex "message" "format"
2885 .cindex "format" "message"
2886 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2887 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
2888 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
2889 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
2890 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
2892 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
2893 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
2895 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
2896 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
2897 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
2898 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
2899 option, which can be changed if necessary.
2901 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
2902 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
2903 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
2904 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
2905 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
2909 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
2910 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
2911 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
2912 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
2913 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
2914 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
2915 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
2917 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
2918 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
2919 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
2920 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
2921 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
2923 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
2924 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
2925 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
2926 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
2931 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
2932 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
2933 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
2934 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
2935 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
2936 arguments, for example:
2938 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
2940 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
2941 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
2942 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
2943 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
2944 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
2945 users, the output is as in this example:
2947 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
2949 If &%configure_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the run time
2950 configuration file is output.
2951 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
2952 is the name of the file that was actually used.
2954 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2955 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2956 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
2957 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
2958 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
2959 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
2960 written directly into the spool directory.
2962 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
2964 exim -bP +local_domains
2966 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
2967 local part) and outputs what it finds.
2969 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
2970 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
2971 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
2972 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
2973 that driver are output. For example:
2975 exim -bP transport local_delivery
2977 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
2978 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
2979 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
2980 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
2981 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
2987 .cindex "queue" "listing messages on"
2988 .cindex "listing" "messages on the queue"
2989 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2990 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
2991 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
2992 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
2993 to allow any user to see the queue.
2995 Each message on the queue is displayed as in the following example:
2997 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
2998 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3001 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3002 .cindex "size" "of message"
3003 The first line contains the length of time the message has been on the queue
3004 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3005 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3006 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3007 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3008 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3009 before the sender address.
3011 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3012 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3013 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3015 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3016 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3017 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3018 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3019 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3025 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3026 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3027 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3033 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3034 This option counts the number of messages on the queue, and writes the total
3035 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3036 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3041 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3042 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3043 lots of messages on the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3044 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3048 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3052 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3057 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3058 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3059 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3060 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3065 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3066 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3067 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3068 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3069 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3071 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3072 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3074 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3075 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3076 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3077 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3078 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3079 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3080 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3081 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3082 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3084 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3085 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3090 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3091 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3092 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3093 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3094 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3095 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3096 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3100 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3101 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3102 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3103 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3104 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3105 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3106 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3107 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3108 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3110 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3111 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3112 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3114 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3115 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&).
3116 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3117 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3119 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3120 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3121 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3123 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3124 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3125 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3126 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3127 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3129 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3130 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3134 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3135 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3136 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3137 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3138 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3139 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3140 messages to the MTA.
3143 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3144 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3145 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3146 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3147 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3148 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3149 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3153 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3154 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3155 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3156 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3157 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3158 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3159 the listening daemon.
3163 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3164 .cindex "address" "testing"
3165 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3166 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3167 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3168 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3169 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3171 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3172 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3174 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3175 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3178 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3179 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3180 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3181 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3182 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3185 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3186 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3187 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3188 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3190 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3191 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3192 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3193 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3196 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3197 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3199 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3200 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3201 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3202 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3203 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3204 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3209 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3210 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3211 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3212 It also lists the DBM library this is being used, the optional modules (such as
3213 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3214 name of the run time configuration file that is in use.
3216 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3217 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3218 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3219 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3220 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3221 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3222 dynamic testing facilities.
3226 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3227 .cindex "address" "verification"
3228 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3229 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3230 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3231 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3232 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3233 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3235 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3236 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3237 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3239 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3240 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3242 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3243 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3246 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3247 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3248 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3249 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3250 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3252 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3253 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3254 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3255 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3256 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3257 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3260 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3261 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3262 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3265 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3266 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3267 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3268 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3270 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3271 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3272 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3273 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3277 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3278 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3281 .vitem &%-C%&&~<&'filelist'&>
3283 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3284 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3285 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3286 This option causes Exim to find the run time configuration file from the given
3287 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3288 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single file
3289 name, but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3290 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3291 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3293 When this option is used by a caller other than root or the Exim user, and the
3294 list is different from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege
3295 immediately, and runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of
3296 the caller. However, if ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY is defined in
3297 &_Local/Makefile_&, root privilege is retained for &%-C%& only if the caller of
3300 That is, the Exim user is no longer privileged in this regard. This build-time
3301 option is not set by default in the Exim source distribution tarbundle.
3302 However, if you are using a &"packaged"& version of Exim (source or binary),
3303 the packagers might have enabled it.
3305 Setting ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY locks out the possibility of testing a
3306 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery, even
3307 if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is running
3308 as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the delivery,
3309 the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception
3310 and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message on the queue,
3311 using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3313 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3314 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3315 must start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3316 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3317 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3318 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3319 unset, any file name can be used with &%-C%&.
3321 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3322 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3323 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3326 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3327 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3328 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3329 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3330 specified by this option.
3332 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3334 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3335 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3336 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3337 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3338 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3339 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3341 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3342 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3343 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3349 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3350 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3353 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3355 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3357 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3359 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3360 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3361 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3362 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3363 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3364 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3365 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3368 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3369 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3370 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3371 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3372 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3373 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3374 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3377 &`acl `& ACL interpretation
3378 &`auth `& authenticators
3379 &`deliver `& general delivery logic
3380 &`dns `& DNS lookups (see also resolver)
3381 &`dnsbl `& DNS black list (aka RBL) code
3382 &`exec `& arguments for &[execv()]& calls
3383 &`expand `& detailed debugging for string expansions
3384 &`filter `& filter handling
3385 &`hints_lookup `& hints data lookups
3386 &`host_lookup `& all types of name-to-IP address handling
3387 &`ident `& ident lookup
3388 &`interface `& lists of local interfaces
3389 &`lists `& matching things in lists
3390 &`load `& system load checks
3391 &`local_scan `& can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3392 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)
3393 &`lookup `& general lookup code and all lookups
3394 &`memory `& memory handling
3395 &`pid `& add pid to debug output lines
3396 &`process_info `& setting info for the process log
3397 &`queue_run `& queue runs
3398 &`receive `& general message reception logic
3399 &`resolver `& turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output
3400 &`retry `& retry handling
3401 &`rewrite `& address rewriting
3402 &`route `& address routing
3403 &`timestamp `& add timestamp to debug output lines
3405 &`transport `& transports
3406 &`uid `& changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid
3407 &`verify `& address verification logic
3408 &`all `& almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&
3410 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3411 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3412 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3413 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3414 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3415 turn everything off.
3417 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3418 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3419 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3420 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3421 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3424 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3425 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3426 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3427 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3428 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3431 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3432 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3435 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3436 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3438 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3440 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3441 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3442 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3443 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3446 .oindex "&%-dropcr%&"
3447 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3448 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3449 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3453 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3454 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3455 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3456 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3457 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3458 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3459 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3460 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3463 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3464 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3465 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3466 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3467 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3469 .vitem &%-F%&&~<&'string'&>
3471 .cindex "sender" "name"
3472 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3473 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3474 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3475 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3476 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3477 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3479 .vitem &%-f%&&~<&'address'&>
3481 .cindex "sender" "address"
3482 .cindex "address" "sender"
3483 .cindex "trusted users"
3484 .cindex "envelope sender"
3485 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3486 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3487 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3488 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3491 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3492 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3493 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3494 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3497 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3498 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3499 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3500 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3501 examples of shell commands:
3503 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3504 exim -f "" user@domain
3506 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3507 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3510 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3511 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3512 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3513 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3516 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3517 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3518 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3519 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3520 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3521 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3525 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-G%& option ignored"
3526 This is a Sendmail option which is ignored by Exim.
3528 .vitem &%-h%&&~<&'number'&>
3530 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3531 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3532 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3537 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3538 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3539 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3540 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
3541 no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
3542 command in Solaris 2.4 uses it. See also &%-ti%&.
3544 .vitem &%-M%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3546 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3547 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3548 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3549 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3550 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3551 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3552 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3555 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3556 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3557 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3558 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3559 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3560 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3562 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3563 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3564 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3565 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3567 .vitem &%-Mar%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3569 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3570 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3571 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3572 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3573 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3574 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3575 can be used only by an admin user.
3577 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3578 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3580 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3581 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3582 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3583 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3584 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3585 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3586 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3587 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3591 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3592 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3593 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3597 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3598 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3599 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3601 .vitem &%-MCQ%&&~<&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3603 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3604 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3605 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3606 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3607 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3608 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3612 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3613 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3614 SMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3619 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3620 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3621 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3623 .vitem &%-Mc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3625 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
3626 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
3627 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn,
3628 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
3629 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
3630 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
3631 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
3632 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
3633 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
3634 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
3635 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
3636 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
3637 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
3639 .vitem &%-Mes%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
3641 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
3642 .cindex "sender" "changing"
3643 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
3644 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
3645 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
3646 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
3647 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
3648 This option can be used only by an admin user.
3650 .vitem &%-Mf%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3652 .cindex "freezing messages"
3653 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
3654 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
3655 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
3656 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
3657 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
3658 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
3661 .vitem &%-Mg%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3663 .cindex "giving up on messages"
3664 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
3665 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
3666 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
3667 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
3668 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
3669 is sent to the sender, containing the text &"cancelled by administrator"&.
3670 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
3673 .vitem &%-Mmad%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3675 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
3676 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
3677 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
3678 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
3679 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3681 .vitem &%-Mmd%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3683 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
3684 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
3685 .cindex "removing recipients"
3686 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
3687 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
3688 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
3689 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
3690 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
3691 can be used only by an admin user.
3693 .vitem &%-Mrm%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3695 .cindex "removing messages"
3696 .cindex "abandoning mail"
3697 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
3698 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
3699 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
3700 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
3701 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
3702 placed on the queue.
3704 .vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3706 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
3707 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
3708 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
3709 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
3710 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
3711 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
3712 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
3713 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
3714 user. See also &%-bem%&.
3716 .vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3718 .cindex "thawing messages"
3719 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
3720 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
3721 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
3722 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
3723 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
3724 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
3727 .vitem &%-Mvb%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3729 .cindex "listing" "message body"
3730 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
3731 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
3732 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3735 .vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3737 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
3738 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2922 format"
3739 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
3740 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
3741 only by an admin user.
3744 .vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3746 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
3747 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
3748 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
3749 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
3750 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3752 .vitem &%-Mvl%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
3754 .cindex "listing" "message log"
3755 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
3756 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
3757 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
3761 This is apparently a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail, so Exim
3762 treats it that way too.
3766 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
3767 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
3768 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
3769 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
3770 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
3771 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
3772 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
3775 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
3776 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
3777 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
3778 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
3779 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
3780 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
3781 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
3786 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-n%& option ignored"
3787 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&. It is ignored
3790 .vitem &%-O%&&~<&'data'&>
3792 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
3795 .vitem &%-oA%&&~<&'file&~name'&>
3797 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
3798 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
3799 alternative alias file name. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
3802 .vitem &%-oB%&&~<&'n'&>
3804 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3805 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3806 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3807 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
3808 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
3809 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
3813 .cindex "background delivery"
3814 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
3815 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
3816 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
3817 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
3818 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
3819 processes to finish.
3821 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
3822 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
3823 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
3824 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
3826 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
3827 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
3828 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
3829 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
3833 .cindex "foreground delivery"
3834 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
3835 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
3836 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
3837 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
3838 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
3840 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
3841 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
3844 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
3845 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
3847 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
3848 message is left on the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
3849 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
3850 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
3855 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
3860 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
3861 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
3862 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
3863 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
3864 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
3865 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
3866 are placed on the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
3867 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
3868 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
3869 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
3874 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
3875 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
3876 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
3877 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
3878 configuration file is in effect.
3880 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
3881 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
3882 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
3883 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
3884 done at this time, so the message remains on the queue until a subsequent queue
3885 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
3886 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
3887 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
3888 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
3893 .cindex "error" "reporting"
3894 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
3895 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
3898 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
3900 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
3901 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
3902 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 any other error. This is
3903 the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
3907 .cindex "error" "reporting"
3908 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
3909 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
3910 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
3911 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
3915 .cindex "error" "reporting"
3916 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
3917 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
3918 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
3919 The return code is 1 for all errors.
3923 .cindex "error" "reporting"
3924 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
3929 .cindex "error" "reporting"
3930 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
3935 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3936 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
3937 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
3938 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
3939 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
3940 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
3943 .oindex "&%-oitrue%&"
3944 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
3946 .vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
3948 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
3949 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
3950 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
3951 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
3952 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
3953 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
3955 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
3956 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
3958 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
3960 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
3961 followed by a colon and the port number:
3963 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
3965 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
3966 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
3967 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
3968 whichever one is last.
3970 .vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
3972 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
3973 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
3974 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
3975 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
3976 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
3977 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
3979 .vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
3981 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
3982 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
3983 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
3984 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
3985 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
3986 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
3988 .vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
3990 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
3991 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
3992 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
3993 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
3994 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
3995 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
3996 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
3997 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
3999 .vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
4001 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4002 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4003 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4004 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4005 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4007 .vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
4009 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4010 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4011 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4012 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4013 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4014 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4015 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4016 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4017 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4020 .vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
4022 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4023 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4024 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4025 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4026 uses the name it is given.
4028 .vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
4030 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4031 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4032 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4033 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4034 used, when there is no default.
4038 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4039 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4040 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4041 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4045 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4046 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4047 whatever that means.
4049 .vitem &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>
4051 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4052 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4053 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4054 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4055 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4056 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4057 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4059 .vitem &%-or%&&~<&'time'&>
4061 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4062 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4063 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4064 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4065 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4067 .vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
4069 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4070 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4071 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4072 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4073 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4074 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4078 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4080 .vitem &%-oX%&&~<&'number&~or&~string'&>
4082 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4083 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4084 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4085 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4086 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4087 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4088 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4089 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid file name.
4093 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4094 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4095 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4096 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4101 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4102 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4103 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4104 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4107 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4109 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4111 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4113 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4114 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4115 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4116 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`p`&
4117 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4121 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4122 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4123 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4124 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4125 and &%-S%& options).
4127 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4128 The &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4129 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4130 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4131 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4132 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4135 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4136 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4137 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4138 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4139 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4142 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4143 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4144 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4145 this to be repeated periodically.
4147 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4148 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4149 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4150 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4152 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4153 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4154 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4156 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4157 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4158 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4159 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4163 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4164 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4165 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4166 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4167 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4168 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4171 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4172 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4173 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred. After this is
4174 complete, a second, normal queue scan happens, with routing and delivery taking
4175 place as normal. Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4176 delivered down a single SMTP
4177 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4178 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4179 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4180 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4181 This option may be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4184 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4186 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4187 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4188 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4189 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages on the queue using
4190 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4192 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4194 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4195 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4196 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4197 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4198 their retry times are tried.
4200 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4202 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4203 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4206 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4208 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4209 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4210 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains on the queue
4213 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4214 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4215 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4216 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4217 starting message id. For example:
4219 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4221 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4222 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4223 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4225 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4227 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4228 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4229 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4230 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4231 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4232 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4234 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4235 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4236 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4237 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4238 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4239 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4240 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4241 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4242 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4244 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4246 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4247 process every 30 minutes.
4249 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4250 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4252 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4254 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4257 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4259 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4261 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4263 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4264 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4265 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4266 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4267 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4268 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4269 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4271 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4272 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4273 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4274 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4275 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4276 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4278 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4279 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4281 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4283 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4284 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4285 applied to each queue run.
4287 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4288 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4289 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4290 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4291 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4292 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4293 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4294 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4295 address will be skipped.
4297 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4298 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4299 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4302 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4303 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4304 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), its default
4305 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4306 an arbitrary command instead.
4310 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4312 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4314 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4315 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4316 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4317 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4318 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4319 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4321 .vitem &%-Tqt%&&~<&'times'&>
4323 This an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4324 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4325 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4329 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4330 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
4331 .cindex "&'Cc:'& header line"
4332 .cindex "&'To:'& header line"
4333 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4334 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4335 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4336 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4337 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4339 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4340 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4341 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4342 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4343 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4344 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4345 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4346 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4347 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4348 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4349 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4351 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4352 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4353 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4354 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4355 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4356 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4358 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4359 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4360 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4361 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4362 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4363 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4364 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4365 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4366 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4370 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4371 compatibility with Sendmail.
4373 .vitem &%-tls-on-connect%&
4374 .oindex "&%-tls-on-connect%&"
4375 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4376 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4377 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4378 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4379 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4380 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4385 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4386 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4387 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4388 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4389 set. Exim ignores this option.
4393 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4394 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4395 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4396 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4397 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4398 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4403 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4404 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4405 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4413 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4414 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4415 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4416 . creates a man page for the options.
4417 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4420 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4427 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4428 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4431 .chapter "The Exim run time configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4432 "The runtime configuration file"
4434 .cindex "run time configuration"
4435 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4436 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4437 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4438 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4439 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4440 Exim uses a single run time configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4441 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4442 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4445 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4446 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4447 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4448 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4449 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4450 actually alter the string.
4452 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4453 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4454 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4455 give a colon-separated list of file names, in which case Exim uses the first
4456 existing file in the list.
4459 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4460 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4461 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4462 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4463 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4464 The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4465 specified at compile time by the EXIM_USER option, or by the user that is
4466 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4467 configuration file must not be world-writeable or group-writeable, unless its
4468 group is the one specified at compile time by the EXIM_GROUP option or by the
4469 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4471 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4472 to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
4473 easy way to run commands as root. If you make your mail administrators members
4474 of the Exim group, but do not trust them with root, make sure that the run time
4475 configuration is not group writeable.
4477 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4478 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4479 defines just one file name, the installation process copies the default
4480 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4481 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4482 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4487 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4488 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4489 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4490 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4491 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root or the
4492 Exim user (or unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value
4493 from CONFIGURE_FILE). &%-C%& is useful mainly for checking the syntax of
4494 configuration files before installing them. No owner or group checks are done
4495 on a configuration file specified by &%-C%&.
4497 The privileged use of &%-C%& by the Exim user can be locked out by setting
4498 ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. However,
4499 if you do this, you also lock out the possibility of testing a
4500 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery, even
4501 if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is running
4502 as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the
4503 use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and
4504 delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message on the queue, using
4505 &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
4507 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4508 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4509 start. In addition, the file name must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4510 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any file
4511 name can be used with &%-C%&.
4513 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4514 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4515 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4516 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4517 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4518 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4520 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4521 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4522 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4523 looks for a file whose name is the configuration file name followed by a dot
4524 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4525 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4526 each file name in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4528 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4529 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4530 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4534 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4535 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4536 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4537 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4538 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4539 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4540 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by the name of the part. The
4544 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
4547 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
4548 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
4549 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
4551 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
4552 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
4553 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
4555 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
4556 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
4557 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
4560 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
4561 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
4562 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
4563 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
4567 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
4568 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
4569 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
4571 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
4572 want to use this feature, you must set
4574 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
4576 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
4577 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
4580 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
4581 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
4582 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
4583 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
4585 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
4586 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
4587 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
4588 and does not introduce a comment.
4590 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
4591 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
4592 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
4593 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
4594 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
4596 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
4597 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
4598 change settings as required.
4600 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
4601 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
4602 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
4603 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
4604 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
4609 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
4610 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
4611 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
4612 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
4613 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
4614 You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
4617 &`.include`& <&'file name'&>
4618 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'file name'&>
4620 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the file name are optional. If you use
4621 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
4622 second form does nothing for non-existent files. In all cases, an absolute file
4625 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
4626 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
4627 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
4628 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
4630 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
4631 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
4634 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
4637 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
4638 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
4643 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
4644 .cindex "macro" "description of"
4645 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
4646 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
4647 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
4648 definition, and must be of the form
4650 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
4652 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
4653 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
4654 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
4655 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
4656 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
4658 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
4659 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
4660 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
4662 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
4663 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
4664 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
4665 scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
4666 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
4667 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
4668 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
4671 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
4672 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
4674 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
4675 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
4676 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
4677 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
4678 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
4679 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
4682 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
4683 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
4684 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
4689 MAC == updated value
4691 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
4692 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
4693 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
4694 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
4698 MAC == MAC and something added
4700 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
4701 from a number of other files.
4703 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
4704 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
4705 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
4706 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
4707 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
4712 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
4713 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
4714 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
4715 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
4717 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
4718 login=${quote_mysql:$local_part};
4720 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
4722 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
4724 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
4725 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
4726 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
4729 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
4730 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
4731 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
4732 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
4733 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
4734 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
4735 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
4737 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
4738 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
4739 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
4743 message_size_limit = 50M
4745 message_size_limit = 100M
4748 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined, and 100M
4749 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
4750 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
4751 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
4753 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
4754 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
4755 in this line"& will always be true.
4757 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
4758 to clarify complicated nestings.
4762 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
4763 .cindex "common option syntax"
4764 .cindex "syntax of common options"
4765 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
4766 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
4767 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
4768 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
4769 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
4770 space) and then the value. For example:
4772 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
4774 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
4775 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
4776 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
4777 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
4778 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
4779 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
4780 word &"hide"&. For example:
4782 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
4784 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
4786 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
4788 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
4789 all instances of the same driver.
4791 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
4792 that are found in option settings.
4795 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
4796 .cindex "format" "boolean"
4797 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
4798 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
4799 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
4800 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
4801 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
4802 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
4803 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
4804 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
4805 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
4806 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
4811 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
4816 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
4821 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
4822 .cindex "integer configuration values"
4823 .cindex "format" "integer"
4824 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
4825 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
4826 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
4827 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
4830 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
4831 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024. When the values
4832 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
4833 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
4834 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
4838 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
4839 .cindex "integer format"
4840 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
4841 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
4842 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
4843 Such options are always output in octal.
4846 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
4847 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
4848 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
4849 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
4850 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
4854 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
4855 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
4856 .cindex "format" "time interval"
4857 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
4858 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
4868 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
4869 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
4870 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
4874 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
4875 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
4876 .cindex "format" "string"
4877 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
4878 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
4879 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
4880 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
4881 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
4882 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
4883 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
4884 therefore equivalent:
4886 trusted_users = uucp:mail
4887 trusted_users = uucp:\
4888 # This comment line is ignored
4891 .cindex "string" "quoted"
4892 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
4893 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
4894 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
4895 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
4898 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
4899 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
4900 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
4902 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
4903 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
4907 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
4908 character, that character replaces the pair.
4910 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
4911 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
4912 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
4913 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
4914 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
4915 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
4918 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
4919 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
4920 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
4921 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
4922 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
4923 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
4924 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
4925 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
4926 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
4927 within a quoted configuration string.
4930 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
4931 .cindex "user name" "format of"
4932 .cindex "format" "user name"
4933 .cindex "groups" "name format"
4934 .cindex "format" "group name"
4935 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
4936 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
4937 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
4938 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
4941 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
4942 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
4943 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
4944 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
4945 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
4946 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
4947 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
4948 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
4949 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
4950 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
4951 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
4953 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
4954 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
4955 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
4956 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
4957 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
4958 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
4961 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
4963 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
4965 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
4966 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The space after the first
4967 colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
4968 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
4970 .section "Changing list separators" "SECID53"
4971 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
4972 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
4973 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
4974 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
4975 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
4976 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
4977 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
4979 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
4981 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
4982 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
4983 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
4985 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
4986 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
4987 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
4988 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
4989 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
4990 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
4991 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
4992 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
4993 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
4995 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
4997 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
4998 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
4999 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5000 the value in quotes. For example:
5002 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5004 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5005 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5006 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5007 enclosing an empty list item.
5011 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5012 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5013 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5014 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5016 senders = user@domain :
5018 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5019 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5020 items, the second of which is empty:
5022 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5024 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5025 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5026 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5027 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5031 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5032 is at the end of the list.
5037 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5038 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5039 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5040 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5041 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5042 a sequence of lines like this:
5044 <&'instance name'&>:
5049 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5050 followed by three options settings:
5055 transport = local_delivery
5057 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5058 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5059 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5060 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5061 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5062 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5064 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5065 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5067 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5068 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5069 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5070 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5071 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5074 .cindex "generic options"
5075 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5076 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5077 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5078 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5079 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5080 .cindex "private options"
5081 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5082 they all have default values.
5084 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5085 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5086 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5088 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5089 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5090 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5091 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5092 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5093 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5094 configuration lines:
5099 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5100 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5101 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5102 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5108 command_timeout = 10s
5110 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5111 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5114 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5115 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5116 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5124 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5125 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5127 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5128 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5129 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5130 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5131 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5132 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5133 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5134 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5135 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5136 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5137 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5141 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5142 The main (global) configuration option settings must always come first in the
5143 file. The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is
5146 # primary_hostname =
5148 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5149 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5150 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5151 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5153 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5155 domainlist local_domains = @
5156 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5157 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5159 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5160 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5161 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5162 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5164 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5165 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5168 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5169 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5170 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5171 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5172 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5173 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5175 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5176 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5177 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5178 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5179 domain is permitted.
5181 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5182 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5183 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5184 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5185 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5186 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5188 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5189 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5190 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5192 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5194 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5195 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5197 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5198 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5199 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5200 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5201 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5202 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5203 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5204 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5205 contents of a message to be checked.
5207 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5209 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5210 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5212 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5213 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5214 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5215 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5217 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5219 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5220 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5221 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5223 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5224 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5225 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5226 connecting to this server; in this case the wildcard means all clients. The
5227 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5228 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5229 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5231 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5233 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5234 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5236 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5237 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5238 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5239 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5240 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5241 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5242 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5243 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5244 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5245 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5246 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&). The usual SMTP port 25 is often blocked
5247 on end-user networks, so RFC 4409 specifies that message submission should use
5248 port 587 instead. However some software (notably Microsoft Outlook) cannot be
5249 configured to use port 587 correctly, so these settings also enable the
5250 non-standard &"smtps"& (aka &"ssmtp"&) port 465 (see section
5251 &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&).
5253 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5256 # qualify_recipient =
5258 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5259 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5260 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5261 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5262 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5263 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5265 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5266 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5267 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5268 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5270 # allow_domain_literals
5272 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5273 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5274 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5275 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5276 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5277 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5279 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5283 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5284 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5285 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5286 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5287 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5288 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5289 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5290 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5292 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5293 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5298 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5299 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5300 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5301 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5302 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5303 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5306 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5307 1413 (hence their names):
5310 rfc1413_query_timeout = 5s
5312 These settings cause Exim to make ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5313 You can limit the hosts to which these calls are made, or change the timeout
5314 that is used. If you set the timeout to zero, all ident calls are disabled.
5315 Although they are cheap and can provide useful information for tracing problem
5316 messages, some hosts and firewalls have problems with ident calls. This can
5317 result in a timeout instead of an immediate refused connection, leading to
5318 delays on starting up an incoming SMTP session.
5320 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5321 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5322 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5323 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5325 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5326 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5328 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5329 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5331 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5333 # percent_hack_domains =
5335 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5336 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5337 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5339 The last two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5340 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5341 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5342 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5343 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5344 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5345 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5346 always bounce messages.
5348 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5349 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5351 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5352 discarded after 2 days on the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5353 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5354 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5355 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5359 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5360 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5361 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5362 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5363 It starts with the line
5367 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5368 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5369 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5371 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5372 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5373 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5374 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5375 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5376 result of the ACL processing.
5380 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5385 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5386 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5387 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5388 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5389 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5390 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5392 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5393 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5394 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5397 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5398 domains = +local_domains
5399 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5401 deny message = Restricted characters in address
5402 domains = !+local_domains
5403 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5405 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5406 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5407 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5408 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5409 in Internet mail addresses.
5411 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5412 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5413 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5414 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5415 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5416 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5417 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5418 policy of being as safe as possible.
5420 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5421 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5422 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5423 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5424 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5425 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5427 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5428 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5429 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5430 have to modify this rule.
5432 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
5433 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
5434 common convention of local parts constructed as
5435 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
5436 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
5437 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
5438 file name (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
5439 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
5440 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
5442 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
5443 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
5444 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
5445 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
5446 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
5447 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
5448 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
5450 accept local_parts = postmaster
5451 domains = +local_domains
5453 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
5454 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
5455 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5456 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5457 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5459 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
5460 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
5461 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
5463 require verify = sender
5465 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
5466 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
5467 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
5468 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
5469 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
5470 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
5471 discusses the details of address verification.
5473 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
5474 control = submission
5476 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
5477 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
5478 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
5479 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
5480 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
5481 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
5482 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
5483 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
5484 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
5486 accept authenticated = *
5487 control = submission
5489 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
5490 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
5491 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
5492 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
5493 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
5494 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
5496 require message = relay not permitted
5497 domains = +local_domains : +relay_domains
5499 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
5500 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
5502 require verify = recipient
5504 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
5505 fails, the address is rejected.
5507 # deny message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
5508 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
5510 # dnslists = black.list.example
5512 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
5513 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
5514 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
5515 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
5517 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
5518 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
5519 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
5522 # require verify = csa
5524 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
5525 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
5530 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
5531 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
5535 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
5536 of this ACL are commented out:
5539 # message = This message contains a virus \
5542 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
5543 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
5544 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
5545 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
5547 # warn spam = nobody
5548 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
5549 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
5550 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
5551 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
5553 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
5554 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
5555 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
5556 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
5557 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
5558 whatever the spam score.
5562 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
5565 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
5566 .cindex "default" "routers"
5567 .cindex "routers" "default"
5568 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
5573 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
5574 messages. An address is passed to each router in turn, until it is either
5575 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
5576 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
5577 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
5580 # driver = ipliteral
5581 # domains = !+local_domains
5582 # transport = remote_smtp
5584 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
5585 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
5586 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
5587 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
5588 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
5592 domains = ! +local_domains
5593 transport = remote_smtp
5594 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
5597 The first uncommented router handles addresses that do not involve any local
5598 domains. This is specified by the line
5600 domains = ! +local_domains
5602 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
5603 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
5604 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
5605 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
5606 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
5607 passed on to the following routers.
5609 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
5610 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
5611 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
5612 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
5613 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
5615 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
5616 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
5617 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
5618 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
5619 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
5620 the address fails and is bounced.
5622 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
5623 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
5624 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
5625 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
5626 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
5627 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
5628 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
5635 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
5637 file_transport = address_file
5638 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5640 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
5641 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
5642 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
5643 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
5644 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
5647 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
5648 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
5649 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
5650 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
5655 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5656 # local_part_suffix_optional
5657 file = $home/.forward
5662 file_transport = address_file
5663 pipe_transport = address_pipe
5664 reply_transport = address_reply
5666 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
5667 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
5668 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
5669 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
5670 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
5673 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5674 # local_part_suffix_optional
5676 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
5677 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
5678 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
5679 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
5680 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
5681 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
5682 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
5684 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
5685 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
5686 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
5687 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
5689 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
5690 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
5691 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
5692 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
5693 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
5694 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
5695 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
5697 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
5698 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
5699 There are two reasons for doing this:
5702 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
5703 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
5706 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
5707 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
5708 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
5709 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
5713 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
5714 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
5715 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
5716 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
5718 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
5719 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
5720 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
5722 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
5724 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
5730 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
5731 # local_part_suffix_optional
5732 transport = local_delivery
5734 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
5735 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
5736 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
5737 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
5738 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
5741 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
5742 .cindex "default" "transports"
5743 .cindex "transports" "default"
5744 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
5745 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
5746 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
5750 One remote transport and four local transports are defined.
5755 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections. All its
5756 options are defaulted. The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
5760 file = /var/mail/$local_part
5767 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
5768 traditional BSD mailbox format. By default it runs under the uid and gid of the
5769 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
5770 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
5771 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
5772 show how this can be done.
5774 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
5775 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
5776 similarly-named options above.
5782 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
5783 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
5784 option specifies that any output generated by the pipe is to be returned to the
5793 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
5794 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
5795 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
5800 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
5805 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
5806 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
5807 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
5808 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
5809 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
5810 introduced by the line
5814 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
5817 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
5819 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
5820 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
5821 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
5822 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced.
5825 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
5826 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
5827 temporary errors into permanent errors.
5831 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
5832 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
5836 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
5837 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
5841 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
5842 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
5843 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
5845 begin authenticators
5847 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
5848 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
5849 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
5850 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
5851 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
5852 to support most MUA software.
5854 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
5857 # driver = plaintext
5858 # server_set_id = $auth2
5859 # server_prompts = :
5860 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
5861 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_cipher }
5863 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
5866 # driver = plaintext
5867 # server_set_id = $auth1
5868 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
5869 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
5870 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_cipher }
5873 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
5874 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
5875 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
5876 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
5877 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
5878 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
5879 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
5880 need to add support for TLS as described in &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
5882 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
5883 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
5884 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
5885 expression like one of the examples in &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
5887 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
5891 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5892 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5894 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
5896 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
5898 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
5899 uses the PCRE regular expression library; this provides regular expression
5900 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
5901 regular expressions is discussed in many Perl reference books, and also in
5902 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
5903 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
5905 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
5906 are supported by PCRE is included in plain text in the file
5907 &_doc/pcrepattern.txt_& in the Exim distribution, and also in the HTML
5908 tarbundle of Exim documentation. It describes in detail the features of the
5909 regular expressions that PCRE supports, so no further description is included
5910 here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using the default option settings
5911 (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that the PCRE_CASELESS option is
5912 set when the matching is required to be case-insensitive.
5914 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
5915 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
5916 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
5917 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
5919 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
5921 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
5922 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
5923 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
5924 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
5925 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
5926 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
5929 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
5930 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
5931 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
5932 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
5933 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
5934 match anywhere in the subject string.
5936 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
5937 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
5939 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
5941 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
5944 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
5946 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
5947 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
5951 .section "Testing regular expressions" "SECID59"
5952 .cindex "testing" "regular expressions"
5953 .cindex "regular expressions" "testing"
5954 .cindex "&'pcretest'&"
5955 A program called &'pcretest'& forms part of the PCRE distribution and is built
5956 with PCRE during the process of building Exim. It is primarily intended for
5957 testing PCRE itself, but it can also be used for experimenting with regular
5958 expressions. After building Exim, the binary can be found in the build
5959 directory (it is not installed anywhere automatically). There is documentation
5960 of various options in &_doc/pcretest.txt_&, but for simple testing, none are
5961 needed. This is the output of a sample run of &'pcretest'&:
5963 &` re> `&&*&`/^([@]+)@.+\.(ac|edu)\.(?!kr)[a-z]{2}$/`&*&
5964 &`data> `&&*&`x@y.ac.uk`&*&
5968 &`data> `&&*&`x@y.ac.kr`&*&
5970 &`data> `&&*&`x@y.edu.com`&*&
5972 &`data> `&&*&`x@y.edu.co`&*&
5977 Input typed by the user is shown in bold face. After the &"re>"& prompt, a
5978 regular expression enclosed in delimiters is expected. If this compiles without
5979 error, &"data>"& prompts are given for strings against which the expression is
5980 matched. An empty data line causes a new regular expression to be read. If the
5981 match is successful, the captured substring values (that is, what would be in
5982 the variables &$0$&, &$1$&, &$2$&, etc.) are shown. The above example tests for
5983 an email address whose domain ends with either &"ac"& or &"edu"& followed by a
5984 two-character top-level domain that is not &"kr"&. The local part is captured
5985 in &$1$& and the &"ac"& or &"edu"& in &$2$&.
5992 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5993 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5995 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
5996 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
5997 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
5998 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
5999 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6000 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6003 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6004 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6005 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6006 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6007 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6009 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6010 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6011 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6012 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6013 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6016 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6017 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6018 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6019 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6020 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6021 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6023 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6024 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6025 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6026 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6027 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6029 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6030 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6032 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6033 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6034 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6035 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6036 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6038 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6039 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6041 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6042 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6044 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6045 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6046 in the file. The file could contains lines like this:
6051 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6052 matches the list item.
6054 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6055 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6057 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6059 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6060 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6061 causes a second lookup to occur.
6063 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6064 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6065 lookup is permitted.
6068 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6069 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6070 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6071 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6074 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6075 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6076 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6078 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6079 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6080 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6081 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6084 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6085 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6086 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6091 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6092 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6093 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6098 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6099 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6100 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6101 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6104 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6105 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6106 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6107 &(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6108 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6109 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6110 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6111 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
6112 be found in several places:
6114 &url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html)
6115 &url(ftp://ftp.corpit.ru/pub/tinycdb/)
6116 &url(http://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb.html)
6118 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6119 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6120 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6121 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6123 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6124 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6125 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6126 &(dbm)&: Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6127 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6128 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6129 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6131 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6132 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6133 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6134 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6135 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6136 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6137 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6139 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6140 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6141 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6143 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6144 .cindex "dmbnz lookup type"
6145 &(dbmnz)&: This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6146 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6147 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6148 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6149 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6150 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6151 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6152 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6155 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6156 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6157 &(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
6158 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
6159 contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
6160 the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
6161 symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
6162 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6163 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6166 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6167 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6168 &(iplsearch)&: The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6169 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6170 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6171 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6172 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6174 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6175 192.168.0.0/16 data for 192.168.0.0/16
6176 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6177 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6179 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6180 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6181 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6182 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6183 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6185 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6186 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6187 lookup types support only literal keys.
6189 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6190 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name (see section
6191 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6193 .cindex "linear search"
6194 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6195 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6196 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6197 &(lsearch)&: The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6198 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6199 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6200 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6201 in the file is used.
6203 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
6204 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
6205 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
6206 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
6207 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
6212 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
6213 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
6214 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
6215 wildcarding of any kind.
6217 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
6218 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
6219 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
6220 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
6221 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
6222 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
6223 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
6224 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
6225 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
6228 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
6229 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
6230 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6231 &(nis)&: The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
6232 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
6233 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
6234 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
6235 aliases; the full map names must be used.
6238 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
6239 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
6240 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
6241 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
6242 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
6243 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
6244 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
6245 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
6246 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
6248 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
6249 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
6250 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
6251 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
6253 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
6254 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
6257 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
6259 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
6260 *fish data for anythingfish
6263 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
6264 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
6266 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
6268 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
6269 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
6270 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
6272 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6274 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
6275 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
6276 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
6278 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
6281 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
6282 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
6283 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
6284 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
6285 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
6287 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
6288 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
6289 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
6290 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
6291 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
6294 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
6295 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
6296 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
6299 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
6301 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
6304 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
6305 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
6306 be followed by optional colons.
6308 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6309 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6310 lookup types support only literal keys.
6314 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECID62"
6315 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
6316 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
6317 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
6318 many of them are given in later sections.
6321 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6322 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
6323 &(dnsdb)&: This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
6324 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
6325 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
6327 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
6328 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
6329 &(ibase)&: This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
6331 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
6332 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6333 &(ldap)&: This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
6334 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
6335 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
6336 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
6337 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
6339 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
6340 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
6341 &(mysql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6342 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6344 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
6345 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
6346 &(nisplus)&: This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
6347 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
6349 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
6350 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
6351 &(oracle)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
6352 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6354 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
6355 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
6356 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
6357 &(passwd)& is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
6358 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
6359 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
6360 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
6361 password value. For example:
6363 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
6366 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
6367 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
6368 &(pgsql)&: The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
6369 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
6372 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
6373 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
6374 &(sqlite)&: The format of the query is a file name followed by an SQL statement
6375 that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
6378 &(testdb)&: This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
6379 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
6381 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
6382 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
6383 &(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
6384 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
6385 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
6386 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
6387 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
6388 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
6389 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
6391 require condition = \
6392 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
6394 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
6395 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
6396 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
6397 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
6402 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
6403 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
6404 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
6405 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
6406 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
6407 options such as a list of local domains.
6409 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
6410 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
6411 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
6412 or may give up altogether.
6416 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
6417 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6418 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
6419 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6420 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
6421 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
6422 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
6423 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
6425 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
6426 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
6427 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
6429 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
6430 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
6431 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
6433 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
6434 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
6435 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
6436 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
6437 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
6438 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
6439 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
6440 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
6441 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
6442 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
6444 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
6446 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
6447 looks up these keys, in this order:
6453 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
6454 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
6455 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
6456 Exim move on to try the next key.
6460 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
6461 .cindex "partial matching"
6462 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
6463 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
6464 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
6465 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
6466 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
6467 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
6468 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
6469 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
6470 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
6471 a key in a DBM file is
6473 *.dates.fict.example
6475 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
6476 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
6477 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
6480 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
6481 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
6482 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
6484 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
6485 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
6486 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
6487 partial matching keys
6488 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
6489 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
6490 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
6492 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
6493 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
6494 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
6495 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
6496 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
6497 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
6500 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
6501 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
6502 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
6503 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
6504 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
6505 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
6507 2250.dates.fict.example
6508 *.2250.dates.fict.example
6509 *.dates.fict.example
6512 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
6515 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
6516 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
6517 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
6518 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
6519 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
6520 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
6522 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
6524 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6525 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
6526 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
6527 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
6529 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
6531 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
6532 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
6534 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
6535 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
6536 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
6539 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
6541 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
6542 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
6544 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
6545 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
6546 for &"*"& on its own.
6548 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
6552 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
6553 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
6554 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
6555 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
6556 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
6557 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
6558 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
6560 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
6561 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
6562 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
6563 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
6564 subject key is always followed by a dot.
6569 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
6570 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
6571 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
6572 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
6573 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
6574 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
6575 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
6577 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
6578 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
6579 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
6580 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
6581 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
6582 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
6584 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
6585 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
6591 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
6592 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
6593 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
6594 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
6595 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
6596 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
6600 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
6601 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
6603 [name="$local_part"]
6605 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
6606 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
6607 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
6608 of the following form is provided:
6610 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
6612 For example, the safest way to write the NIS+ query is
6614 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
6616 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
6617 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
6618 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
6623 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
6624 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
6625 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
6626 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
6627 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
6628 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
6629 an expansion string could contain:
6631 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
6633 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
6634 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
6635 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
6636 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
6638 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SRV, and TXT, and,
6639 when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA (and A6 if that is also
6640 configured). If no type is given, TXT is assumed. When the type is PTR,
6641 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
6642 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
6644 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
6646 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
6647 altered and nothing is added.
6649 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6650 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6651 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6652 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
6653 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
6655 For any record type, if multiple records are found (or, for A6 lookups, if a
6656 single record leads to multiple addresses), the data is returned as a
6657 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
6658 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
6659 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
6660 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
6662 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
6664 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
6665 white space is ignored.
6667 .section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
6668 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6669 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
6670 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
6671 the pseudo-type MXH:
6673 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
6675 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
6678 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
6679 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
6680 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
6681 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
6682 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
6683 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
6684 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
6685 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
6687 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
6688 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
6690 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
6691 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
6692 the name servers for &%edu%&.
6694 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
6695 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
6696 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
6697 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
6698 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
6701 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
6702 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
6703 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
6704 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
6705 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
6706 result of a successful lookup such as:
6708 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
6710 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
6711 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
6712 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
6715 .section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
6716 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
6717 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
6718 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
6719 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
6721 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
6722 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6723 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
6725 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
6726 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
6727 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
6728 case, it does not treat it as a list.
6730 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
6731 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
6732 different separator can be specified, as described above.
6734 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
6735 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
6736 an optional keyword followed by a comma that may appear before the record
6737 type. The possible keywords are &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and
6738 &"defer_lax"&. With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
6739 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
6740 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
6741 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
6742 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
6743 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
6745 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6746 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
6748 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
6749 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
6754 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
6755 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
6756 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
6757 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
6758 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
6759 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
6760 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
6761 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
6762 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
6763 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
6764 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
6765 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
6767 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
6768 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
6769 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
6770 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
6771 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
6773 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
6774 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
6776 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
6777 the way they handle the results of a query:
6780 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
6783 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
6784 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
6786 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
6787 from all of them are returned.
6791 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
6792 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
6793 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
6794 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
6797 .section "Format of LDAP queries" "SECTforldaque"
6798 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
6799 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
6800 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
6802 data = ${lookup ldap \
6803 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
6804 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
6806 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
6807 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
6808 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
6809 encrypted TLS connection is used.
6812 .section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
6813 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
6814 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
6815 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
6816 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
6817 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
6819 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
6820 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
6828 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
6829 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
6833 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
6835 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
6839 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
6841 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
6843 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
6845 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
6846 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
6847 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
6851 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
6852 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
6853 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
6855 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
6859 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
6861 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
6863 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
6865 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
6866 authentication below.
6869 .section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
6870 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
6871 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
6872 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
6873 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
6876 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
6878 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
6879 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
6880 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
6881 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
6882 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
6883 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
6884 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
6885 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
6886 failures, and timeouts.
6888 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
6889 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
6890 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
6891 doubled. For example
6893 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
6895 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
6896 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
6897 the local host) is used.
6899 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
6900 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
6901 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
6902 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
6905 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
6906 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
6907 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
6908 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
6910 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
6912 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
6913 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
6915 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
6917 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
6918 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
6919 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
6920 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
6921 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
6922 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
6923 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
6926 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
6927 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
6928 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
6931 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
6934 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
6938 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
6939 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
6943 .section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
6944 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
6945 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
6946 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
6947 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
6948 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
6949 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
6950 them. The following names are recognized:
6952 &`DEREFERENCE`& set the dereferencing parameter
6953 &`NETTIME `& set a timeout for a network operation
6954 &`USER `& set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind
6955 &`PASS `& set the password, likewise
6956 &`REFERRALS `& set the referrals parameter
6957 &`SIZE `& set the limit for the number of entries returned
6958 &`TIME `& set the maximum waiting time for a query
6960 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
6961 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
6962 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
6963 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
6965 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
6966 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
6967 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
6968 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
6969 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
6970 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
6971 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
6972 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
6973 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
6975 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
6976 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
6979 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
6980 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
6983 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
6984 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
6987 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
6988 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
6989 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
6990 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
6992 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
6993 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
6994 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
6996 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
6997 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it LDAP. Apparently
6998 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
6999 quoting has two advantages:
7002 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7003 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7005 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7008 For example, a setting such as
7010 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7012 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7014 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7015 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7016 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7017 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7021 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7022 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7027 .section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
7028 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7029 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7030 as a sequence of values, for example
7032 cn=manager, o=University of Cambridge, c=UK
7034 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7035 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7036 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7037 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7038 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7041 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7042 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7043 has multiple values, they are separated by commas.
7045 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7046 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7047 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7048 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7049 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7050 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7051 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7053 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7054 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7055 &%attr1%& has two values, whereas &%attr2%& has only one value:
7057 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7060 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7063 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7064 attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
7066 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
7067 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1, value1.2" attr2="value two"
7069 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
7070 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs. You can
7071 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
7072 results of LDAP lookups.
7077 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
7078 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7079 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7080 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
7081 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
7082 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
7083 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
7084 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
7086 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
7088 might return the string
7090 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
7091 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
7093 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
7095 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
7101 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
7102 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
7103 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
7107 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
7108 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
7109 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7110 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7111 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7112 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7113 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7114 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7115 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7116 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7117 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, and SQLite
7118 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
7121 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
7124 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
7125 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
7127 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
7132 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
7134 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
7135 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
7136 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
7140 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
7141 with a newline between the data for each row.
7144 .section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, and InterBase" "SECID72"
7145 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7146 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7147 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7148 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7149 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7150 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7151 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7152 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7153 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, or InterBase lookups are used, the
7154 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, or &%ibase_servers%&
7155 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
7157 &new("(For MySQL and PostgreSQL only, the global option need not be set if all
7158 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
7159 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.)") Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
7160 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
7161 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
7162 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
7164 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
7166 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
7167 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
7168 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
7170 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
7171 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
7174 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
7175 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
7176 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
7177 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
7178 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
7179 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
7182 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
7183 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
7184 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
7185 itself are escaped with backslashes. The &%quote_pgsql%& expansion operator, in
7186 addition, escapes the percent and underscore characters. This cannot be done
7187 for MySQL because these escapes are not recognized in contexts where these
7188 characters are not special.
7191 .section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
7192 For MySQL and PostgreSQL lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
7193 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
7194 done by starting the query with
7196 &`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
7198 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
7200 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
7201 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
7202 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
7205 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
7207 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
7208 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
7209 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
7211 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
7212 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
7213 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
7216 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
7220 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
7222 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...}
7224 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
7225 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
7226 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
7228 ${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...}
7233 .section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
7234 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
7235 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
7236 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses. The full syntax of
7237 each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
7239 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)/<&'database'&>/&&&
7240 <&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
7242 Any of the three sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
7243 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
7245 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
7248 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
7249 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
7251 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
7252 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
7253 is zero because no rows are affected.
7256 .section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
7257 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
7258 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
7259 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
7260 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
7263 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
7265 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
7266 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
7267 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
7269 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
7270 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
7273 .section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
7274 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
7275 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7276 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
7277 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
7278 daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
7279 of the file, as an absolute path, to be given at the start of the query. It is
7280 separated from the query by white space. This means that the path name cannot
7281 contain white space. Here is a lookup expansion example:
7283 ${lookup sqlite {/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7284 select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
7286 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
7288 domainlist relay_domains = sqlite;/some/thing/sqlitedb \
7289 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
7291 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
7292 quote, which it doubles.
7294 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
7295 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
7296 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
7297 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
7298 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
7299 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
7305 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7306 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
7308 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
7309 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
7310 "Domain, host, and address lists"
7311 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
7312 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
7313 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
7314 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
7315 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
7316 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
7318 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
7319 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
7320 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
7321 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
7325 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECID75"
7326 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
7327 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used. The result of
7328 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
7329 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
7330 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
7331 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
7332 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
7335 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
7336 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
7337 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
7339 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
7340 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
7341 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
7342 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
7343 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
7345 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
7346 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
7348 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
7349 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
7350 senders based on the receiving domain.
7355 .section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
7356 .cindex "list" "negation"
7357 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
7358 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
7359 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
7360 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
7361 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
7362 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
7364 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
7365 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
7366 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
7367 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
7368 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
7370 domainlist relay_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
7372 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
7373 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
7374 list is positive. However, if the setting were
7376 domainlist relay_domains = !a.b.c
7378 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
7379 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
7380 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
7382 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
7383 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
7388 .section "File names in lists" "SECTfilnamlis"
7389 .cindex "list" "file name in"
7390 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute file
7391 name (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
7392 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
7393 file names are not allowed,
7394 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
7395 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
7399 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
7400 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
7402 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
7403 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
7404 white space or the start of the line. For example:
7406 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
7410 Putting a file name in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
7411 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
7412 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
7413 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
7415 If a file name is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
7416 within the file is inverted. For example, if
7418 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
7420 and the file contains the lines
7425 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
7426 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
7430 .section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
7431 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
7432 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
7433 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
7434 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
7435 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
7436 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
7437 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
7439 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
7440 list, just give the file name on its own, without a search type, as described
7441 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
7442 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
7447 .section "Named lists" "SECTnamedlists"
7448 .cindex "named lists"
7449 .cindex "list" "named"
7450 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
7451 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
7452 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
7453 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
7454 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
7455 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
7456 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
7458 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
7460 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
7461 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
7462 configured with the line
7464 domains = +local_domains
7466 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
7467 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
7471 domains = ! +local_domains
7472 transport = remote_smtp
7475 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
7476 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
7477 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
7478 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
7480 hostlist relay_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
7481 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
7483 A named list may refer to other named lists:
7485 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
7486 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
7487 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
7489 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
7490 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
7491 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
7493 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
7494 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
7496 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
7497 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
7498 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
7500 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
7502 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
7503 referenced lists if you can.
7505 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
7506 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
7507 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
7509 domains = +local_domains
7511 on several of your routers
7512 or in several ACL statements,
7513 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
7514 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
7515 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
7516 the same each time they are referenced.
7518 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
7519 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
7520 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
7521 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
7525 .section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
7526 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
7527 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
7528 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
7529 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
7532 ALIST = host1 : host2
7533 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
7535 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
7537 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
7539 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
7542 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
7543 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
7545 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
7547 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
7551 .section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
7552 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
7553 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
7554 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
7555 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
7556 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
7557 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
7558 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
7559 message. For example:
7561 domainlist special_domains = \
7562 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
7564 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
7565 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
7566 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
7567 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
7568 same list each time.
7570 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
7571 cache the result anyway. For example:
7573 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
7575 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
7576 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
7580 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
7581 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
7582 .cindex "list" "domain list"
7583 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
7584 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
7587 .cindex "primary host name"
7588 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
7589 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
7590 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
7591 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
7592 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
7593 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
7594 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
7595 differ only in their names.
7598 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
7599 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
7600 .cindex "domain literal"
7601 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
7602 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
7603 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
7604 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
7605 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
7606 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
7610 .cindex "@mx_primary"
7611 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
7612 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
7613 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
7614 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
7615 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
7616 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
7617 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
7618 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
7619 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
7620 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
7622 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
7623 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
7624 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
7625 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
7626 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
7628 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
7629 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
7630 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
7631 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
7632 on a router). For example:
7634 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
7636 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
7637 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
7639 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
7640 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
7641 contain negative items.
7643 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
7644 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
7645 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
7647 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
7648 an.other.domain : ...
7650 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
7651 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
7653 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
7654 an.other.domain ? ...
7657 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
7658 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
7659 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
7660 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
7661 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
7662 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
7663 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
7664 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
7665 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
7670 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
7671 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
7672 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
7673 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
7674 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
7675 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
7676 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
7677 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
7678 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
7681 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
7682 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
7683 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
7684 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
7685 expression by expansion, of course).
7687 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
7688 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
7689 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
7690 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
7691 must be a file name in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
7692 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
7694 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
7696 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
7697 key. In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used; Exim is interested
7698 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
7699 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
7700 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the data is preserved in the
7701 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
7702 other statements in the same ACL.
7705 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
7706 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
7708 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
7710 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
7711 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
7714 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
7715 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
7716 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
7717 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
7718 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
7719 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
7722 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
7723 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
7724 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
7725 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
7727 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
7728 where domain = '$domain';
7730 In most cases, the data that is looked up is not used (so for an SQL query, for
7731 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
7732 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
7733 &%domains%& option on a router, the data is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
7734 variable and can be referred to in other options.
7736 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
7737 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
7738 between the pattern and the domain.
7741 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
7743 domainlist funny_domains = \
7746 *.foundation.fict.example : \
7747 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
7748 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
7749 nis;domains.byname : \
7750 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
7752 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
7753 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
7754 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
7755 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
7756 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
7761 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
7762 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
7763 .cindex "list" "host list"
7764 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
7765 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
7766 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
7767 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
7768 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
7769 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
7770 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
7773 .section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
7774 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
7775 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
7776 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
7777 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
7778 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
7781 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
7782 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
7783 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
7787 .section "Host list patterns that match by IP address" "SECThoslispatip"
7788 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
7789 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
7790 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
7791 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
7792 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
7793 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
7796 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
7797 inspecting its IP address:
7800 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
7801 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
7802 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
7803 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
7804 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
7805 with the IP address of the subject host.
7807 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
7808 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
7809 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
7810 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
7811 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
7814 .cindex "@ in a host list"
7815 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
7816 domain name, as just described.
7819 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
7820 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
7821 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
7822 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
7823 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
7824 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
7825 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
7826 that can never match a client host.
7829 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
7830 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
7831 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
7832 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
7834 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
7838 .cindex "CIDR notation"
7839 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length (for
7840 example 10.11.42.0/24), it is matched against the IP address of the subject
7841 host under the given mask. This allows, an entire network of hosts to be
7842 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
7843 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
7844 significant end of the address.
7846 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
7847 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
7848 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
7849 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
7853 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
7854 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
7857 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
7859 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
7860 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
7862 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
7863 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
7866 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
7868 could make use of a file containing
7873 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
7874 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
7875 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
7877 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
7880 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
7886 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
7887 "SECThoslispatsikey"
7888 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
7889 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
7890 address, the pattern takes this form:
7892 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
7896 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
7898 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
7899 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
7900 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
7901 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
7902 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
7903 returned by the lookup is not used.
7905 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
7906 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
7907 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
7908 patterns of this form:
7910 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
7914 net24-dbm;/networks.db
7916 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
7917 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
7918 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
7919 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
7920 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
7923 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
7924 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
7925 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
7926 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
7927 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
7928 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
7929 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
7930 converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
7931 addresses are always used.
7933 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
7934 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
7935 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
7939 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
7940 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
7941 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
7942 case the IP address is used on its own.
7946 .section "Host list patterns that match by host name" "SECThoslispatnam"
7947 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
7948 .cindex "unknown host name"
7949 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
7950 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
7951 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
7952 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
7953 address to match against, as described in the section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
7956 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
7957 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
7958 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
7959 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
7960 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
7961 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
7962 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
7964 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
7965 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
7967 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
7968 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
7969 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
7970 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
7971 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
7972 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
7973 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
7974 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
7975 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
7977 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
7978 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
7980 .cindex "host" "alias for"
7981 .cindex "alias for host"
7982 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
7983 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
7986 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
7987 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
7988 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
7989 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
7990 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
7994 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
7995 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
7996 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
7997 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
7998 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
7999 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
8000 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
8006 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
8007 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
8008 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
8009 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
8010 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8012 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
8014 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
8015 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
8016 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
8023 .section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
8024 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
8025 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
8026 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
8027 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
8028 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
8031 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
8032 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
8035 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
8036 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
8037 By default, Exim behaves as if the host does not match the list. This may not
8038 always be what you want to happen. To change Exim's behaviour, the special
8039 items &`+include_unknown`& or &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at
8040 top level &-- they are not recognized in an indirected file).
8043 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
8044 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
8046 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
8048 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
8049 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
8052 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
8053 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
8056 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
8059 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
8060 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
8061 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
8064 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
8065 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
8070 .section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
8072 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
8073 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
8074 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
8075 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
8076 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
8077 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analagous to
8078 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
8079 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
8080 host lists such as whitelists.
8085 .section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
8086 "SECThoslispatnamsk"
8087 .cindex "unknown host name"
8088 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
8089 If a pattern is of the form
8091 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
8095 dbm;/host/accept/list
8097 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
8098 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
8101 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
8102 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
8103 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"& (see section
8104 &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&). There is, however, no reason why you could not use
8105 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
8106 lookup, both using the same file.
8110 .section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
8111 If a pattern is of the form
8113 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
8115 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
8116 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
8117 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
8119 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
8120 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
8122 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
8123 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
8124 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
8127 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
8128 looks up the host name if has not already done so. (See section
8129 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
8131 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
8132 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
8133 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
8134 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
8135 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
8136 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
8140 .section "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
8142 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
8143 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same
8144 host list, you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, in an
8147 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
8149 The reason for this lies in the left-to-right way that Exim processes lists.
8150 It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an
8151 item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to
8152 compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
8153 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even if its
8154 IP address is 10.9.8.7.
8156 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
8157 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
8159 accept hosts = *.friend.example
8160 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
8162 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
8163 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs.
8169 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
8170 .cindex "list" "address list"
8171 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
8172 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
8173 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
8174 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
8175 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
8176 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
8177 using this option setting:
8181 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
8182 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
8183 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
8184 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
8186 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
8189 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
8191 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
8192 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
8193 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
8194 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
8195 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
8196 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
8197 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
8199 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
8200 *@+hostile_domains:\
8201 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
8202 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
8204 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8205 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
8206 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
8207 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
8208 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
8210 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
8211 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
8212 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
8213 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
8214 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
8216 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
8219 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
8220 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
8224 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
8225 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
8226 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
8227 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
8228 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
8229 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
8230 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
8232 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
8233 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
8235 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
8236 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
8239 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
8240 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
8241 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
8244 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
8245 mysql;select address from blocked where \
8246 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
8248 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
8249 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
8250 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
8251 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
8253 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
8254 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
8256 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
8257 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
8258 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
8259 default. For example, with this lookup:
8261 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
8263 the file could contains lines like this:
8265 user1@domain1.example
8268 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
8271 nimrod@jaeger.example
8275 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
8276 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
8278 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
8280 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
8281 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
8283 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
8284 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
8285 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
8289 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
8290 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
8295 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
8296 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
8297 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
8298 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
8299 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
8300 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
8301 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
8302 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
8303 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
8305 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
8306 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
8307 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
8308 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
8309 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
8312 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
8314 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
8316 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
8318 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
8320 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
8321 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
8322 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
8323 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
8324 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
8325 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
8327 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
8330 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
8333 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
8334 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
8335 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
8336 might have entries like
8338 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
8339 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
8342 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
8343 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
8344 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
8345 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
8347 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
8348 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
8349 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
8352 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
8353 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
8354 can only return a single list of local parts.
8357 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
8358 in these two examples:
8361 senders = *@+my_list
8363 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
8364 example it is a named domain list.
8369 .section "Case of letters in address lists" "SECTcasletadd"
8370 .cindex "case of local parts"
8371 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
8372 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
8373 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
8374 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
8375 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
8376 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
8377 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
8378 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
8381 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
8382 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
8383 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
8384 the address list itself, in files included as plain file names, and in any file
8385 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
8386 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
8387 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
8390 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
8391 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
8392 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
8393 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
8394 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
8395 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
8396 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
8397 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
8401 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
8402 .cindex "list" "local part list"
8403 .cindex "local part" "list"
8404 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
8405 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
8406 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
8407 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
8408 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
8409 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
8410 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
8411 option is case-sensitive from the start.
8413 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
8414 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
8415 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
8416 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
8417 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
8418 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
8419 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
8421 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
8426 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8427 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8429 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
8430 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
8431 Many strings in Exim's run time configuration are expanded before use. Some of
8432 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
8434 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
8435 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
8436 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
8437 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
8438 escape character, as described in the following section.
8442 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
8443 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
8444 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
8445 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
8446 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
8447 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
8448 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
8449 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
8451 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
8452 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
8453 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
8454 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
8456 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
8458 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
8459 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
8464 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
8465 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
8466 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
8467 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
8468 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
8469 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
8470 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
8473 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
8474 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
8475 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
8478 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
8479 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
8480 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
8482 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
8483 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
8484 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
8485 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
8486 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
8487 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
8488 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
8491 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
8492 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
8493 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
8496 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
8497 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
8498 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
8499 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
8501 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
8503 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
8504 Exim message identifier. For example:
8506 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
8508 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
8509 is therefore restricted to admin users.
8512 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
8513 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
8514 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
8515 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
8516 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
8517 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
8518 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
8519 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
8520 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
8521 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
8522 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
8523 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
8529 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
8530 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
8531 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
8532 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
8533 white space is significant.
8536 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
8537 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
8538 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
8543 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
8544 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
8545 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
8546 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
8547 given, the expansion fails.
8549 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
8550 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
8551 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
8552 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
8556 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
8557 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
8558 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
8559 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
8560 string easier to understand.
8562 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
8563 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
8564 expansion item below.
8566 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
8567 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
8569 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
8570 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
8574 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
8575 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
8576 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
8578 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function. When compiling
8579 a local function that is to be called in this way, &_local_scan.h_& should be
8580 included. The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
8581 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
8582 must have the following type:
8584 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
8586 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
8587 function should return one of the following values:
8589 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
8590 into the expanded string that is being built.
8592 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
8593 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
8595 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
8596 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
8598 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
8600 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
8601 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
8602 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
8604 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
8605 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8606 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
8607 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
8608 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
8609 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
8610 must not consist entirely of digits. The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the
8613 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
8616 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
8617 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
8618 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
8619 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
8620 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
8621 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
8622 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
8623 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
8624 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
8626 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
8627 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
8628 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
8631 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
8632 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
8634 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
8635 appear, for example:
8637 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
8639 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
8640 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
8643 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
8644 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
8645 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
8646 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
8647 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
8648 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
8649 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
8650 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
8651 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
8652 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
8653 <&'string3'&> as before.
8655 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
8656 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
8657 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
8658 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
8659 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
8660 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
8661 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
8662 provided. For example:
8664 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8668 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
8670 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
8671 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
8674 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
8675 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
8676 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
8678 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
8679 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
8680 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
8681 evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
8682 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
8683 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
8684 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
8686 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}
8688 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
8689 to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
8692 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
8693 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
8694 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
8695 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
8696 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
8697 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
8699 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
8700 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
8701 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
8702 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
8704 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
8706 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
8707 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
8708 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
8709 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
8710 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
8712 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
8714 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
8715 letters appear. For example:
8717 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
8718 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
8719 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
8722 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8723 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
8724 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8725 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
8726 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
8727 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
8728 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
8729 .vindex "&$header_$&"
8730 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
8731 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
8732 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
8733 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
8734 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
8735 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
8739 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
8740 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
8741 lines) may be present.
8743 The difference between &%rheader%&, &%bheader%&, and &%header%& is in the way
8744 the data in the header line is interpreted.
8747 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
8748 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
8749 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
8752 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
8753 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
8754 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
8755 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
8756 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
8757 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
8758 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
8759 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
8762 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
8763 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
8764 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
8765 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
8766 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
8767 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
8770 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
8771 command of the following form:
8773 headers charset "UTF-8"
8775 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
8776 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
8777 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
8778 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
8779 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
8782 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
8783 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
8784 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
8785 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
8787 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
8788 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
8789 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
8790 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
8791 router or transport are not accessible.
8793 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in ACLs that are obeyed
8794 before the DATA ACL, because the header structure is not set up until the
8795 message is received. Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
8796 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
8797 point they are added. When a DATA ACL is running, however, header lines added
8798 by earlier ACLs are visible.
8800 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
8801 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
8802 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
8803 white space terminates the header name, it is included in the expanded string.
8804 If the message does not contain the given header, the expansion item is
8805 replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in section
8806 &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a header.)
8808 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
8809 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
8810 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
8811 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
8812 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
8813 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
8814 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
8815 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
8818 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
8819 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
8821 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
8822 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
8823 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
8824 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
8825 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
8826 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
8827 present. For example:
8829 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
8831 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
8834 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
8836 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
8837 an Exim configuration:
8839 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
8841 In a router or a transport you could then have:
8844 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
8845 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
8846 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
8848 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
8849 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
8850 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
8851 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
8852 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example by using the
8853 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
8856 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
8857 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
8858 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
8859 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
8860 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
8861 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
8863 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
8865 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
8866 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
8867 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
8868 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
8869 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
8871 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
8872 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
8873 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
8875 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
8879 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
8882 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
8883 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
8884 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
8885 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
8886 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
8887 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
8888 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
8891 ${length_<n>:<string>}
8893 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> characters or the whole
8894 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
8895 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
8898 .vitem "&*${lookup{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
8899 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
8900 This is the first of one of two different types of lookup item, which are both
8901 described in the next item.
8903 .vitem "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
8904 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
8905 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
8906 .cindex "file" "lookups"
8907 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
8908 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
8909 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
8910 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
8911 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
8913 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
8914 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
8915 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
8916 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
8917 out by the system administrator.
8920 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
8921 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
8922 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
8923 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
8924 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
8925 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
8926 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
8927 original lookup fails.
8929 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
8930 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
8931 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
8932 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
8933 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
8934 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
8935 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
8936 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
8938 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
8939 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
8940 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
8941 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
8943 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
8944 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
8945 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
8946 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
8948 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
8950 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
8952 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
8953 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
8955 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
8960 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
8961 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
8963 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
8964 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
8965 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
8966 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
8967 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
8968 setting is not included in the output. For example:
8970 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
8972 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
8973 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
8974 and &*reduce*& expansion items.
8976 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
8977 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
8978 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
8979 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
8980 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
8981 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
8982 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
8984 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
8986 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
8987 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
8988 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
8989 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
8992 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
8994 returns the string &"6/33"&.
8998 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
8999 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
9000 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
9001 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
9002 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
9003 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
9004 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
9005 name of the subroutine, is nine.
9007 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
9008 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the expansion fails in the same
9009 way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item. The return value is a scalar.
9010 Whatever you return is evaluated in a scalar context. For example, if you
9011 return the name of a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
9014 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
9015 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
9016 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
9018 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
9019 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9022 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
9023 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
9024 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
9025 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
9026 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
9027 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
9028 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
9029 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9031 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
9032 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
9033 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
9034 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
9035 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
9036 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
9037 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
9038 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
9039 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
9040 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
9042 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
9043 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
9044 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
9045 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
9047 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
9048 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
9049 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
9050 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
9051 is the expansion of the third argument.
9053 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
9054 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
9055 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
9057 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
9058 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
9059 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
9060 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
9061 The file name and end-of-line string are first expanded separately. The file is
9062 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
9063 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
9064 newlines are left in the string.
9065 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
9066 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
9067 the string expansion fails.
9069 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
9070 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9074 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
9075 {*&<&'timeout'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
9076 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
9077 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
9078 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
9079 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or Internet socket into the expanded
9080 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
9083 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
9084 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
9086 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
9087 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
9088 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
9089 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
9090 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
9093 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
9095 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
9096 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
9097 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
9098 (unless it is an empty string) and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
9099 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
9100 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
9102 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
9104 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
9105 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
9106 turns them into spaces:
9108 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
9110 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
9111 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
9112 addition, the following errors can occur:
9115 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
9117 Failure to connect the socket;
9119 Failure to write the request string;
9121 Timeout on reading from the socket.
9124 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
9125 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
9126 errors occurs. For example:
9128 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
9131 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
9132 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
9133 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
9134 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
9135 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
9137 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
9138 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9141 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9142 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
9143 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
9146 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
9147 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
9148 separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
9149 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
9150 list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
9151 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
9152 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
9153 added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
9154 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
9156 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
9158 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
9161 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
9163 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
9164 restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
9167 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9168 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9169 expansion item above.
9171 .vitem "&*${run{*&<&'command'&>&*&~*&<&'args'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
9172 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9173 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
9174 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
9175 The command and its arguments are first expanded separately, and then the
9176 command is run in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in
9177 other command executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If you want
9178 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
9180 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
9181 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
9182 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
9184 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
9185 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
9186 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
9187 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
9188 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
9191 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
9192 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
9193 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
9194 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
9197 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
9198 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
9200 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
9201 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
9205 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
9206 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
9209 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
9210 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
9211 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
9212 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
9214 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
9215 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
9218 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
9219 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
9220 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
9221 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
9222 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
9223 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
9224 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
9225 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
9227 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
9229 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
9230 if any $ or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
9231 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
9233 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
9235 yields &"defabc"&, and
9237 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
9239 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
9240 the regular expression from string expansion.
9244 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
9245 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9246 .cindex "substring extraction"
9247 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
9248 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
9249 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
9250 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
9251 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
9253 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<string>}
9255 The second number is optional (in both notations).
9256 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
9259 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
9260 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
9261 length required. For example
9263 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
9265 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
9266 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
9267 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
9268 given offset. The first character in the string has offset zero.
9270 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
9271 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last character is offset -1, the
9272 second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
9274 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
9276 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
9277 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
9278 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
9280 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
9282 yields an empty string, but
9284 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
9288 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
9289 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all characters in the
9290 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
9291 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
9294 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
9296 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
9300 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
9301 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
9302 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
9303 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
9304 This item does single-character translation on its subject string. The second
9305 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
9306 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
9307 replacement list. For example
9309 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
9311 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
9312 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
9313 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
9319 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
9320 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9321 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
9322 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
9323 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
9324 following operations can be performed:
9327 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9328 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9329 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
9330 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
9331 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
9332 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9335 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9336 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
9337 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
9338 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
9339 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
9340 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
9341 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
9342 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
9343 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
9345 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
9346 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
9347 character. For example:
9349 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
9351 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. Compare the &*address*& (singular)
9352 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
9353 address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
9357 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
9358 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
9359 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9360 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
9361 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
9362 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
9363 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive file
9364 names), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just to
9365 be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
9367 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
9368 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
9369 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
9370 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
9371 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
9372 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
9375 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9376 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
9377 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
9378 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
9379 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
9382 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9383 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
9384 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
9385 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
9386 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
9387 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
9388 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
9391 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9392 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
9393 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
9394 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
9395 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
9396 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
9397 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
9398 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
9399 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
9400 C programming language):
9402 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
9403 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
9404 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
9405 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
9408 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
9410 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
9411 space is permitted before or after operators.
9413 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
9414 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
9415 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
9416 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
9417 times, which often do have leading zeros.
9419 A number may be followed by &"K"& or &"M"& to multiply it by 1024 or 1024*1024,
9420 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
9421 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"& or &"M"&). For example:
9424 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
9425 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
9426 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
9427 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
9428 &`${eval:0xc&5} `& yields 4
9429 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
9430 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
9431 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
9432 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
9433 &`${eval:~255&0x1234} `& yields 4608
9434 &`${eval:-(~255&0x1234)} `& yields -4608
9437 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
9439 deny message = Too many bad recipients
9442 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
9445 {$recipients_count} \
9446 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
9450 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
9451 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
9454 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9455 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
9456 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
9459 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
9461 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
9462 and then re-expands what it has found.
9465 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9467 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
9468 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
9469 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
9470 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
9471 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
9472 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
9473 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
9474 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
9475 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
9477 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
9478 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
9479 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
9480 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
9481 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
9482 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
9483 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
9486 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9487 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
9488 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
9489 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
9490 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
9491 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9493 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
9495 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
9496 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
9500 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
9501 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
9502 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
9503 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
9504 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
9505 be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
9508 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9509 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
9510 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
9511 .cindex "lower casing"
9512 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
9513 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
9514 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
9519 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9520 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
9521 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
9522 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
9523 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
9524 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
9526 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
9528 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
9529 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
9530 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
9533 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9534 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
9535 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
9536 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
9537 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
9541 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
9542 .cindex "masked IP address"
9543 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
9544 .cindex "CIDR notation"
9545 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
9546 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
9547 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
9548 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
9549 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
9550 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
9551 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
9553 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
9555 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&. Since this operation is expected to
9556 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the result for an IPv6
9557 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
9558 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
9560 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
9564 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
9566 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
9569 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9571 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
9572 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
9573 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
9574 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
9577 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9578 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
9579 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
9580 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
9581 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
9582 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9584 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
9586 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
9589 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9590 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
9591 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
9592 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
9593 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
9594 is an empty string or
9595 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
9596 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
9597 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
9598 respectively For example,
9606 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
9607 variable or a message header.
9609 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9610 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
9611 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
9612 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
9613 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
9614 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
9615 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
9618 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9619 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
9620 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
9621 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
9622 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
9624 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
9630 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
9631 yields an unchanged string.
9634 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9635 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
9636 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
9637 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
9638 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
9639 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
9640 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
9641 &%headers_charset%& option, which defaults to ISO-8859-1. If the string
9642 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
9645 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
9647 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
9648 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
9652 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9653 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
9654 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
9655 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
9656 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
9657 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
9658 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
9659 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
9662 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
9663 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
9664 to use this operator as well.
9669 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9670 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
9671 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
9672 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
9673 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
9674 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
9675 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
9678 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9679 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
9680 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
9681 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
9682 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
9683 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
9686 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9687 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
9688 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
9689 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
9690 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
9691 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
9692 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
9693 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
9694 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
9695 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
9696 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
9697 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
9698 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
9700 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
9701 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
9702 systems for files larger than 2GB.
9704 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9705 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
9706 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
9707 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
9708 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
9712 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9713 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
9714 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
9715 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
9716 The item is replace by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
9717 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
9720 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9721 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
9722 .cindex "substring extraction"
9723 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
9724 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
9725 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
9726 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
9728 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
9730 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
9731 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
9733 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9734 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
9735 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
9736 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
9739 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9740 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
9741 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
9742 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
9743 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
9744 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
9747 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9748 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
9749 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
9750 .cindex "upper casing"
9751 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
9752 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
9753 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
9761 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
9762 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
9763 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
9764 while expanding strings:
9767 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
9768 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
9769 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
9770 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
9773 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9774 .cindex "numeric comparison"
9775 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
9776 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
9782 &`>= `& greater or equal
9784 &`<= `& less or equal
9788 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
9790 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
9791 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
9792 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"& or &"M"& (in either upper or
9793 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024 or 1024*1024, respectively.
9794 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
9797 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9798 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
9799 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
9800 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
9801 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
9802 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
9803 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
9804 included in the binary.
9806 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
9807 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
9808 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
9809 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
9810 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
9811 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
9812 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
9813 string in LDAP form is:
9815 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
9817 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
9818 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
9820 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
9822 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
9827 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
9828 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
9829 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
9830 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
9831 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
9832 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
9836 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
9837 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
9838 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
9839 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
9840 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
9841 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
9844 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
9845 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
9846 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
9847 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
9848 whatever its length.
9851 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
9852 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
9853 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
9854 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
9856 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
9857 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
9858 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
9859 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
9860 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
9861 support &[crypt16()]&.
9863 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
9864 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
9865 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
9866 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
9867 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
9869 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
9870 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
9871 Exim is seen as very low priority.
9873 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
9874 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
9875 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
9876 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
9877 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
9879 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
9880 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
9881 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
9882 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
9883 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
9884 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
9886 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
9888 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
9889 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
9891 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
9892 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
9893 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
9894 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
9895 exists in the message. For example,
9897 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
9899 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
9900 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
9902 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
9903 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9904 .cindex "string" "comparison"
9905 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
9906 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
9907 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
9908 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
9909 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
9910 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
9912 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
9913 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
9914 .cindex "file" "existence test"
9915 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
9916 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
9917 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
9918 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
9919 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
9921 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
9922 .cindex "delivery" "first"
9923 .cindex "first delivery"
9924 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
9925 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
9926 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
9927 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
9930 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
9931 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
9932 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
9933 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
9934 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
9936 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
9937 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
9938 the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
9939 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
9940 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
9942 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
9943 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
9944 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
9946 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
9947 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
9948 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
9950 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
9951 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
9952 that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
9953 list separator is changed to a comma:
9955 ${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
9957 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
9958 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
9961 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
9962 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9963 .cindex "string" "comparison"
9964 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
9965 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
9966 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
9967 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
9968 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
9969 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
9972 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
9973 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
9974 .cindex "string" "comparison"
9975 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
9976 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
9977 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
9978 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
9979 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
9980 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
9983 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
9984 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
9985 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9986 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
9987 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
9988 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
9989 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
9990 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
9991 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
9992 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
9993 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
9996 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
9997 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
9998 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
9999 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
10000 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
10002 &*Note*&: The checks are just on the form of the address; actual numerical
10003 values are not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passes the IPv4
10004 check. The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
10005 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
10007 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
10009 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
10012 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
10013 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
10014 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
10015 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
10016 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
10017 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
10018 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
10019 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
10020 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
10021 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
10022 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
10023 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
10024 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
10028 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10029 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10030 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10031 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10032 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
10033 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
10034 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10035 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
10036 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
10039 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
10040 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10041 .cindex "string" "comparison"
10042 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
10043 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
10044 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
10045 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
10046 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
10047 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
10051 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10052 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
10053 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
10054 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
10055 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
10056 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
10057 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
10058 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
10059 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
10060 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
10061 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
10064 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
10066 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
10067 backslashes is also required.
10069 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
10070 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
10071 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
10072 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
10073 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
10074 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
10076 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
10077 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
10078 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
10079 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
10080 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
10081 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
10082 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
10083 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
10085 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10086 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
10087 See &*match_local_part*&.
10089 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10090 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
10091 See &*match_local_part*&.
10093 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10094 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
10095 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
10096 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
10097 address or an empty string. The second (after expansion) is a restricted host
10098 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
10100 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
10102 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
10105 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
10107 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
10109 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
10110 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
10111 in a single test such as
10112 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
10113 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
10114 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
10115 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
10117 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
10119 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
10121 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
10123 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
10124 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
10125 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
10126 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
10127 masks. For example:
10129 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
10131 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
10132 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
10133 address mask, for example:
10135 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
10137 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
10138 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
10140 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
10144 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
10146 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10147 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
10148 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
10149 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
10150 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
10151 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
10152 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
10153 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
10156 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
10158 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
10159 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument (after
10160 expansion) is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
10161 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
10163 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
10165 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
10166 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
10167 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
10168 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
10171 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
10172 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
10173 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
10174 matched using &%match_ip%&.
10176 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
10177 .cindex "PAM authentication"
10178 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
10179 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
10180 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
10181 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
10182 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
10183 (&url(http://www.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
10184 available in the latest releases of Solaris and in some GNU/Linux
10185 distributions. The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
10186 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
10190 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
10191 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
10193 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
10194 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
10195 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
10196 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
10197 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
10198 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
10199 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
10201 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
10202 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
10203 separators. If the data is being inserted from a variable, the &%sg%& expansion
10204 item can be used to double any existing colons. For example, the configuration
10205 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
10207 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${sg{$auth2}{:}{::}}}}
10209 For a PLAIN authenticator you could use:
10211 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth2:${sg{$auth3}{:}{::}}}}
10213 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
10214 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
10215 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
10216 A patched version of the &'pam_unix'& module that comes with the
10217 Linux PAM package is available from &url(http://www.e-admin.de/pam_exim/).
10218 The patched module allows one special uid/gid combination, in addition to root,
10219 to authenticate. If you build the patched module to allow the Exim user and
10220 group, PAM can then be used from an Exim authenticator.
10223 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
10224 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
10226 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
10227 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
10228 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
10229 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
10230 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
10231 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
10233 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10234 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10235 building Exim. For example:
10237 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
10239 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10240 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10241 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
10242 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
10244 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
10245 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
10246 configuration, you might have this:
10248 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
10250 .vitem &*queue_running*&
10251 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
10252 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
10253 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
10254 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
10255 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
10258 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
10260 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
10261 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
10262 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
10263 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
10264 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
10267 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
10268 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
10269 this library, you need to set
10271 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
10273 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
10274 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
10276 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
10278 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
10279 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
10280 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
10282 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
10283 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
10284 the authentication is successful. For example:
10286 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
10290 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
10291 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
10292 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
10294 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
10295 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
10296 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
10297 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
10298 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
10299 by a process that is not running as root.
10301 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
10302 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
10303 building Exim. For example:
10305 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
10307 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
10308 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
10309 from the Cyrus SASL library.
10311 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
10312 two are mandatory. For example:
10314 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
10316 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
10317 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
10318 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
10323 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
10324 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
10325 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
10326 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
10327 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
10328 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
10329 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
10333 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
10334 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
10335 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
10336 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
10337 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
10340 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
10342 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
10343 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
10344 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
10346 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
10347 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
10348 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
10349 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
10350 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
10351 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
10352 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
10353 parsed but not evaluated.
10355 .ecindex IIDexpcond
10360 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
10361 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
10362 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
10363 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
10364 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
10367 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
10368 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
10369 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
10370 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
10371 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
10372 However, they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
10373 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
10374 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
10375 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
10376 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
10377 matching condition.
10379 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
10380 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
10381 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
10382 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
10383 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
10384 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
10385 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
10386 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
10387 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
10388 during subsequent delivery.
10390 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
10391 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
10392 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
10393 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
10394 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
10395 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
10396 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
10397 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
10400 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
10401 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
10402 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
10403 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
10404 be preserved by coding like this:
10406 warn !verify = sender
10407 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
10409 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
10410 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
10413 .vitem &$address_data$&
10414 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
10415 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
10416 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
10417 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
10418 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
10419 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
10422 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
10423 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
10424 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
10425 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
10426 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
10427 from the child's routing.
10429 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
10430 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
10431 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
10434 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
10435 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
10436 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
10438 .vitem &$address_file$&
10439 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
10440 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
10441 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
10442 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
10443 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
10445 /home/r2d2/savemail
10447 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
10448 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
10449 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
10450 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
10451 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
10452 to the relevant file.
10454 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
10455 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
10456 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
10457 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
10459 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
10460 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
10461 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
10462 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPspa>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
10464 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
10465 .cindex "authentication" "id"
10466 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
10467 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
10468 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
10469 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
10470 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
10471 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
10472 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
10473 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
10474 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
10475 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
10476 command line option.
10481 .vitem &$authenticated_sender$&
10482 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
10483 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
10484 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
10485 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
10486 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
10487 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
10488 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
10489 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
10490 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
10491 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
10493 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
10494 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
10495 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
10496 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
10497 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
10500 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
10501 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
10502 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
10503 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
10504 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
10505 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
10506 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
10507 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
10508 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&). Failure includes any
10509 negative response to an AUTH command, including (for example) an attempt to use
10510 an undefined mechanism.
10512 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
10513 .cindex "message body" "line count"
10514 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
10515 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
10516 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
10517 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
10519 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
10520 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
10521 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
10522 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
10523 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
10524 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
10525 number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
10527 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
10528 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
10529 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
10530 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
10531 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
10533 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
10534 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
10535 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
10536 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
10537 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
10539 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
10540 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
10541 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
10542 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
10543 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
10544 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
10545 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
10547 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
10548 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
10549 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
10550 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
10551 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
10552 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
10553 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
10555 .vitem &$compile_date$&
10556 .vindex "&$compile_date$&"
10557 The date on which the Exim binary was compiled.
10559 .vitem &$compile_number$&
10560 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
10561 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
10562 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
10563 compilations of the same version of the program.
10565 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
10566 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
10567 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with
10568 the content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For
10569 details, see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10571 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
10572 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
10573 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
10574 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
10575 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10578 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
10579 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
10580 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
10582 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
10583 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
10584 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
10585 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
10586 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
10587 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
10588 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
10589 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
10590 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
10594 .vindex "&$domain$&"
10595 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
10596 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
10597 case for &$domain$&.
10599 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
10600 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
10601 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
10602 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
10604 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
10605 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
10606 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
10607 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
10608 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
10609 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
10611 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
10612 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
10613 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
10615 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
10618 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
10619 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
10620 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
10621 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
10622 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
10623 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
10624 the &(smtp)& transport.
10627 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
10628 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
10629 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
10630 rewrite domains by file lookup.
10633 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
10634 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
10635 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
10636 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
10637 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
10638 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
10641 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
10642 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
10643 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
10644 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
10648 .vitem &$domain_data$&
10649 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
10650 When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
10651 means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
10652 of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
10653 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
10654 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
10657 &$domain_data$& is also set when the &%domains%& condition in an ACL matches a
10658 domain by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is available during
10659 the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this variable expands
10662 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
10663 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
10664 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
10666 .vitem &$exim_path$&
10667 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
10668 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
10670 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
10671 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
10672 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
10674 .vitem &$found_extension$&
10675 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
10676 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
10677 content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
10678 see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
10680 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
10681 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
10682 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
10683 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
10684 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
10688 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
10689 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
10690 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
10691 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
10692 by a setting on the transport itself.
10694 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
10695 of the environment variable HOME.
10699 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
10700 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
10701 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
10702 to local and remote transports.
10704 .cindex "transport" "filter"
10705 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
10706 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
10707 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
10708 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
10709 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
10710 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
10713 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
10714 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
10715 client is connected.
10718 .vitem &$host_address$&
10719 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
10720 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
10721 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
10722 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
10724 .vitem &$host_data$&
10725 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
10726 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
10727 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
10728 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
10730 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
10731 message = $host_data
10733 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
10734 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
10735 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
10736 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
10737 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
10738 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
10739 variables is set to &"1"&.
10742 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
10743 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
10746 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
10747 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
10748 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
10751 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
10752 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
10753 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
10754 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
10755 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
10756 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
10757 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
10758 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
10759 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
10760 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
10762 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
10763 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
10764 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
10768 .vindex "&$inode$&"
10769 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
10770 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
10771 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
10772 a unique name for the file.
10774 .vitem &$interface_address$&
10775 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
10776 This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
10778 .vitem &$interface_port$&
10779 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
10780 This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
10784 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
10785 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*man*&, and
10786 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
10790 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
10791 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
10792 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
10795 .vitem &$load_average$&
10796 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
10797 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
10798 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
10799 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
10801 .vitem &$local_part$&
10802 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
10803 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
10804 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
10805 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
10806 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
10808 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
10809 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
10810 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
10811 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
10814 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
10815 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
10816 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
10817 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
10818 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
10819 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
10821 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
10822 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
10823 the parent address, not to the file name or command (see &$address_file$& and
10826 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
10827 local part of the recipient address.
10829 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
10830 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
10831 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
10833 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
10836 "abc:xyz"@test.example
10837 abc\:xyz@test.example
10839 the value of &$local_part$& is
10843 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
10844 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
10847 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
10849 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
10850 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
10851 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
10853 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
10854 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
10855 When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
10856 lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
10857 router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
10858 to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the transport is
10859 handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is used.
10861 &$local_part_data$& is also set when the &%local_parts%& condition in an ACL
10862 matches a local part by means of a lookup. The data read by the lookup is
10863 available during the rest of the ACL statement. In all other situations, this
10864 variable expands to nothing.
10866 .vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
10867 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
10868 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
10869 specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
10870 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
10872 .vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
10873 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
10874 When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
10875 specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
10876 variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
10878 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
10879 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
10880 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
10881 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
10883 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
10884 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
10885 See &$local_user_uid$&.
10887 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
10888 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
10889 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
10890 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
10891 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
10892 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
10893 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
10894 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
10896 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
10897 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
10898 This contains the expanded value of the
10899 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
10902 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
10903 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
10904 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
10905 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
10906 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
10907 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
10909 .vitem &$log_space$&
10910 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
10911 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
10912 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
10913 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
10914 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
10915 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
10918 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
10919 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
10920 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
10921 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
10922 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
10923 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
10924 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
10927 .vitem &$malware_name$&
10928 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
10929 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
10930 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
10931 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
10934 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
10935 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
10936 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
10937 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
10938 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
10939 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
10943 .vitem &$message_age$&
10944 .cindex "message" "age of"
10945 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
10946 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
10947 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
10950 .vitem &$message_body$&
10951 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
10952 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
10953 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
10954 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
10955 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
10956 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
10957 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
10958 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
10959 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
10962 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
10963 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
10964 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
10965 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
10966 zeros are always converted into spaces.
10969 .vitem &$message_body_end$&
10970 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
10971 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
10972 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
10973 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
10974 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
10977 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
10978 .cindex "body of message" "size"
10979 .cindex "message body" "size"
10980 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
10981 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
10982 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
10983 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
10984 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
10986 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
10987 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
10988 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
10989 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
10990 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
10991 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
10992 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
10993 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
10995 .vitem &$message_headers$&
10996 .vindex &$message_headers$&
10997 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
10998 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
10999 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
11000 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
11002 .vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
11003 .vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
11004 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
11005 contents of header lines is done.
11007 .vitem &$message_id$&
11008 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&, which is now deprecated.
11010 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
11011 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
11012 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
11013 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
11014 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
11015 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
11016 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
11017 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
11018 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
11019 from the body is not counted. Here is an example of the use of this variable in
11022 deny message = Too many lines in message header
11024 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
11026 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
11027 message has not yet been received.
11029 .vitem &$message_size$&
11030 .cindex "size" "of message"
11031 .cindex "message" "size"
11032 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
11033 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
11034 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
11035 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
11036 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
11037 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
11038 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
11039 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
11040 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
11042 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
11043 While running an ACL at the time of an SMTP RCPT command, &$message_size$&
11044 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
11045 value may not, of course, be truthful.
11047 .vitem &$mime_$&&'xxx'&
11048 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
11049 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
11050 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
11052 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
11053 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
11054 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
11056 .vitem &$original_domain$&
11057 .vindex "&$domain$&"
11058 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
11059 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11060 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
11061 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
11062 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
11063 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
11064 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
11065 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
11067 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11068 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11069 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11071 .vitem &$original_local_part$&
11072 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
11073 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
11074 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
11075 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
11076 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
11077 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
11078 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
11079 the original address.
11081 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
11082 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
11083 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
11084 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
11085 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
11087 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
11088 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
11089 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
11091 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
11092 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
11093 .cindex "sender" "gid"
11094 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
11095 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
11096 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
11097 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
11098 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
11099 normally the gid of the Exim user.
11101 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
11102 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
11103 .cindex "sender" "uid"
11104 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
11105 .vindex "&$originaltor_uid$&"
11106 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
11107 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
11108 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
11111 .vitem &$parent_domain$&
11112 .vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
11113 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
11114 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11116 .vitem &$parent_local_part$&
11117 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
11118 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
11119 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
11122 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
11124 This variable contains the current process id.
11126 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
11127 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
11128 .cindex "transport" "filter"
11129 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
11130 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
11131 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
11132 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
11133 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
11134 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
11135 variable"& error if encountered.
11137 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
11138 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
11139 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
11140 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
11141 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
11142 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
11143 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
11146 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$&
11147 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11148 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11149 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11151 .vitem &$prvscheck_keynum$&
11152 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11153 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11154 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11156 .vitem &$prvscheck_result$&
11157 This variable is used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
11158 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
11159 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
11161 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
11162 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
11163 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
11165 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
11166 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
11167 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
11168 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
11170 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
11171 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
11172 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11173 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
11174 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
11176 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
11177 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
11178 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
11179 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11180 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11181 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
11183 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
11184 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
11185 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
11186 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
11187 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
11189 .vitem &$received_count$&
11190 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
11191 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
11192 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
11193 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
11196 .vitem &$received_for$&
11197 .vindex "&$received_for$&"
11198 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
11199 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
11200 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
11201 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
11203 .vitem &$received_ip_address$&
11204 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
11205 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
11206 variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
11207 is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
11208 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
11209 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
11212 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
11213 could be used, for example, to make the file name for a TLS certificate depend
11214 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
11215 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
11216 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
11219 &*Note:*& There are no equivalent variables for outgoing connections, because
11220 the values are unknown (unless they are explicitly set by options of the
11221 &(smtp)& transport).
11223 .vitem &$received_port$&
11224 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
11225 See &$received_ip_address$&.
11227 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
11228 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
11229 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
11230 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
11231 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
11232 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
11233 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
11234 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
11235 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
11237 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
11238 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
11239 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
11240 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
11241 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
11242 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
11244 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
11245 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
11246 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
11248 .vitem &$received_time$&
11249 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
11250 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
11251 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
11253 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
11254 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
11255 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
11256 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
11257 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
11259 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
11260 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
11262 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
11263 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
11264 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
11265 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
11267 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
11268 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
11269 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
11270 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
11273 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
11274 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
11277 &"route"&: Routing failed.
11280 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
11281 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
11285 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
11288 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
11291 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
11292 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
11294 .vitem &$recipients$&
11295 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
11296 This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
11297 a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
11298 is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
11299 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
11303 In a system filter file.
11305 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
11306 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
11307 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
11308 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
11310 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
11314 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
11315 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
11316 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
11317 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
11318 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
11319 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
11322 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
11323 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
11324 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
11325 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
11328 .vitem &$reply_address$&
11329 .vindex "&$reply_address$&"
11330 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
11331 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
11332 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
11333 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
11334 decoding or character code translation takes place.
11336 .vitem &$return_path$&
11337 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
11338 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
11339 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
11340 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
11341 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
11342 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
11343 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
11344 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
11345 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
11346 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
11349 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
11350 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
11351 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
11354 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
11355 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
11356 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
11357 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
11358 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
11359 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
11360 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
11363 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
11364 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
11365 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
11366 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
11367 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
11368 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
11369 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
11370 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
11372 .vitem &$sender_address$&
11373 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
11374 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
11375 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
11376 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
11377 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
11379 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
11380 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
11381 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
11382 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
11383 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
11384 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
11385 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
11386 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
11388 .vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
11389 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
11390 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
11392 .vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
11393 .vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
11394 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
11396 .vitem &$sender_data$&
11397 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
11398 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
11399 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
11400 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
11403 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
11404 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
11406 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
11407 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
11408 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
11409 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
11411 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
11412 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
11413 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
11414 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
11415 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
11416 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
11417 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
11418 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
11419 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
11420 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
11421 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
11422 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
11423 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
11425 .vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
11426 .vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
11427 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
11428 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
11429 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
11430 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
11432 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
11433 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
11434 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains that
11435 host's IP address. For locally submitted messages, it is empty.
11437 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
11438 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
11439 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
11440 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
11441 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
11442 &$authenticated_id$&.
11444 .vitem &$sender_host_name$&
11445 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
11446 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
11447 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
11448 other means, this variable is empty.
11450 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
11451 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
11452 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
11453 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
11454 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
11455 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
11456 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
11458 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
11459 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
11460 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
11461 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
11463 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
11464 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
11465 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
11468 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
11469 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
11470 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
11471 following are true:
11474 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
11476 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
11477 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
11478 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
11480 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
11481 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
11482 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
11484 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
11485 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
11486 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
11488 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
11489 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
11490 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
11491 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
11493 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
11495 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
11496 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
11500 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
11501 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
11502 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
11503 number that was used on the remote host.
11505 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
11506 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
11507 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
11508 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
11509 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
11512 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
11513 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
11514 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
11515 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
11517 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
11518 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
11519 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
11520 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
11521 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
11522 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
11523 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
11524 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
11525 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
11526 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
11527 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
11530 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
11531 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
11532 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
11533 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
11534 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
11536 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
11537 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
11538 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
11539 about the failure. The details are the same as for
11540 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
11542 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
11543 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
11544 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
11545 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
11546 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
11547 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
11548 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
11550 .vitem &$sending_port$&
11551 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
11552 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
11553 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
11554 connections, see &$received_port$&.
11556 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
11557 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
11558 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
11559 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
11560 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
11561 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
11563 .vitem &$smtp_command$&
11564 .vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
11565 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
11566 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
11567 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
11572 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
11573 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
11574 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
11575 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
11577 .vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
11578 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
11579 .vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
11580 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
11581 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
11582 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
11583 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
11585 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
11586 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
11587 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
11588 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
11589 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
11590 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
11591 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
11592 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
11593 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
11594 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
11595 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
11597 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
11598 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
11599 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
11600 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
11601 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
11602 message is junk mail.
11604 .vitem &$spam_$&&'xxx'&
11605 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
11606 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
11607 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
11610 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
11611 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
11612 The name of Exim's spool directory.
11614 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
11615 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
11616 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
11617 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
11618 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
11619 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
11621 .vitem &$spool_space$&
11622 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
11623 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
11624 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
11625 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
11626 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
11627 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
11628 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
11630 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
11632 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
11635 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
11636 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
11637 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
11638 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
11639 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
11640 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
11642 .vitem &$tls_certificate_verified$&
11643 .vindex "&$tls_certificate_verified$&"
11644 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
11645 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
11647 .vitem &$tls_cipher$&
11649 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
11650 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
11651 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
11652 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
11653 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
11654 &$tls_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
11655 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
11657 The &$tls_cipher$& variable retains its value during message delivery, except
11658 when an outward SMTP delivery takes place via the &(smtp)& transport. In this
11659 case, &$tls_cipher$& is cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
11660 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
11661 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
11662 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
11665 .vitem &$tls_peerdn$&
11666 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
11667 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
11668 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
11669 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
11670 &$tls_peerdn$& during subsequent processing. &new("Like &$tls_cipher$&, the
11671 value is retained during message delivery, except during outbound SMTP
11674 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
11675 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
11676 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
11677 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
11679 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
11680 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
11681 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
11683 .vitem &$tod_full$&
11684 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
11685 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
11686 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
11687 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
11688 values for those that are behind (west).
11691 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
11692 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
11693 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
11695 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
11696 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
11697 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
11698 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
11701 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
11702 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
11703 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
11706 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
11707 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
11708 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
11709 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
11712 .vindex "&$value$&"
11713 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
11714 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
11715 &*reduce*& expansion.
11717 .vitem &$version_number$&
11718 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
11719 The version number of Exim.
11721 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
11722 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
11723 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
11724 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
11726 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
11727 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
11728 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
11729 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
11735 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11736 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11738 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
11739 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
11740 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
11741 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
11742 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
11743 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
11748 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
11751 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
11752 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
11753 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
11754 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
11755 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
11756 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
11757 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
11758 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
11759 a newly created Perl interpreter.
11761 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
11762 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
11763 should usually be something like
11765 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
11767 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
11768 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
11769 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
11770 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
11771 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
11772 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
11773 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
11774 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
11778 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
11779 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
11780 a startup when Exim is entered.
11782 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
11783 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
11786 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
11787 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
11790 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
11791 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
11792 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
11793 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
11797 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
11798 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
11800 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
11801 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
11802 with an error message of the form
11804 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
11806 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
11807 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
11808 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
11809 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
11810 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
11811 that was passed to &%die%&.
11814 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
11815 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
11816 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
11819 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
11821 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
11822 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
11823 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
11825 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
11826 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
11827 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
11828 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
11830 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
11831 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
11832 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
11833 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
11834 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
11835 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
11836 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
11839 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
11840 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
11841 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
11842 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
11843 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
11844 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
11845 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
11846 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
11847 avoided, but the output is lost.
11849 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
11850 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
11851 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
11852 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
11853 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
11854 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
11855 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
11857 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
11859 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
11860 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
11861 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
11862 as the first subroutine argument.
11866 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11867 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
11869 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
11870 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
11871 "Starting the daemon"
11872 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
11873 .cindex "interface" "listening"
11874 .cindex "network interface"
11875 .cindex "interface" "network"
11876 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
11877 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
11878 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
11879 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
11880 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
11881 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
11882 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
11883 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
11884 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
11885 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
11886 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
11889 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
11890 and ports to listen on.
11892 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
11893 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
11894 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
11895 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
11896 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
11897 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
11898 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
11899 as an error situation.
11901 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
11902 for the outgoing connection.
11906 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
11907 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
11908 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
11909 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
11910 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
11912 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
11913 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
11914 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
11915 chapter describes how they operate.
11917 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
11918 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
11922 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
11923 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
11924 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
11928 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports. (For backward
11929 compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
11931 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
11932 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
11935 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
11936 described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
11937 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
11938 colons. For example:
11940 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
11943 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
11945 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
11946 in &%local_interfaces%&:
11949 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
11950 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
11952 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
11953 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
11956 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
11957 with a colon separator, for example:
11959 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
11960 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
11964 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
11965 default setting contains just one port:
11967 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
11969 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
11970 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
11971 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
11972 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
11973 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
11977 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
11978 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
11979 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
11980 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
11981 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
11982 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
11984 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
11986 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
11988 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
11990 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
11994 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
11995 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
11996 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
11997 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
11998 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
11999 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
12002 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
12003 changed in the usual way if required. If there are any items that do not
12004 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
12005 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
12006 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
12007 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
12011 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
12014 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
12016 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
12017 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
12018 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
12022 .section "Support for the obsolete SSMTP (or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
12023 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
12024 .cindex "smtps protocol"
12025 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
12026 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
12027 Exim supports the obsolete SSMTP protocol (also known as SMTPS) that was used
12028 before the STARTTLS command was standardized for SMTP. Some legacy clients
12029 still use this protocol. If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a
12030 list of port numbers, connections to those ports must use SSMTP. The most
12031 common use of this option is expected to be
12033 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
12035 because 465 is the usual port number used by the legacy clients. There is also
12036 a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports to behave in
12037 this way when a daemon is started.
12039 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
12040 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
12041 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
12042 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
12043 connections via the daemon.)
12048 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
12049 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
12050 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
12051 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
12052 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
12053 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
12054 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
12055 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
12057 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
12059 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
12060 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
12061 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
12062 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
12063 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
12064 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
12066 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
12068 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
12069 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
12070 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
12071 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
12072 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
12074 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
12075 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
12076 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
12077 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
12078 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
12079 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
12080 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
12081 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
12082 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
12083 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
12084 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
12085 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
12087 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
12088 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
12089 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
12090 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
12091 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
12095 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
12096 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
12098 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
12099 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12101 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
12102 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
12103 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
12104 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
12106 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
12108 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
12110 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
12112 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
12113 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
12115 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
12116 IPv4 loopback address only:
12118 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
12120 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
12122 local_interfaces = 192.168.34.67 : 192.168.34.67
12124 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
12128 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
12129 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
12130 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
12131 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
12134 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
12135 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
12136 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
12137 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
12139 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
12140 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
12141 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
12142 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
12143 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
12144 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
12145 used for listening. Consider this example:
12147 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
12149 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
12151 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
12153 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
12154 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
12157 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
12158 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
12159 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
12160 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
12161 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
12162 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
12163 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
12164 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
12168 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
12169 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
12170 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
12171 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
12172 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
12173 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
12179 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12180 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
12182 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
12183 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
12184 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
12185 The first part of the run time configuration file contains three types of item:
12188 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
12189 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
12191 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
12192 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
12193 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
12195 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
12196 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
12197 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
12198 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
12202 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
12203 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
12204 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
12205 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
12206 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
12207 listed in more than one group.
12209 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
12211 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
12212 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
12213 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
12214 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
12215 .row &new(&%message_body_newlines%&) "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
12216 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
12217 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
12218 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
12219 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
12223 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
12225 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
12226 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12227 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
12228 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
12229 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
12230 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
12235 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
12237 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
12238 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
12239 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
12240 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
12241 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
12242 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
12243 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
12244 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
12245 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
12246 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
12247 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
12252 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
12254 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
12255 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12256 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
12257 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
12258 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
12259 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
12260 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
12261 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
12262 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
12263 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
12264 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
12265 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
12270 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
12272 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
12273 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
12274 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
12275 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
12280 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
12282 .row &new(&%ibase_servers%&) "InterBase servers"
12283 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
12284 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
12285 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
12286 .row &new(&%mysql_servers%&) "default MySQL servers"
12287 .row &new(&%oracle_servers%&) "Oracle servers"
12288 .row &new(&%pgsql_servers%&) "default PostgreSQL servers"
12289 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
12294 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
12296 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
12297 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
12302 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
12304 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
12305 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
12310 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
12312 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
12313 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
12314 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
12315 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
12316 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
12317 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
12318 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
12323 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
12325 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
12326 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
12327 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
12328 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
12329 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
12330 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
12331 .row &new(&%queue_only_load_latch%&) "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
12332 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
12333 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
12334 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
12335 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
12336 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
12337 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
12338 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
12339 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
12340 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
12342 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
12343 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
12344 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
12345 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
12346 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
12351 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
12353 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
12354 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
12355 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
12356 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
12357 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
12358 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
12359 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
12360 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
12361 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
12362 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
12363 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
12364 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
12365 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
12366 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
12367 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
12368 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
12369 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
12370 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
12371 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
12373 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
12374 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
12375 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
12376 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
12377 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
12378 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
12379 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
12380 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
12381 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
12382 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
12383 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
12384 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
12385 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
12386 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
12387 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
12388 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
12389 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
12390 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
12395 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
12397 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
12399 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
12401 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
12402 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
12403 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
12408 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
12410 .row &%gnutls_require_kx%& "control GnuTLS key exchanges"
12411 .row &%gnutls_require_mac%& "control GnuTLS MAC algorithms"
12412 .row &%gnutls_require_protocols%& "control GnuTLS protocols"
12413 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
12414 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
12415 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
12416 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
12417 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
12418 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
12419 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
12420 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
12421 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
12422 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
12423 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
12428 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
12430 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
12431 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
12432 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
12433 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
12434 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
12435 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
12436 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
12437 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
12442 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
12444 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
12445 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
12446 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
12447 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
12448 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
12449 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
12450 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
12451 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
12457 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
12459 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
12466 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
12467 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
12470 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
12471 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
12472 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
12473 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
12474 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
12475 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
12476 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
12477 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
12478 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
12479 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
12480 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
12481 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
12482 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
12483 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
12485 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
12486 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
12487 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
12488 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
12489 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
12490 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
12491 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
12492 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
12493 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
12494 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
12495 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
12496 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
12497 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
12498 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
12499 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
12500 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
12505 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
12507 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
12508 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
12509 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
12510 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
12511 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
12512 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
12517 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
12519 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
12520 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
12521 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
12522 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
12524 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12525 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12526 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
12527 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
12528 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
12529 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
12530 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
12531 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
12532 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
12533 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
12538 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
12540 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
12541 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
12543 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
12544 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
12545 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
12546 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
12547 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
12552 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
12554 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
12555 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
12556 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
12557 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
12558 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
12559 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
12560 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
12561 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
12562 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
12563 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
12564 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
12565 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
12566 .row &new(&%queue_only_load_latch%&) "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
12567 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
12568 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
12569 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
12570 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
12571 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
12572 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
12573 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
12574 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
12579 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
12581 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
12582 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
12583 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
12584 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
12585 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
12586 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
12587 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
12588 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
12589 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
12590 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
12591 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
12592 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
12593 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
12594 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
12599 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
12600 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
12603 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean false
12605 .cindex "8-bit characters"
12606 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
12607 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
12608 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
12609 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
12610 Consequently, this option is turned off by default.
12612 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
12613 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
12614 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
12615 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
12616 read and is on the point of being accepted. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
12619 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
12620 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
12621 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
12624 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
12625 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
12626 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
12627 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
12628 non-SMTP message. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12630 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
12631 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
12632 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
12633 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
12634 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12636 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
12637 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
12638 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
12639 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12641 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
12642 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
12643 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
12644 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
12645 acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12647 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
12648 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
12649 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
12650 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12652 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
12653 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
12654 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
12655 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12657 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
12658 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
12659 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
12660 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
12661 command is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12664 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
12665 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
12666 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
12667 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12669 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
12670 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
12671 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
12672 a MAIL command. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs, and chapter
12673 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
12675 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
12676 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
12677 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
12678 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
12679 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
12681 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
12682 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
12683 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
12686 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
12687 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
12688 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
12689 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12691 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
12692 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
12693 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
12694 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12696 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
12697 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
12698 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
12699 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12701 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
12702 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
12703 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
12704 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
12706 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
12707 .cindex "admin user"
12708 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
12709 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
12710 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
12711 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
12712 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
12713 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
12714 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
12716 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
12717 .cindex "domain literal"
12718 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
12719 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
12720 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
12721 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
12723 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
12724 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
12725 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
12726 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
12727 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
12728 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
12729 the local host's IP addresses.
12732 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
12733 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
12734 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
12735 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
12736 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
12737 that explains the mis-configuration. However, some other MTAs support this
12738 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
12739 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
12740 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
12742 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
12743 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
12744 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
12745 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
12746 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
12747 that at least two other MTAs permit this. This option allows Exim users to
12748 experiment if they wish.
12750 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
12751 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
12752 letters, digits, and hyphens. However, just setting this option is not
12753 enough; if you want to look up these domain names in the DNS, you must also
12754 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
12755 suitable setting is:
12757 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
12758 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
12760 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
12762 dns_check_names_pattern =
12764 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
12767 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
12768 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
12769 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
12770 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
12771 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
12772 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
12773 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
12774 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
12775 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
12776 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
12777 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
12779 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
12780 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
12781 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
12782 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
12783 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
12784 which Exim advertises AUTH.
12786 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
12787 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
12788 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
12789 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
12791 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_cipher}{}{}{*}}
12793 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
12794 If &$tls_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
12795 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
12796 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
12799 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
12800 .cindex "thawing messages"
12801 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
12802 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
12803 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
12804 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
12805 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
12806 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
12808 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
12809 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
12810 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
12812 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
12813 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
12814 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
12816 sophie:/var/run/sophie
12818 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with dollar character, it is expanded
12819 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
12823 .option bi_command main string unset
12825 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
12826 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
12827 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
12828 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
12831 .option bounce_message_file main string unset
12832 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
12833 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
12834 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
12835 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
12836 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%warn_message_file%&.
12839 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
12840 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
12841 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
12842 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
12844 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
12845 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
12846 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
12847 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
12848 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
12849 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
12850 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
12851 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
12852 point at which the error was detected are returned.
12853 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
12855 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
12856 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
12857 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
12858 &%bounce_return_body%&.
12861 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
12862 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
12863 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
12864 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
12865 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
12866 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
12867 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
12868 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
12869 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
12871 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
12872 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
12873 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
12874 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
12875 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
12878 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
12879 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
12880 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
12881 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
12882 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
12883 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
12884 connection. A typical setting might be:
12886 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
12888 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
12890 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
12892 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
12895 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
12896 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
12897 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
12898 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
12899 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
12900 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
12903 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
12904 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
12905 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
12906 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
12909 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
12910 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
12911 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
12912 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
12915 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
12916 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
12917 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
12918 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
12921 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
12922 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
12923 callout verification. The default value is
12925 $primary_host_name-$tod_epoch-testing
12927 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
12930 .option check_log_inodes main integer 0
12931 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
12934 .option check_log_space main integer 0
12935 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
12937 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
12938 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
12939 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
12940 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
12941 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
12942 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
12943 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
12944 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
12945 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
12946 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
12949 .option check_spool_inodes main integer 0
12950 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
12953 .option check_spool_space main integer 0
12954 .cindex "checking disk space"
12955 .cindex "disk space, checking"
12956 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
12957 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
12958 message is accepted.
12960 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
12961 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
12962 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
12963 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
12964 When any of these options are set, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
12965 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
12966 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
12967 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
12970 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
12971 either value is greater than zero, for example:
12973 check_spool_space = 10M
12974 check_spool_inodes = 100
12976 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
12977 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
12980 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
12981 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
12982 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
12984 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
12985 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
12986 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
12987 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
12988 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
12989 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
12991 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
12992 number of kilobytes. If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
12994 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
12995 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
12996 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
12998 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
12999 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
13000 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
13001 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
13002 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
13003 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
13005 .option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
13006 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
13007 This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
13008 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
13009 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
13010 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
13011 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
13013 .option daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
13014 See &%daemon_startup_retries%&.
13016 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
13017 .cindex "warning of delay"
13018 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
13019 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
13020 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
13021 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
13022 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
13023 message has been on the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
13024 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
13027 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
13029 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
13030 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
13031 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
13032 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
13036 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
13037 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
13039 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
13042 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
13043 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13044 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
13045 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
13046 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
13047 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
13048 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
13049 not sent. The default is:
13051 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
13052 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
13053 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
13054 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
13057 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
13058 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
13059 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
13060 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
13062 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
13063 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
13064 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
13065 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
13066 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
13067 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
13068 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
13069 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
13071 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
13072 .cindex "load average"
13073 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
13074 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
13075 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
13076 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
13077 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
13080 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
13081 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
13082 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
13083 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
13084 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
13085 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
13086 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
13087 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
13089 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
13090 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
13091 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
13092 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
13093 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
13094 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
13095 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
13096 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
13098 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
13099 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
13100 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
13101 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
13104 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
13105 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
13106 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
13107 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
13108 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
13109 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
13110 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
13113 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
13114 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
13115 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
13116 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
13117 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
13118 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
13119 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
13120 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
13121 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
13122 by a setting such as this:
13124 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
13126 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does. It also applies when the
13127 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
13128 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
13129 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
13130 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
13131 options are applied after this global option.
13133 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
13134 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
13135 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
13136 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
13137 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
13138 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
13139 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
13140 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
13141 value of this option. The default pattern is
13143 dns_check_names_pattern = \
13144 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
13146 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
13147 they must start and end with a letter or digit. &new(Slashes) are not, in fact,
13148 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
13149 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
13150 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
13153 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
13154 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
13155 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
13157 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
13158 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
13159 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
13160 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
13162 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
13163 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
13164 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
13165 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
13166 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
13167 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
13168 domain matches this list.
13170 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
13171 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
13172 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
13175 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
13176 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
13177 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
13178 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
13179 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
13180 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
13181 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
13182 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
13183 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
13184 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
13188 .option dns_retry main integer 0
13189 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
13192 .option drop_cr main boolean false
13193 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
13194 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
13195 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
13197 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
13198 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
13199 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
13200 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
13201 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
13202 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
13204 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
13206 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
13207 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
13209 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
13210 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
13211 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
13212 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
13213 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
13214 messages's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
13215 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
13216 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
13217 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
13220 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
13221 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
13222 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
13223 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
13224 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
13225 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
13226 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
13227 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
13228 must be enclosed in double quotes.
13230 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
13231 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
13232 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
13233 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
13234 are examined. For example:
13236 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
13237 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
13238 postmaster@mydomain.example
13240 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13241 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
13242 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
13243 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
13244 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
13245 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
13246 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
13249 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
13250 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
13251 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
13253 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
13255 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
13256 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
13257 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
13258 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
13259 overrides the default.
13261 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
13262 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
13263 and warning messages. For example:
13265 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
13267 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
13268 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
13269 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
13270 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
13274 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
13275 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
13276 .cindex "Exim group"
13277 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
13278 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
13279 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
13280 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
13281 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
13285 .option exim_path main string "see below"
13286 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
13287 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
13288 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
13289 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
13290 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
13292 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
13293 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
13294 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
13295 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
13298 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
13299 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
13300 .cindex "Exim user"
13301 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
13302 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
13303 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
13304 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
13306 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
13307 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
13308 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
13309 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
13312 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
13313 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
13314 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
13315 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
13318 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
13319 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
13321 .option "extract_addresses_remove_ &~&~arguments" main boolean true &&&
13322 extract_addresses_remove_arguments
13324 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
13325 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
13326 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
13327 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
13328 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
13329 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
13330 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
13331 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
13332 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
13333 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
13337 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
13338 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
13339 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
13340 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
13341 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
13342 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
13343 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
13344 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
13347 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
13348 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
13349 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
13350 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
13354 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
13355 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
13356 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
13357 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
13358 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
13359 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
13360 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
13361 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
13362 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
13363 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
13364 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
13365 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
13366 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
13367 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
13368 logging that you require.
13371 .option gecos_name main string&!! unset
13373 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
13374 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
13375 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
13376 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
13377 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
13378 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
13379 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
13380 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
13382 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
13383 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
13384 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
13387 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
13388 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
13389 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
13390 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
13392 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
13396 .option gecos_pattern main string unset
13397 See &%gecos_name%& above.
13400 .option gnutls_require_kx main string unset
13401 This option controls the key exchange mechanisms when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
13402 server. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
13404 .option gnutls_require_mac main string unset
13405 This option controls the MAC algorithms when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
13406 server. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
13408 .option gnutls_require_protocols main string unset
13409 This option controls the protocols when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
13410 server. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
13413 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
13414 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
13415 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
13416 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
13417 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
13418 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
13422 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
13423 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
13424 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
13425 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
13426 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
13427 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
13428 sections are rejected.
13431 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
13432 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
13433 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
13434 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
13435 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
13436 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
13437 zero means &"no limit"&.
13442 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13443 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
13444 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
13445 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
13446 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
13447 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
13448 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
13449 if you want to do semantic checking.
13450 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
13454 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
13455 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
13456 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
13457 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
13458 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
13459 all EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
13460 hyphens, and dots. If you really must allow underscores, you can set
13462 helo_allow_chars = _
13464 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
13467 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
13468 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
13469 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
13470 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
13471 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
13472 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
13473 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
13477 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13478 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
13479 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
13480 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
13481 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
13482 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
13483 condition &`verify`& &`=`& &`helo`& is provided to make this possible.
13484 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
13485 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
13486 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify`& &`=`& &`helo`& is
13487 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
13488 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
13490 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
13491 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
13492 EHLO command either:
13495 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
13497 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
13498 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
13499 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
13500 calling host address, or
13502 when looked up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when
13503 available) yields the calling host address.
13506 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
13507 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
13508 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify`& &`=`& &`helo`& condition.
13510 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13511 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
13512 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
13513 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
13514 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
13515 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
13516 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
13517 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
13518 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
13521 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
13522 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
13523 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
13524 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held on the queue
13525 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
13526 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
13527 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
13528 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
13529 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
13531 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
13532 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
13533 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
13534 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
13535 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
13537 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
13538 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
13539 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
13540 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
13543 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
13544 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
13545 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
13546 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
13547 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
13548 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
13549 default configuration file contains
13553 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
13554 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
13556 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
13557 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
13558 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
13560 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
13561 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
13562 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
13563 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
13564 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and &`verify`& &`=`&
13565 &`reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
13568 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
13569 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
13570 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
13571 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
13572 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
13575 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
13576 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
13577 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
13578 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
13582 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
13583 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
13584 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
13585 as soon as the connection is made.
13586 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
13587 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
13588 connections immediately.
13590 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
13591 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
13592 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
13593 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
13594 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
13597 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
13598 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
13599 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
13600 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
13601 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
13602 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
13603 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
13604 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
13605 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
13607 hosts_connection_nolog = :
13609 If the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is not set, this option has no effect.
13613 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
13614 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
13615 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
13616 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
13617 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
13619 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
13620 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
13622 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
13623 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
13624 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
13625 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
13626 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
13627 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
13628 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
13632 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
13633 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
13634 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
13635 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
13636 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
13641 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
13642 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
13643 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
13644 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
13645 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
13646 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
13648 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
13649 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
13650 message has been on the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
13651 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
13652 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
13653 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
13654 for frozen messages. For example,
13656 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
13658 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
13659 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
13660 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
13661 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
13662 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
13663 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
13666 .option ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
13667 .cindex "&""From""& line"
13668 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
13669 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
13670 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
13671 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
13672 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
13673 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
13674 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
13675 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
13678 .option ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
13679 See &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& above.
13682 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
13683 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
13684 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
13685 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
13689 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
13690 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
13691 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
13692 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
13693 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
13697 .option ldap_version main integer unset
13698 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
13699 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
13700 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
13701 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
13702 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
13703 has been built with LDAP support.
13707 .option local_from_check main boolean true
13708 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
13709 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
13710 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
13711 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
13712 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
13713 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
13715 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
13716 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
13717 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
13719 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
13720 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
13721 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
13722 and the default qualify domain.
13724 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
13725 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
13726 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
13727 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
13729 .cindex "envelope sender"
13730 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
13731 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
13732 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
13734 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
13735 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
13736 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
13741 .option local_from_prefix main string unset
13742 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
13743 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
13744 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
13745 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
13746 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
13747 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
13750 local_from_prefix = *-
13752 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
13754 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
13756 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
13757 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
13761 .option local_from_suffix main string unset
13762 See &%local_from_prefix%& above.
13765 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
13766 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
13767 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
13768 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
13769 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
13770 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
13771 &%local_interfaces%& is
13773 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
13775 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
13777 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
13780 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
13781 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
13782 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
13783 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
13784 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
13785 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
13786 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
13787 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
13791 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
13792 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
13793 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
13794 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
13795 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
13796 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
13797 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
13798 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
13803 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
13804 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
13805 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
13806 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
13807 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
13808 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
13809 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
13810 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
13811 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
13812 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
13813 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
13814 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number is set%&, the final two
13815 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
13816 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
13817 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
13821 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
13822 .cindex "log" "file path for"
13823 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
13824 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
13825 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
13826 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or run time, they
13827 are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
13828 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
13829 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
13830 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
13831 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
13832 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
13833 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
13834 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
13837 .option log_selector main string unset
13838 .cindex "log" "selectors"
13839 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
13840 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
13841 minus characters. For example:
13843 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
13845 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
13846 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
13849 .option log_timezone main boolean false
13850 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
13851 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
13852 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
13853 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
13854 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
13855 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
13856 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
13857 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
13858 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
13859 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
13860 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
13861 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
13864 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
13865 .cindex "too many open files"
13866 .cindex "open files, too many"
13867 .cindex "file" "too many open"
13868 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
13869 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
13870 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
13871 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
13872 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
13873 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
13874 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
13875 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
13876 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
13877 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
13878 &%lookup_open_max%&.
13881 .option max_username_length main integer 0
13882 .cindex "length of login name"
13883 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
13884 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
13885 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
13886 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
13887 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
13888 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
13892 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
13893 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
13894 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
13895 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
13896 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
13897 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
13898 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
13899 option is set true, this no longer happens.
13903 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
13904 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
13905 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
13906 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
13907 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
13908 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
13909 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
13912 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
13913 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
13914 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
13915 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
13916 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
13917 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
13918 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
13919 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
13920 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
13921 empty string, the option is ignored.
13924 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
13925 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
13926 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
13927 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
13928 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
13929 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
13930 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
13931 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
13932 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
13933 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
13934 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
13935 colons will become hyphens.
13938 .option message_logs main boolean true
13939 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
13940 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
13941 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
13942 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
13943 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
13944 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
13945 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
13946 which is not affected by this option.
13949 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
13950 .cindex "message" "size limit"
13951 .cindex "limit" "message size"
13952 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
13953 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
13954 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
13955 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
13956 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
13957 optionally followed by K or M.
13959 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
13960 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
13961 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
13962 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
13963 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
13965 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
13966 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
13967 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
13968 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
13969 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
13970 message that an individual transport can process.
13973 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
13974 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
13975 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
13977 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
13979 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
13980 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
13981 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
13982 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
13983 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
13986 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
13987 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
13988 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
13989 contains a full description of this facility.
13993 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
13994 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
13995 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
13996 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
13997 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
14000 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
14001 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
14002 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
14003 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
14004 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
14007 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
14008 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
14009 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
14010 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
14011 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
14013 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
14014 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
14017 never_users = root:daemon:bin
14019 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
14020 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
14024 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
14025 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
14026 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
14027 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
14028 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
14031 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14032 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
14033 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
14034 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
14035 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
14036 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
14037 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
14038 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
14039 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
14040 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
14043 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
14044 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
14045 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
14046 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
14047 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
14048 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
14049 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
14052 .option perl_at_start main boolean false
14053 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
14054 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
14057 .option perl_startup main string unset
14058 This option is available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
14059 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of its use.
14062 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
14063 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
14064 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
14065 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
14066 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
14067 PostgreSQL support.
14070 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
14071 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
14072 .cindex "pid file, path for"
14073 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
14074 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
14077 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
14079 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
14081 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
14082 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
14083 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
14086 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14087 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
14088 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
14089 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
14090 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
14091 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
14092 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
14093 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
14094 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
14097 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
14098 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
14099 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
14100 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
14101 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
14102 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
14103 volume of mail. Use with care!
14106 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
14107 .cindex "name" "of local host"
14108 .cindex "host" "name of local"
14109 .cindex "local host" "name of"
14110 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
14111 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
14112 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
14113 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
14114 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
14115 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
14117 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
14118 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
14119 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
14120 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
14121 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
14122 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
14125 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
14126 .cindex "printing characters"
14127 .cindex "8-bit characters"
14128 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
14129 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
14130 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
14131 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
14132 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
14135 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
14136 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
14137 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
14138 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
14139 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
14143 .option process_log_path main string unset
14144 .cindex "process log path"
14145 .cindex "log" "process log"
14146 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
14147 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
14148 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
14149 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
14150 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
14151 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
14152 different spool directories.
14155 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
14159 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
14160 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
14161 &%queue_list_requires_admin%&.
14164 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
14165 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
14166 .cindex "address" "qualification"
14167 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
14168 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
14169 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
14170 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
14171 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
14172 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
14174 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
14175 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
14176 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
14177 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
14178 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
14179 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
14180 &%primary_hostname%& value.
14183 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
14184 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
14185 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
14189 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14190 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
14191 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14192 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
14193 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
14194 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
14195 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
14196 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
14199 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
14201 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
14202 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
14203 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false. See also &%prod_requires_admin%&.
14206 .option queue_only main boolean false
14207 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14208 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
14209 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
14210 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits on the queue for the
14211 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
14212 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
14214 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
14215 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
14216 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
14217 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
14220 .option queue_only_file main string unset
14221 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14222 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
14223 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
14224 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
14225 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
14226 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
14227 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
14228 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
14230 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
14232 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
14233 &_/some/file_& exists.
14236 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
14238 .cindex "load average"
14239 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14240 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
14241 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
14242 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
14243 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
14244 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
14245 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
14249 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
14250 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
14251 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
14252 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14256 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
14257 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
14258 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
14259 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
14260 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
14261 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
14262 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
14263 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
14264 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
14265 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
14266 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
14267 re-evaluated for each message.
14271 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
14272 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14273 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
14274 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
14275 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
14276 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
14279 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
14280 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
14281 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
14282 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
14283 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
14284 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
14285 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
14286 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
14287 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
14288 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
14289 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
14290 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
14291 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
14295 .option queue_run_max main integer 5
14296 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
14297 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
14298 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
14299 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
14300 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
14301 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
14302 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
14303 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
14305 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
14306 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
14307 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
14308 the daemon's command line.
14310 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14311 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14312 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
14313 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
14314 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
14315 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
14316 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
14317 message waits on the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
14318 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
14319 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
14320 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
14321 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
14322 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
14326 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
14327 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
14328 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
14329 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
14330 the value is zero, it will wait for ever. This setting is overridden by the
14331 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
14332 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
14334 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
14335 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
14336 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
14337 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
14338 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
14339 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
14340 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
14341 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
14342 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
14343 header lines. The default setting is:
14346 received_header_text = Received: \
14347 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
14348 {${if def:sender_ident \
14349 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
14350 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
14351 by $primary_hostname \
14352 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol}} \
14353 ${if def:tls_cipher {($tls_cipher)\n\t}}\
14354 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
14355 ${if def:sender_address \
14356 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
14357 id $message_exim_id\
14358 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
14361 The reference to the TLS cipher is omitted when Exim is built without TLS
14362 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
14363 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
14364 header lines such as the following:
14366 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
14367 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
14368 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
14369 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
14370 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
14371 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
14372 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
14374 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
14375 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
14376 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
14377 message was accepted.
14380 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
14381 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
14382 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
14383 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
14384 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
14385 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
14386 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
14387 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
14390 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14391 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
14392 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
14393 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
14394 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
14395 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
14396 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
14397 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
14398 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
14399 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
14400 option was not set.
14403 .option recipients_max main integer 0
14404 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
14405 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
14406 If this option is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
14407 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
14408 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
14409 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
14410 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
14413 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
14414 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
14415 RCPT commands in a single message.
14418 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
14419 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
14420 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
14421 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
14422 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
14423 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
14424 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
14427 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 2
14428 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
14429 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
14430 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
14431 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
14432 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
14433 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
14434 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
14435 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
14436 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
14437 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
14438 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
14439 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
14440 tagged with its process id.
14442 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
14443 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
14444 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
14445 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
14448 .cindex "number of deliveries"
14449 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
14450 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
14451 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
14452 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
14453 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
14454 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
14455 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
14456 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
14457 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
14458 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
14460 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
14461 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
14462 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
14463 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
14466 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
14467 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
14468 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
14469 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
14470 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
14472 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
14474 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
14475 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
14478 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
14479 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
14480 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
14481 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
14482 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
14486 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
14487 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
14488 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
14489 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
14490 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
14491 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
14492 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
14496 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
14497 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
14498 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
14499 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
14500 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
14501 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
14502 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
14503 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
14504 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
14505 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
14508 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
14509 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
14512 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14514 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
14515 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches an item
14518 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 5s
14519 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
14520 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
14521 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
14522 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
14525 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14526 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
14527 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
14528 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
14529 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
14530 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
14531 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
14532 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
14533 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
14534 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
14537 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
14538 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
14539 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
14540 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
14541 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
14542 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
14543 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
14544 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
14545 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
14546 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
14547 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
14551 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
14552 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
14553 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
14555 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
14556 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
14557 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
14558 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
14559 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
14560 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
14562 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
14563 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
14564 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
14565 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
14568 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
14569 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
14570 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
14571 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
14572 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
14573 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
14574 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
14575 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
14577 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
14578 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
14579 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
14580 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
14581 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
14582 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
14583 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
14584 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
14587 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
14588 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
14589 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
14590 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
14594 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14595 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14597 .option "smtp_accept_max_per_ &~&~connection" main integer 1000 &&&
14598 smtp_accept_max_per_connection
14599 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
14600 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
14601 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
14602 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
14603 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
14604 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
14605 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
14609 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
14610 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
14611 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
14612 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
14613 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
14614 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
14615 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
14616 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
14617 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
14618 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
14619 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
14621 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
14622 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
14623 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
14624 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
14625 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
14626 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
14630 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
14632 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
14633 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14634 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
14635 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
14636 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
14637 on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
14638 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
14639 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
14640 to all messages received in the same connection.
14643 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
14644 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
14645 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
14646 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
14649 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
14650 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
14652 .option "smtp_accept_queue_per_ &~&~connection" main integer 10 &&&
14653 smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
14654 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
14655 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
14656 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
14657 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
14658 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
14659 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
14660 number, subsequent messages are placed on the queue, but no delivery processes
14661 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
14662 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
14663 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
14664 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
14667 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
14668 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
14669 .cindex "host" "reserved"
14670 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
14671 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
14672 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
14673 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
14674 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
14675 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
14676 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
14677 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
14680 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
14681 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
14682 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
14683 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
14686 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
14687 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
14688 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
14689 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
14690 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
14691 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
14692 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
14693 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
14694 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
14696 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
14697 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
14698 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
14699 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
14701 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
14702 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
14703 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
14704 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
14705 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
14708 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
14709 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
14712 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
14713 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
14714 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
14715 &%helo_data%& value.
14717 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
14718 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
14719 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
14720 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
14721 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
14722 This string, which is expanded every time it is used, is output as the initial
14723 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
14725 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
14726 $version_number $tod_full
14728 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error. If you want to create a
14729 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
14730 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
14731 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
14732 multiline response).
14735 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
14736 .cindex "checking disk space"
14737 .cindex "disk space, checking"
14738 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
14739 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
14740 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
14741 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
14742 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
14743 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
14746 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
14747 .cindex "connection backlog"
14748 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
14749 .cindex "backlog of connections"
14750 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
14751 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
14752 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
14753 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
14754 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
14755 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
14756 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
14757 attacks by SYN flooding.
14760 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
14761 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
14762 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
14763 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
14764 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
14765 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
14766 fewer, but they still exist.
14768 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
14769 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
14770 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
14771 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
14772 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
14773 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
14774 does detect many instances.
14776 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
14777 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
14778 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
14779 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
14783 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
14784 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
14785 .vindex "&$domain$&"
14786 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
14787 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
14788 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
14789 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
14790 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
14793 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
14794 $sender_host_address
14796 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
14797 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
14798 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
14799 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
14800 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
14804 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
14805 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
14806 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
14807 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
14808 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
14811 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
14812 .cindex "load average"
14813 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
14814 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
14815 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
14816 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
14817 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
14818 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
14822 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
14823 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
14824 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
14825 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
14826 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
14828 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
14830 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
14831 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
14832 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
14833 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
14834 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
14836 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
14837 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
14838 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
14839 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
14840 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
14841 not count towards the limit.
14845 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
14846 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
14847 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
14848 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
14849 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
14852 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
14853 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
14857 .option smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14858 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
14859 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
14860 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
14861 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
14862 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
14865 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
14866 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
14867 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
14868 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
14870 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
14871 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
14872 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
14873 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
14877 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
14879 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
14880 fractional parts are allowed here.
14882 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
14884 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
14885 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
14888 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
14889 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
14891 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
14892 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
14894 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
14895 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
14896 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
14897 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
14900 .option smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset
14901 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
14904 .option smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
14905 See &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& above.
14908 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time 5m
14909 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
14910 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
14911 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
14912 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
14913 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
14914 the message is abandoned.
14915 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
14917 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
14918 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
14920 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
14921 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
14925 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
14926 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
14927 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
14928 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
14929 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
14932 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
14933 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
14934 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
14937 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
14938 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
14939 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
14940 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
14941 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
14942 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
14943 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
14944 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
14945 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
14946 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
14948 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
14949 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
14952 .option spamd_address main string "see below"
14953 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
14954 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
14955 The default value is
14959 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
14963 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
14964 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
14965 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
14966 .cindex "directories, multiple"
14967 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
14968 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
14969 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
14970 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
14971 arrival of the message.
14973 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
14974 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
14975 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
14976 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
14977 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
14979 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
14980 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
14981 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
14982 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
14983 automatically deleted.
14985 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
14986 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
14987 trying to deliver each one in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
14988 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
14989 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
14990 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
14991 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages on the queue. However,
14992 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
14993 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
14996 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
14997 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
14998 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
14999 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
15000 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
15001 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
15002 &$primary_hostname$&.
15004 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
15005 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
15006 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
15007 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
15008 as failures in the configuration file.
15010 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
15011 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
15013 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
15014 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
15015 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
15016 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
15018 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
15019 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
15020 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
15021 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
15022 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
15023 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
15025 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
15026 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
15027 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
15028 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
15029 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
15030 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
15031 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
15034 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
15035 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
15036 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
15037 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
15038 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
15039 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
15040 domain causes a syntax error.
15041 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
15045 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
15046 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
15047 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
15048 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
15049 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
15050 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
15051 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
15052 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
15053 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
15054 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
15055 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
15056 the LOG_ALERT priority.
15059 .option syslog_facility main string unset
15060 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
15061 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
15062 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
15063 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
15064 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
15065 details of Exim's logging.
15069 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
15070 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
15071 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
15072 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
15073 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
15077 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
15078 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
15079 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
15080 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
15081 details of Exim's logging.
15084 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
15085 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
15086 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
15087 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
15088 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
15089 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
15090 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
15091 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
15092 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
15093 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
15094 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
15097 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
15098 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
15099 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
15100 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
15101 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
15102 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
15105 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
15106 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
15107 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
15108 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
15109 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
15111 .option system_filter_group main string unset
15112 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
15113 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
15114 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
15115 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
15117 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
15118 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
15119 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
15120 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
15121 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
15122 contains the pipe command.
15125 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
15126 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
15127 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
15128 is used in a system filter.
15130 .option system_filter_user main string unset
15131 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
15132 If this option is not set, the system filter is run in the main Exim delivery
15133 process, as root. When the option is set, the system filter runs in a separate
15134 process, as the given user. Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
15135 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
15136 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
15137 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
15138 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
15140 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
15141 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
15142 transport option overrides. Normally you should set &%system_filter_user%& if
15143 your system filter generates these kinds of delivery.
15146 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
15147 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
15148 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
15149 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
15150 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
15151 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
15152 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
15153 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
15154 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
15155 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
15156 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
15157 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
15161 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
15162 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
15163 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
15164 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
15165 message of any kind that has been on the queue for longer than the given time
15166 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
15167 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
15168 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
15169 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
15170 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
15172 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
15173 frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
15174 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
15177 .option timezone main string unset
15178 .cindex "timezone, setting"
15179 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
15180 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
15181 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
15182 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
15186 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
15187 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
15188 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
15189 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
15190 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
15191 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
15194 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15195 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
15196 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
15197 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
15198 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
15199 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
15200 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
15201 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
15204 .option tls_certificate main string&!! unset
15205 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
15206 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
15207 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
15208 file which contains the server's certificates. The server's private key is also
15209 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
15210 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
15212 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
15213 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
15214 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
15215 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
15218 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
15219 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
15220 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
15221 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
15222 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
15225 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
15226 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
15227 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to
15228 a file which contains the server's DH parameter values.
15229 This is used only for OpenSSL. When Exim is linked with GnuTLS, this option is
15230 ignored. See section &<<SECTopenvsgnu>>& for further details.
15233 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
15234 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
15235 operate the obsolete SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
15236 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
15237 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
15241 .option tls_privatekey main string&!! unset
15242 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
15243 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
15244 file which contains the server's private key. If this option is unset, or if
15245 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
15246 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
15247 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
15250 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
15251 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
15252 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
15253 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
15254 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
15255 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
15259 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
15260 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
15261 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
15262 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
15263 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
15264 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
15265 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
15266 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
15267 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
15268 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
15269 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
15272 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15273 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
15274 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
15275 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
15278 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! unset
15279 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
15280 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
15281 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to
15282 a file containing permitted certificates for clients that
15283 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. Alternatively, if you
15284 are using OpenSSL, you can set &%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a
15285 directory containing certificate files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the
15286 option must be set to the name of a single file if you are using GnuTLS.
15289 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15290 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
15291 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
15292 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
15293 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
15294 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
15295 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
15296 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
15299 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
15300 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
15301 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
15302 aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
15303 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
15304 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
15305 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
15308 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
15309 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
15310 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
15311 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
15312 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
15313 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
15314 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
15317 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
15321 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
15322 .cindex "trusted groups"
15323 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
15324 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
15325 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
15326 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
15327 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
15328 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
15329 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
15332 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
15333 .cindex "trusted users"
15334 .cindex "user" "trusted"
15335 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
15336 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
15337 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
15338 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
15339 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
15340 Exim user are trusted.
15342 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
15343 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
15344 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
15345 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
15346 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
15347 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
15348 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
15349 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
15350 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
15353 .option unknown_username main string unset
15354 See &%unknown_login%&.
15356 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
15357 .cindex "trusted users"
15358 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
15359 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
15360 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
15361 .cindex "envelope sender"
15362 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
15363 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
15364 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
15365 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
15366 is used) is ignored.
15368 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
15369 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
15371 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
15373 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
15374 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
15375 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
15376 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
15377 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
15378 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
15379 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
15380 followed by a hyphen
15381 by a setting like this:
15383 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
15385 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
15386 restriction, you can use
15388 untrusted_set_sender = *
15390 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
15391 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
15392 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
15393 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
15394 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
15395 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
15396 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
15397 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
15399 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
15400 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
15401 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
15402 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
15406 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
15407 .cindex "&""From""& line"
15408 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
15409 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
15410 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
15411 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
15412 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
15413 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
15414 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
15415 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
15417 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
15418 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
15420 The pattern can be seen by running
15422 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
15424 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
15425 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
15426 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
15427 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
15428 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
15429 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
15432 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
15433 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
15436 .option warn_message_file main string unset
15437 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
15438 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
15439 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
15440 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
15441 been on the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
15442 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
15443 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&. See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
15446 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
15447 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
15448 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
15449 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
15450 .ecindex IIDconfima
15451 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
15456 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15457 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15459 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
15460 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
15461 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
15462 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
15463 Those that are preconditions are marked with ‡ in the &"use"& field.
15465 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
15466 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
15467 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
15468 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
15469 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
15473 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
15474 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
15475 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
15476 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
15477 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
15478 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
15479 delivery of the address to be deferred.
15481 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
15482 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
15483 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
15484 routers, and the eventual transport.
15486 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
15487 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
15488 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
15489 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
15490 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
15492 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
15493 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
15494 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
15495 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
15496 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
15498 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
15499 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
15500 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
15502 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
15504 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
15506 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
15508 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
15509 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
15511 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
15512 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
15513 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
15514 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
15515 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
15516 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
15517 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
15521 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
15523 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
15524 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
15525 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
15526 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
15527 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
15532 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
15533 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
15534 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
15535 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
15536 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
15537 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
15538 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
15539 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
15540 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
15541 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
15544 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
15546 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
15549 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
15551 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
15552 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
15553 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
15554 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
15557 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
15558 .cindex "case of local parts"
15559 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
15560 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
15561 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
15562 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
15563 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
15564 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
15565 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
15568 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
15569 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
15570 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
15571 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
15572 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
15573 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
15574 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
15575 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
15576 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
15578 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
15579 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
15580 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
15581 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
15585 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
15586 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
15587 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
15588 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
15590 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
15591 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
15592 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
15593 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
15594 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
15595 user, &$home$& is set from the password data, and can be tested in other
15596 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
15597 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
15598 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
15599 the router is skipped.
15601 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
15602 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
15603 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
15604 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
15605 setting to achieve this. For example:
15607 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
15609 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
15610 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
15611 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
15615 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
15616 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
15617 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
15618 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
15619 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
15620 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
15621 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
15622 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
15624 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
15625 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
15627 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
15628 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
15629 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
15631 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
15633 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
15635 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
15637 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
15638 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
15639 be specified using &%condition%&.
15643 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
15644 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
15645 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
15646 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
15647 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
15648 output, and Exim carries on processing.
15649 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
15650 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
15651 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
15652 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
15653 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
15654 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
15658 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
15659 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
15660 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
15661 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
15662 transport option of the same name.
15665 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
15666 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
15667 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
15668 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
15669 the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
15670 lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
15671 expansions of the driver's private options. See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
15672 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
15676 .option driver routers string unset
15677 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
15682 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
15683 .cindex "envelope sender"
15684 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
15685 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
15686 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
15687 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
15688 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
15689 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
15690 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
15692 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
15693 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
15694 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
15697 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
15698 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
15699 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
15700 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
15702 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
15703 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
15704 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
15705 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
15711 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
15712 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
15713 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
15714 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
15715 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
15717 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
15718 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
15719 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
15720 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
15721 setting &%return_path%&.
15723 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
15724 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
15725 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
15729 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
15730 .cindex "address" "testing"
15731 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
15732 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
15733 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
15734 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
15735 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
15736 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
15737 on for the system alias file.
15738 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
15741 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
15742 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
15743 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
15747 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
15748 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
15749 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
15750 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
15754 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
15755 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
15756 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
15760 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
15761 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
15762 verifying a sender, verification fails.
15766 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
15767 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
15768 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
15769 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
15770 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
15771 changed (see section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&), and a port can be specified with
15772 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
15773 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
15774 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
15776 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
15777 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
15778 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
15779 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
15780 transport for further details.
15783 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
15784 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
15785 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
15786 .cindex "transport" "local"
15787 .cindex "router" "setting group"
15788 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
15789 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
15791 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
15792 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
15793 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
15794 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
15795 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
15799 .option headers_add routers string&!! unset
15800 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
15801 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
15802 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded at routing time, and
15803 associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router. However, this
15804 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
15805 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
15806 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
15807 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
15808 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
15809 &"see"& the added header lines.
15811 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
15812 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If the expanded string is empty, or if
15813 the expansion is forced to fail, the option has no effect. Other expansion
15814 failures are treated as configuration errors.
15816 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
15817 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
15819 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
15820 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
15821 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
15822 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
15823 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
15824 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
15825 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
15826 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
15827 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
15828 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
15832 .option headers_remove routers string&!! unset
15833 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
15834 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
15835 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded at routing time, and
15836 associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router. However, this
15837 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
15838 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
15839 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
15840 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
15841 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
15842 &"see"& the original header lines.
15844 The &%headers_remove%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%& and
15845 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If the expansion is forced to fail,
15846 the option has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
15849 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
15850 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
15852 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
15853 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
15854 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
15855 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
15858 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
15859 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
15860 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
15861 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
15862 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
15863 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
15864 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
15867 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
15871 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
15873 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
15874 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
15875 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
15876 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
15877 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
15878 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
15880 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
15881 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
15883 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
15884 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
15886 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
15887 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
15889 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
15890 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
15891 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
15892 domain that is being routed.
15894 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
15895 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
15898 .option initgroups routers boolean false
15899 .cindex "additional groups"
15900 .cindex "groups" "additional"
15901 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
15902 .cindex "transport" "local"
15903 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
15904 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
15905 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
15906 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
15907 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
15911 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
15912 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
15913 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
15914 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
15915 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
15916 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
15919 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
15920 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
15921 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
15922 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
15923 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
15924 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
15925 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
15926 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
15927 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
15929 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
15930 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
15931 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
15932 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
15933 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
15934 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
15935 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
15936 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
15937 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
15938 the relevant transport.
15940 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
15941 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
15942 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
15945 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
15946 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
15947 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
15948 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
15949 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
15953 local_part_prefix = real-
15955 transport = local_delivery
15958 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
15959 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
15961 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
15962 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
15966 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
15967 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
15968 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
15969 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
15972 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
15973 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
15977 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
15978 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
15979 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
15980 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
15981 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
15982 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
15983 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
15984 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
15985 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
15989 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
15990 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
15994 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
15995 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
15996 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
15997 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
15998 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16000 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
16001 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
16004 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
16006 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
16007 If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
16008 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
16009 expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
16010 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
16011 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
16012 each virtual domain:
16016 local_parts = postmaster
16017 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
16021 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
16022 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
16023 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
16024 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
16025 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
16026 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
16027 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
16028 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
16029 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
16030 redirect addresses.
16034 .option more routers boolean&!! true
16035 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
16036 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
16037 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
16038 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
16039 delivery to be deferred.
16041 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
16042 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
16044 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
16045 means of the setting
16049 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
16050 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
16051 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
16053 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
16054 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
16055 controls what happens next.
16058 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
16059 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
16060 .cindex "router" "timeout"
16061 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
16062 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
16063 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
16064 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
16065 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
16067 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
16068 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
16069 applies to all of them.
16073 .option pass_router routers string unset
16075 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
16076 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
16077 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
16078 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
16079 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
16080 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
16081 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
16082 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
16083 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
16084 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
16089 .option redirect_router routers string unset
16090 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
16091 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
16092 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
16093 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
16094 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
16096 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
16097 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
16098 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
16099 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
16103 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
16104 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
16105 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
16106 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
16107 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
16108 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
16109 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
16111 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
16112 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used.
16113 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
16114 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
16116 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
16117 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
16118 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
16119 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
16120 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
16123 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
16124 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
16127 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
16128 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
16129 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
16130 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
16131 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
16132 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
16133 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
16134 transport (for example &_.procmailrc_&).
16136 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
16137 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
16138 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
16139 operates as follows:
16141 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
16142 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
16143 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
16144 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
16147 require_files = mail:/some/file
16148 require_files = $local_part:$home/.procmailrc
16150 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
16151 &%require_files%& condition fails.
16153 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
16154 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
16155 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
16156 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
16158 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
16159 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
16160 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
16161 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
16162 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
16164 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
16165 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
16166 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
16167 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
16168 check again in that process.
16170 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
16171 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
16172 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
16173 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
16174 not exist. If the file name (or the exclamation mark that precedes the file
16175 name for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
16176 as if the file did not exist. For example:
16178 require_files = +/some/file
16180 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
16181 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
16182 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
16186 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
16187 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
16188 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
16189 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
16190 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
16191 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
16192 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
16193 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
16196 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
16197 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
16198 router. The default value is true for any router that has &%check_local_user%&
16199 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
16200 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
16203 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
16204 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
16205 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
16209 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
16210 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
16211 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
16213 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
16214 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
16215 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
16216 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
16217 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
16218 cause the router to defer.
16220 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
16221 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
16223 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16225 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
16226 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
16228 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
16229 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
16230 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
16231 of these values that is set:
16234 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
16236 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
16238 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
16240 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
16243 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
16244 router, but not for the transport.
16248 .option self routers string freeze
16249 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
16250 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
16251 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
16252 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
16253 and &(manualroute)& routers.
16254 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
16256 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
16257 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
16258 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
16259 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
16260 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
16262 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
16263 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
16264 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
16265 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
16266 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
16271 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
16273 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
16274 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
16275 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
16276 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
16278 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
16279 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
16280 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
16285 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
16286 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
16287 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
16288 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
16289 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
16290 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
16296 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
16297 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
16298 be passed to the next router.
16301 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
16304 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
16305 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
16306 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
16307 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
16308 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
16309 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
16314 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
16315 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
16316 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
16317 address matches something on the list.
16318 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16321 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
16322 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
16323 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
16324 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
16325 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
16326 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
16327 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
16331 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
16332 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
16333 .cindex "packet radio"
16334 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
16335 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
16336 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
16337 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
16338 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
16339 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
16340 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
16341 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
16343 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
16344 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
16345 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
16346 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
16347 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
16348 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
16349 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
16350 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
16351 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
16352 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
16354 translate_ip_address = \
16355 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
16358 The file would contain lines like
16360 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
16361 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
16363 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
16368 .option transport routers string&!! unset
16369 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
16370 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
16371 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
16372 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
16373 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
16374 delivery is deferred.
16376 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
16377 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
16378 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
16382 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
16383 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
16384 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
16385 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
16386 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
16387 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
16388 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
16389 overridden by a setting on the transport.
16390 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
16391 logged, and delivery is deferred.
16392 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
16398 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
16399 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
16400 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
16401 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
16402 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
16403 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
16404 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
16405 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
16406 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
16407 logged, and delivery is deferred.
16409 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
16410 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
16411 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
16412 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
16413 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
16415 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
16421 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
16422 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
16423 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
16424 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
16425 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
16426 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
16427 delivery to be deferred.
16429 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
16430 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
16431 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
16432 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
16433 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
16434 sometimes true and sometimes false).
16436 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
16437 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
16438 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
16439 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
16440 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
16441 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
16442 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
16443 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
16445 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
16446 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
16447 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
16448 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
16449 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
16450 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
16451 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
16452 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
16453 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
16454 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
16456 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
16457 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
16458 subsequent routers.
16461 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
16462 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
16463 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
16464 .cindex "transport" "local"
16465 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
16466 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
16467 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
16468 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
16469 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
16470 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
16471 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
16472 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
16473 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
16474 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
16475 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
16476 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
16480 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
16481 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
16482 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
16485 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
16486 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
16488 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
16489 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address or
16490 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
16491 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
16492 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
16493 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
16495 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
16496 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
16497 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
16501 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
16502 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
16504 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
16505 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16509 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
16510 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
16511 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
16512 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
16514 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
16515 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
16522 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16523 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16525 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
16526 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
16527 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
16528 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
16529 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
16530 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
16531 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
16532 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
16533 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
16537 domains = mydomain.example
16539 transport = local_delivery
16541 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
16542 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
16543 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
16544 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
16551 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16552 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16554 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
16555 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
16556 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
16557 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
16558 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
16559 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
16561 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
16562 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
16563 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
16564 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
16567 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
16568 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
16569 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
16570 except that IPv6 addresses are always sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
16571 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
16572 generic option, the router declines.
16574 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
16575 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
16576 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
16578 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
16579 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
16580 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
16581 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
16582 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
16583 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
16586 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
16587 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
16588 Some mis-behaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
16589 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
16590 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
16591 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
16593 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
16594 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
16595 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
16596 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
16597 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
16598 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
16599 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
16600 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
16601 case routing fails.
16606 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
16607 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
16608 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
16610 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
16611 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
16612 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
16613 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
16614 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
16615 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
16616 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
16619 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
16620 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
16621 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
16622 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
16623 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
16624 required. For example,
16628 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
16629 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
16630 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
16631 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
16632 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
16635 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
16636 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
16637 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
16638 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
16639 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
16640 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
16642 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
16643 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
16644 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
16645 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
16646 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
16647 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
16648 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
16649 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
16651 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
16652 when there is a DNS lookup error.
16656 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
16657 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
16658 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
16659 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
16660 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
16661 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
16662 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
16665 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
16667 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
16668 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
16669 the address record.
16672 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
16673 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
16674 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
16675 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
16680 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
16681 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
16682 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
16683 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
16684 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
16685 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
16686 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
16687 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
16688 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
16693 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
16694 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
16695 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
16696 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
16697 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
16698 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
16699 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
16700 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
16701 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
16702 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
16703 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
16705 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
16706 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
16709 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
16710 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
16711 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
16712 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
16713 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
16717 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
16718 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
16719 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
16720 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
16721 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
16722 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
16723 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
16724 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
16726 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
16727 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
16728 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
16729 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
16730 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
16731 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
16732 without processing them independently,
16733 provided the following conditions are met:
16736 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
16737 &%headers_remove%&.
16739 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
16746 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
16747 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
16748 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
16749 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
16750 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
16751 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
16752 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
16753 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
16754 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
16755 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
16757 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
16758 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
16763 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
16764 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
16765 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
16766 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
16771 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
16772 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
16773 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
16774 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
16777 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
16779 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
16780 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
16781 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
16782 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
16783 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
16784 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
16787 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
16788 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
16789 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
16790 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
16791 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
16793 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
16794 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
16795 such as that implied by
16799 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
16800 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
16801 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
16802 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
16812 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16813 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16815 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
16816 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
16817 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
16818 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
16819 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
16820 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
16821 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
16822 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
16823 router handles the address
16827 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
16828 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
16829 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
16831 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
16833 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
16834 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
16836 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
16837 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
16838 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
16839 &%self%& option determines what happens.
16841 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
16842 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
16843 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
16844 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
16848 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16849 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16851 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
16852 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
16853 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
16854 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
16855 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
16856 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
16859 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
16861 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
16863 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
16864 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
16865 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
16866 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
16867 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
16868 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
16869 must not be specified for it.
16871 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
16872 .option hosts iplookup string unset
16873 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
16874 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
16875 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
16876 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
16877 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
16880 .option optional iplookup boolean false
16881 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
16882 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
16883 delivery to the address is deferred.
16886 .option port iplookup integer 0
16887 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
16888 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
16892 .option protocol iplookup string udp
16893 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
16894 protocols is to be used.
16897 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
16898 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
16901 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
16903 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
16904 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
16907 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
16908 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
16909 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
16910 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
16911 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
16912 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
16913 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
16914 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
16917 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
16918 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
16919 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
16920 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
16921 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
16922 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
16923 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
16924 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
16925 following could be used:
16927 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
16928 reroute = $local_part@$1
16931 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
16932 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
16933 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
16934 call. It does not apply to UDP.
16939 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16940 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16942 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
16943 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
16944 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
16945 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
16946 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
16947 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
16948 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
16949 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
16950 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
16951 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
16953 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
16954 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
16955 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
16956 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
16957 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
16958 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
16959 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
16962 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
16963 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
16964 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
16965 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
16966 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
16967 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
16968 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
16971 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
16972 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
16973 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
16974 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
16975 below, following the list of private options.
16978 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
16980 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
16981 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
16983 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
16984 See &%host_find_failed%&.
16986 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
16987 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
16988 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
16989 of the following values:
16998 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
16999 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
17000 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
17003 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
17004 router only if &%more%& is true.
17006 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
17007 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
17008 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
17009 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
17011 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
17012 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
17013 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
17016 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
17017 .cindex "randomized host list"
17018 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
17019 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
17020 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
17021 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
17022 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
17023 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
17024 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
17025 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
17027 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
17028 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
17029 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
17030 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
17032 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
17034 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
17035 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
17036 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
17037 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
17038 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
17041 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
17042 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
17043 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
17046 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
17048 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
17049 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
17053 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
17054 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
17055 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
17056 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
17059 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
17060 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
17061 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
17062 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
17063 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
17064 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
17065 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
17066 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
17068 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
17069 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
17070 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
17071 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
17072 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
17073 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
17074 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
17075 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
17080 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
17081 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
17082 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
17083 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
17084 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
17085 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
17087 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
17089 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
17093 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
17094 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
17096 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
17097 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
17098 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
17099 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
17100 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
17101 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
17102 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
17103 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
17104 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
17105 in a &%route_list%&).
17107 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
17108 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
17109 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
17110 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
17114 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
17115 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
17116 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
17117 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
17118 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
17119 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
17120 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
17123 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
17124 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
17126 This data can be accessed by setting
17128 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
17130 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
17131 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
17132 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
17133 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
17134 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
17139 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
17140 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
17141 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
17142 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
17143 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports. The format of each item
17144 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
17145 as described in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
17147 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
17148 variables are set during its expansion:
17151 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
17152 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
17153 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
17155 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
17158 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
17160 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
17163 .vindex "&$value$&"
17164 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
17165 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
17167 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
17171 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
17172 semicolon is the default route list separator.
17176 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
17177 Each item in the list of hosts is either a host name or an IP address,
17178 optionally with an attached port number. When no port is given, an IP address
17179 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
17180 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
17181 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
17184 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
17185 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
17186 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
17188 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
17189 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
17192 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
17193 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
17194 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
17195 number follows. For example:
17197 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
17201 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
17202 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
17203 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
17204 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
17205 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
17208 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
17209 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
17210 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
17211 records in the DNS. For example:
17213 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
17215 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
17218 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
17220 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
17221 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
17222 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
17223 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
17224 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
17225 happens is controlled by the
17226 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
17227 &%self%& option of the router.
17229 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
17230 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
17231 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
17232 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
17233 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
17234 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
17235 defined by MX preferences.
17237 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
17238 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
17239 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
17241 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
17242 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
17243 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
17244 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
17246 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
17247 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
17250 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
17251 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
17252 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
17254 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
17255 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
17259 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
17260 The options are a sequence of words; in practice no more than three are ever
17261 present. One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
17262 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
17263 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
17264 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
17265 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
17268 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
17269 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
17271 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
17272 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
17274 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
17275 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
17276 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
17278 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
17279 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
17280 timeout), delivery is deferred.
17285 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
17286 domain2 host4:host5
17288 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
17289 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
17290 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
17291 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
17294 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
17295 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
17296 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
17297 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
17302 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
17303 &%host_find_failed%& option.
17306 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
17307 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
17311 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
17312 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
17313 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
17316 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
17317 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
17318 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
17319 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
17321 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
17323 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
17324 your first router something like this:
17327 driver = manualroute
17328 domains = !+local_domains
17329 transport = remote_smtp
17330 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
17332 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
17333 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
17334 they are tried in order
17335 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
17336 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
17339 driver = manualroute
17340 transport = remote_smtp
17341 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
17343 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
17344 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
17345 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
17346 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
17347 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
17348 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
17349 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
17350 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
17353 .cindex "mail hub example"
17354 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
17355 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
17356 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
17357 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
17358 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
17359 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
17360 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
17361 lookup is easier to manage.
17363 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
17364 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
17368 driver = manualroute
17369 transport = remote_smtp
17370 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
17372 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
17373 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
17374 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
17375 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
17376 domain can be used to find the host:
17379 driver = manualroute
17380 transport = remote_smtp
17381 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
17383 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
17384 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
17385 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
17389 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
17390 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
17391 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
17392 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
17393 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
17394 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
17397 driver = manualroute
17398 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
17399 route_list = saved.domain.example
17401 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
17402 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
17403 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
17406 driver = manualroute
17408 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
17409 *.saved.domain2.example \
17410 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
17413 .vindex "&$domain$&"
17415 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
17416 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
17417 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
17418 the address if the lookup fails.
17421 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
17422 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
17423 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
17424 one way it can be done:
17430 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
17431 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
17432 return_fail_output = true
17437 driver = manualroute
17439 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
17441 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
17443 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
17445 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
17446 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
17447 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
17449 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
17450 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
17459 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17460 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17462 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
17463 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
17464 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
17465 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
17466 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
17467 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
17468 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
17469 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
17470 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
17471 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
17473 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
17475 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
17476 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
17477 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
17478 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
17479 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
17482 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
17483 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
17484 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
17485 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
17486 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
17487 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
17490 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
17491 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
17492 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
17493 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
17494 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
17495 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
17496 not set, a value for the gid also.
17498 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
17499 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
17500 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
17501 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
17502 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
17503 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
17507 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
17508 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
17509 before running the command.
17512 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
17513 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
17514 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
17518 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
17519 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
17520 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
17521 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
17522 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
17525 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
17528 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
17529 &%no_more%& is set.
17531 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
17532 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
17533 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
17534 included in the SMTP response.
17536 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
17537 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
17538 included in any SMTP response.
17540 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
17542 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
17543 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
17545 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
17546 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
17547 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
17550 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
17551 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
17554 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
17555 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
17557 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
17558 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
17559 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
17560 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
17562 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
17563 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
17564 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
17565 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
17566 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
17568 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
17569 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
17570 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
17571 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
17572 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
17574 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
17575 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
17576 variable. For example, this return line
17578 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
17580 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
17581 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
17582 .ecindex IIDquerou1
17583 .ecindex IIDquerou2
17588 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17589 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
17591 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
17592 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
17593 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
17594 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
17595 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
17596 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
17597 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
17598 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
17599 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
17600 redirected in several different ways:
17603 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
17606 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
17608 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
17610 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
17612 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
17614 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
17616 It can be discarded.
17619 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
17620 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
17621 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
17622 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
17626 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
17627 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
17628 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
17629 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
17630 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
17631 aliases, in a configuration like this:
17635 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
17637 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
17638 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
17639 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
17640 cause delivery to be deferred.
17642 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
17643 &_.forward_& files, like this:
17648 file = $home/.forward
17651 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
17652 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
17653 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
17654 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
17659 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
17660 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
17661 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
17662 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
17665 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
17666 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
17667 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
17668 practice the router may not be able to operate.
17670 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
17671 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
17672 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
17673 saves some resources.
17681 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
17682 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
17683 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
17684 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
17685 can be interpreted in two different ways:
17688 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
17689 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
17690 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
17691 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
17692 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
17693 document is intended for use by end users.
17695 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
17696 described in the next section.
17699 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the file name given
17700 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
17701 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
17702 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
17703 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
17707 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
17708 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
17709 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
17710 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
17711 addresses, file names, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
17712 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
17713 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
17714 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
17715 commas or newlines.
17716 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
17719 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
17720 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
17721 next newline character is ignored.
17723 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
17724 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
17725 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
17726 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
17729 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
17730 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
17731 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
17732 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
17733 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
17734 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
17737 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
17741 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
17742 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
17743 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
17744 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
17745 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
17746 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
17747 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
17748 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
17749 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
17750 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
17751 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
17753 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
17754 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
17755 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
17756 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
17757 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
17759 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
17761 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
17762 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
17763 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
17764 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
17765 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
17768 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
17769 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
17770 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
17771 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
17772 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
17774 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
17775 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
17780 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
17781 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
17784 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
17786 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
17787 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
17788 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
17789 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
17790 should really contain
17792 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
17794 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
17795 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
17796 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
17800 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
17801 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
17802 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
17805 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
17806 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
17807 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
17808 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
17809 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
17810 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
17811 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
17813 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
17814 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
17815 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
17816 in double quotes, for example:
17818 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
17820 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
17821 quote just the command. An item such as
17823 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
17825 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
17828 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
17829 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
17830 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
17831 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
17833 /home/world/minbari
17835 is treated as a file name, but
17837 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
17839 is treated as an address. For a file name, a transport must be specified using
17840 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
17841 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
17842 file name, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
17844 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
17845 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
17847 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
17848 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
17849 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
17850 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
17853 .cindex "included address list"
17854 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
17855 If an item is of the form
17857 :include:<path name>
17859 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
17860 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
17861 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
17862 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
17863 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
17864 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
17866 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
17868 It must be given as
17870 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
17873 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
17874 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
17875 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
17876 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
17877 .cindex "black hole"
17878 .cindex "abandoning mail"
17879 &':blackhole:'& can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
17880 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifing
17881 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
17883 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
17884 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
17885 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
17886 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
17890 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
17891 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
17892 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
17893 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
17894 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
17895 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
17896 redirection items of the form
17901 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies to the
17902 entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored (&':blackhole:'& is
17903 different). Any text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error
17904 text associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
17906 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
17908 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
17910 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
17911 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
17913 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
17914 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
17915 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
17917 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
17918 By default, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
17919 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
17920 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
17921 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
17922 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
17923 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
17924 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
17925 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
17928 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
17929 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
17930 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
17931 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
17933 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
17934 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
17935 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
17936 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
17937 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
17939 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
17940 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
17941 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain on the queue so that a
17942 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
17943 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
17947 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
17948 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
17949 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
17950 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
17951 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
17952 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
17953 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
17957 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
17958 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
17959 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
17960 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
17961 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
17962 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
17963 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
17964 aliasing scheme of the type
17966 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
17970 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
17971 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
17972 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
17975 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
17976 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
17978 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
17979 the pipes are distinct.
17983 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
17984 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
17985 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
17986 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
17987 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
17988 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
17989 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
17990 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
17991 can be used to avoid this.
17994 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
17995 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
17996 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
17997 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
17998 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
17999 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
18000 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
18004 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
18006 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
18007 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
18010 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
18011 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
18012 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
18015 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
18016 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
18017 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
18018 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
18021 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
18022 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
18023 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
18024 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
18025 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
18026 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
18027 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
18029 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
18030 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
18033 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
18034 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
18035 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
18036 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
18037 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
18041 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
18042 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
18043 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
18044 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
18045 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
18046 let ordinary users do.
18050 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
18051 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
18052 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
18053 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
18054 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
18055 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
18057 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
18058 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
18059 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
18060 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
18061 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
18062 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
18064 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
18066 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
18067 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
18068 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
18069 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
18070 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
18071 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
18072 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
18073 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
18076 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
18077 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
18078 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
18079 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
18080 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
18081 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
18082 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
18083 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
18087 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
18088 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
18089 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
18090 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
18091 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
18092 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
18095 .option data redirect string&!! unset
18096 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
18097 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
18098 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
18099 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
18100 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
18102 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
18103 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
18104 terminated with newline characters. For example:
18106 data = #Exim filter\n\
18107 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
18109 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
18110 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
18111 choice into a newline.
18114 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
18115 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
18116 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
18117 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
18118 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
18121 .option file redirect string&!! unset
18122 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
18123 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
18124 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
18125 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
18126 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
18127 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
18128 entirely of comments), the router declines.
18130 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
18131 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
18132 runs a check on the containing directory,
18133 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
18134 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
18135 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
18136 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
18137 not, the router declines.
18140 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
18141 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
18142 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
18143 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
18144 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
18145 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
18146 it is running, the file name is in &$address_file$&.
18149 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
18150 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
18151 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
18152 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
18153 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
18156 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
18157 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
18161 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
18162 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
18163 &%allow_filter%& is true.
18168 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
18169 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
18170 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
18171 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
18172 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
18173 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
18174 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
18175 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
18176 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
18179 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
18180 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
18181 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
18182 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
18185 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
18186 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
18187 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
18188 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
18190 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
18191 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
18192 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
18193 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
18194 &_.forward_& files).
18197 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
18198 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18199 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
18202 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
18203 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
18204 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
18205 of the embedded Perl support.
18208 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
18209 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18210 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
18213 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
18214 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18215 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
18218 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
18219 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
18220 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
18221 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
18222 &%one_time%& is set.
18225 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
18226 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
18227 to make use of &%run%& items.
18230 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
18231 If this option is true, items of the form
18233 :include:<path name>
18235 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
18238 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
18239 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
18240 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
18241 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
18242 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
18245 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
18246 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
18247 &%allow_filter%& is true.
18250 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
18251 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
18252 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
18253 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
18254 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
18259 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
18260 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
18261 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
18262 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
18263 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
18264 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
18265 bounce may well quote the generated address.
18268 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
18270 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
18271 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
18272 file did not exist.
18275 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
18277 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
18278 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
18279 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
18281 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
18282 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
18283 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
18284 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
18285 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
18286 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
18287 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
18288 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
18292 .option include_directory redirect string unset
18293 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
18294 redirection list must start with this directory.
18297 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
18298 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
18299 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
18302 .option one_time redirect boolean false
18303 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
18304 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
18305 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
18306 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
18307 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
18308 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
18309 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
18310 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
18311 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
18312 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
18313 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
18314 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
18315 before they subscribed.
18317 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
18318 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
18319 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
18320 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
18323 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
18324 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
18325 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
18326 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
18328 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
18329 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
18330 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
18332 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
18335 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
18336 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
18337 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
18338 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
18339 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
18343 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
18344 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
18345 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
18346 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
18347 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
18348 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
18349 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
18350 See &%check_owner%& above.
18353 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
18354 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
18355 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
18356 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
18359 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
18360 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
18361 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
18362 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
18363 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
18364 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
18365 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
18368 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
18369 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
18370 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
18371 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
18372 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
18373 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
18374 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
18375 &$qualify_recipient$&.
18377 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
18378 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
18379 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
18382 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
18383 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
18384 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
18385 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
18386 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
18387 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
18388 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
18389 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
18390 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
18391 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
18394 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
18395 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
18396 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
18397 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
18398 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
18399 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
18402 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
18403 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
18404 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
18405 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
18406 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
18407 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
18410 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
18411 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
18412 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
18413 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
18414 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
18417 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
18418 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
18419 :subaddress part of an address.
18421 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
18422 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
18423 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
18424 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
18427 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
18428 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
18429 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
18430 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
18431 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
18432 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
18433 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
18437 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
18438 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
18439 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
18440 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
18441 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
18442 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
18443 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
18444 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
18445 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
18446 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
18447 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
18448 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
18449 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
18450 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
18451 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
18452 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
18454 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
18455 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
18456 the following routers.
18458 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
18459 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
18460 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
18461 so it is passed to the following routers.
18463 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
18464 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
18465 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
18466 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
18468 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
18469 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
18470 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
18471 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
18477 file = $home/.forward
18478 file_transport = address_file
18479 pipe_transport = address_pipe
18480 reply_transport = address_reply
18483 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
18484 syntax_errors_text = \
18485 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
18486 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
18487 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
18488 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
18489 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
18490 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
18491 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
18492 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
18493 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
18494 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
18496 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
18497 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
18498 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
18503 local_part_prefix = real-
18504 transport = local_delivery
18507 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
18508 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
18510 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
18511 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
18516 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
18517 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
18520 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
18521 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
18522 .ecindex IIDredrou1
18523 .ecindex IIDredrou2
18530 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18531 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18533 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
18534 "Environment for local transports"
18535 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
18536 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment for local transports"
18537 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
18538 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
18539 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
18540 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
18541 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
18543 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
18544 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
18545 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
18546 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
18548 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
18549 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
18550 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
18551 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
18552 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
18556 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
18557 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
18558 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
18559 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
18560 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
18561 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
18562 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
18565 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
18566 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
18570 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
18572 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
18573 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
18574 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
18575 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
18580 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
18581 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
18582 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
18583 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
18584 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
18585 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
18586 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
18587 group (set by the transport). For example:
18590 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
18594 transport = group_delivery
18597 # This transport overrides the group
18599 driver = appendfile
18600 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
18603 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
18604 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
18605 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
18608 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
18609 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
18610 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
18611 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
18612 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
18613 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
18615 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
18616 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
18617 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
18618 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
18619 original gid is also used.
18621 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
18622 following that is set is used:
18625 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
18627 A &%group%& setting of the router;
18629 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
18630 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
18632 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
18634 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
18635 the uid is the creator's uid;
18637 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
18640 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
18641 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
18642 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
18643 The first of the following that is set is used:
18646 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
18648 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
18650 A &%user%& setting of the router;
18652 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
18657 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
18658 &%never_users%& list.
18664 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
18665 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
18666 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
18667 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
18668 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
18669 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
18670 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
18671 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
18672 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
18673 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
18676 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
18678 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
18680 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
18682 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
18685 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
18688 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
18690 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
18694 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
18695 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
18696 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
18700 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
18701 .vindex "&$domain$&"
18702 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
18703 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
18704 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
18705 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
18706 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
18707 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
18708 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
18709 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
18710 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
18711 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
18712 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
18713 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
18721 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18722 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18724 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
18725 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
18726 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
18727 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
18728 The following generic options apply to all transports:
18731 .option body_only transports boolean false
18732 .cindex "transport" "body only"
18733 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
18734 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
18735 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
18736 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
18737 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
18738 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
18739 automatically suppress them.
18742 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
18743 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
18744 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
18745 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
18746 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
18747 logged, and delivery is deferred.
18750 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
18751 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
18752 deliveries by the transport or for any
18753 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
18754 what you are doing.
18757 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
18758 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
18759 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
18760 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
18762 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
18763 output, and Exim carries on processing.
18764 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
18765 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
18766 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
18767 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
18771 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
18772 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
18773 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
18774 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
18775 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
18776 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
18777 safely be resent to other recipients.
18780 .option driver transports string unset
18781 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
18782 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
18785 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
18786 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
18787 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
18788 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
18789 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
18790 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
18791 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
18792 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
18793 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
18794 resent to other recipients.
18797 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
18798 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
18799 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
18800 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
18801 &%user%& (see below).
18804 .option headers_add transports string&!! unset
18805 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
18806 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
18807 This option specifies a string of text that is expanded and added to the header
18808 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
18809 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
18810 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
18811 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
18812 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
18816 .option headers_only transports boolean false
18817 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
18818 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
18819 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
18820 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
18821 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
18822 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
18823 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
18826 .option headers_remove transports string&!! unset
18827 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
18828 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
18829 This option specifies a string that is expanded into a list of header names;
18830 these headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
18831 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
18832 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
18833 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
18834 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
18838 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
18839 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
18840 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
18841 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
18842 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
18843 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
18844 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
18845 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
18848 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
18851 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
18852 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
18853 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
18854 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
18855 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
18856 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
18857 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
18858 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
18859 change envelope recipients at this time.
18862 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
18863 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
18865 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
18866 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
18867 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
18868 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
18869 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
18870 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
18871 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
18875 .option initgroups transports boolean false
18876 .cindex "additional groups"
18877 .cindex "groups" "additional"
18878 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
18879 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
18880 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
18881 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
18884 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
18885 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
18886 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
18887 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
18888 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
18889 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
18890 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
18891 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
18892 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
18893 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
18894 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
18895 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
18896 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
18901 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
18902 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
18903 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
18904 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
18905 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
18906 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
18907 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
18908 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
18911 local_part_prefix = *-
18913 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
18916 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
18918 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
18919 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
18920 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
18921 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
18922 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
18925 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
18926 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
18927 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
18928 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
18929 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
18930 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
18931 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
18932 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
18933 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
18935 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
18936 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
18937 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
18938 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
18940 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
18941 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
18942 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
18945 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
18946 .cindex "envelope sender"
18947 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
18948 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
18949 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
18950 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
18951 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
18952 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
18953 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
18954 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
18955 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
18957 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
18958 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
18960 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
18961 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
18962 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
18963 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
18964 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
18965 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
18966 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
18968 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
18969 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
18970 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
18971 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
18972 &%errors_to%& in a router.
18976 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
18977 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
18978 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
18979 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
18980 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
18981 have easy access to it.
18983 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
18984 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
18985 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
18986 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
18987 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
18991 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
18992 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
18995 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
18996 .cindex "shadow transport"
18997 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
18998 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
18999 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
19001 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
19002 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
19003 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
19004 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
19005 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
19006 cause a log line to be written.
19008 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
19009 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
19010 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
19011 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
19012 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
19015 ST=<shadow transport name>
19017 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
19018 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
19019 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
19020 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
19021 headers that some sites insist on.
19024 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
19025 .cindex "transport" "filter"
19026 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
19027 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
19028 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
19029 individual users or via a system filter.
19031 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
19032 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
19033 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
19034 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock). The
19035 command must be specified as an absolute path.
19037 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
19038 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
19039 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
19040 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
19041 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
19042 &(pipe)& transports.
19044 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
19045 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
19046 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
19047 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
19048 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
19050 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
19051 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. A demonstration Perl script is provided in
19052 &_util/transport-filter.pl_&; this makes a few arbitrary modifications just to
19053 show the possibilities. Exim does not check the result, except to test for a
19054 final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over SMTP must end
19055 with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
19057 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
19058 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
19059 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
19060 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
19061 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
19062 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
19064 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
19065 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
19066 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
19067 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
19068 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
19069 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
19070 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
19071 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
19073 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
19074 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
19075 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
19076 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
19077 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
19078 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
19079 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
19080 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
19081 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
19082 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
19085 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
19086 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
19087 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
19088 which the message is being sent. For example:
19090 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
19091 $host $host_address $sender_address $pipe_addresses
19094 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
19095 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
19096 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
19098 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
19099 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
19100 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
19103 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
19105 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
19106 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise. If double quotes had been used, they would have been
19107 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
19108 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
19109 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
19110 Exim tried to expand the first one.
19112 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
19113 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
19114 arguments. Consider this example:
19116 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
19117 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
19119 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
19120 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
19122 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
19123 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
19127 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
19128 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
19129 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
19130 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
19131 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
19132 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
19133 bounced from a transport filter.
19135 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
19136 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
19137 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
19140 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
19141 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
19142 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it a applies a timeout
19143 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
19144 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
19145 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
19146 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
19147 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
19148 becomes a temporary error.
19151 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
19152 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
19153 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
19154 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
19155 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
19156 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
19157 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
19160 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
19161 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
19162 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
19164 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
19165 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
19166 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
19167 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
19169 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
19170 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
19171 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
19178 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19179 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19181 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
19183 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
19184 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
19185 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
19186 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
19187 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
19188 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
19189 copy of the message is delivered each time.
19191 .cindex "batched local delivery"
19192 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
19193 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
19194 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
19195 local transport, for example:
19198 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
19199 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
19200 recipients saves space.
19202 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
19203 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
19205 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
19206 to a scanner program or
19207 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
19211 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
19212 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
19213 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
19215 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
19216 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
19217 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
19218 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
19219 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
19220 to certain conditions:
19223 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19224 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
19225 batching is possible.
19227 .vindex "&$domain$&"
19228 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
19229 addresses with the same domain are batched.
19231 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
19232 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
19233 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
19234 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
19235 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
19238 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
19239 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
19240 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
19244 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
19245 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
19246 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
19247 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
19248 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
19249 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
19250 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
19253 escape_string = ".."
19255 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
19256 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
19257 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
19259 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
19260 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
19261 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
19262 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
19263 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
19264 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
19266 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
19267 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
19268 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
19269 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
19270 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
19271 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
19272 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
19273 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
19274 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
19279 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19280 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19282 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
19283 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
19284 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
19285 .cindex "directory creation"
19286 .cindex "creating directories"
19287 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
19288 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
19289 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
19290 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
19291 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
19292 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
19293 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
19294 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
19295 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
19296 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
19298 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
19299 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
19300 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
19303 .cindex "quota" "system"
19304 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
19305 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
19306 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
19308 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
19309 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
19310 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
19311 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
19313 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
19314 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
19317 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
19318 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
19319 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
19320 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
19325 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
19326 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
19327 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
19328 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
19329 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
19331 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
19332 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19333 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
19334 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
19335 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
19336 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
19337 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
19338 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
19339 operation. There are two cases:
19342 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
19343 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
19344 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
19345 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
19346 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
19347 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
19348 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
19350 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
19351 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
19352 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
19356 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
19357 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
19358 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
19359 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
19364 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
19366 require "fileinto";
19367 fileinto "folder23";
19369 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
19370 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute file name. In the
19371 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the name that
19372 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
19373 way of handling this requirement:
19375 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
19376 {/var/mail/$local_part} \
19377 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
19379 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
19383 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
19384 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
19385 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
19387 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
19388 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
19389 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
19390 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
19391 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
19392 path to the transport.
19394 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
19395 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
19400 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
19401 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
19405 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
19406 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
19407 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
19408 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
19409 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
19410 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
19411 delivery is deferred.
19414 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
19415 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
19416 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
19417 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
19418 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
19419 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
19420 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
19421 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
19424 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
19425 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
19426 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
19427 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
19431 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
19432 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
19435 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
19436 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
19437 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
19438 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
19439 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
19442 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
19443 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
19444 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
19445 process is running.
19448 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
19449 .cindex "&""From""& line"
19450 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
19451 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
19452 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
19453 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
19454 contains is significant.
19456 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
19457 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
19458 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
19459 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
19460 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
19462 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
19463 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
19464 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
19465 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
19466 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
19467 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
19469 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
19470 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
19471 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
19472 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
19474 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
19475 .cindex "directory creation"
19476 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
19477 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
19478 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
19480 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
19481 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
19482 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
19483 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
19484 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
19488 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
19489 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
19490 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
19491 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
19492 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
19495 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
19496 &"belowhome"&. In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
19497 set for the transport. This option is not useful when an explicit file name is
19498 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when file
19499 names are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
19500 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
19501 &%file_must_exist%&.
19504 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
19505 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
19506 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
19507 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
19509 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
19510 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
19511 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
19512 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
19513 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
19516 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
19518 .vindex "&$inode$&"
19519 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
19520 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
19521 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
19523 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
19525 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
19526 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
19530 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
19531 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
19532 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
19535 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
19536 See &%check_string%& above.
19539 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
19540 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
19541 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
19542 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
19543 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
19544 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
19547 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
19548 .cindex "locking files"
19549 .cindex "lock files"
19550 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
19551 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
19553 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
19554 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
19557 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part
19558 file = /home/$local_part/inbox
19561 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
19562 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
19563 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
19564 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
19565 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
19566 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
19570 .option file_format appendfile string unset
19571 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
19572 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
19573 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
19574 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
19575 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
19576 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
19577 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
19578 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
19581 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
19582 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
19584 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
19585 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
19586 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
19587 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
19588 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
19589 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
19590 delivery is deferred.
19593 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
19594 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
19595 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
19596 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
19599 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
19600 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
19601 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
19602 .cindex "locking files"
19603 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
19604 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
19605 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
19606 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
19607 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
19608 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
19609 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
19610 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
19612 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
19613 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
19614 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
19615 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
19617 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
19618 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
19621 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
19623 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
19624 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
19625 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
19627 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
19628 local deliveries because of errors of the form
19630 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
19633 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
19634 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
19635 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
19636 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
19639 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
19640 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
19641 for details of locking.
19644 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
19645 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
19646 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
19649 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
19650 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
19651 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
19654 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
19655 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
19656 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
19657 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
19658 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
19661 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
19662 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
19663 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
19664 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
19665 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
19666 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
19667 external source that maintains the data.
19670 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
19671 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
19672 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
19673 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
19674 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
19675 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
19676 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
19677 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
19681 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
19682 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
19683 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
19684 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
19685 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
19686 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
19687 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
19688 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
19689 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
19690 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
19693 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
19694 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
19695 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
19696 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
19697 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
19698 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
19699 calculation. The default value is:
19701 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
19703 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
19704 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
19706 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
19708 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
19710 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
19711 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
19712 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
19713 directly into that directory.
19716 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
19717 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
19718 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
19721 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
19722 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
19723 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
19726 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile boolean false
19727 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
19728 Setting this option true enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
19729 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
19730 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
19731 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
19732 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
19734 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
19735 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
19736 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
19737 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
19738 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
19739 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
19740 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
19741 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
19742 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
19743 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
19746 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
19747 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
19748 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
19749 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
19750 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
19751 below for further details.
19754 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
19755 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
19756 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
19759 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
19760 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
19761 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
19764 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
19765 .cindex "locking files"
19766 .cindex "file" "locking"
19767 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
19768 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
19769 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
19770 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
19771 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
19772 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
19773 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
19775 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
19776 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
19777 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
19784 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
19785 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
19786 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
19787 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
19788 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
19789 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
19790 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
19791 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
19793 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
19794 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
19795 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
19796 append messages to it.
19799 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
19800 .cindex "&""From""& line"
19801 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
19802 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
19803 in which case it is:
19805 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
19806 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
19809 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
19810 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
19813 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
19814 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
19815 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
19816 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
19822 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
19823 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
19826 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
19827 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
19828 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
19829 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
19830 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
19831 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
19832 value, and this option is ignored.
19835 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
19836 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
19837 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
19838 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
19839 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
19842 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
19843 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
19844 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
19845 on users about incoming mail.
19848 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
19849 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
19850 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
19851 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
19852 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
19853 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
19854 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
19855 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
19856 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
19858 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
19859 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
19860 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
19862 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
19863 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
19864 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
19865 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
19866 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
19867 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
19869 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
19870 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
19871 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes. If Exim is running on a system with
19872 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
19875 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
19877 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
19878 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
19879 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
19880 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
19881 system quota failures.
19883 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
19884 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
19885 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
19886 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
19887 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
19888 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
19889 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
19890 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
19891 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
19892 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
19895 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
19896 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
19897 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
19898 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
19899 delivery directory.
19902 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
19903 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
19904 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
19905 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
19906 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
19910 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
19911 See &%quota%& above.
19914 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
19915 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
19916 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
19917 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
19918 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the file name, and it
19919 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
19920 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
19922 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
19923 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
19924 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
19925 the file length to the file name. For example:
19927 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
19928 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
19930 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
19931 number of lines in the message.
19933 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
19934 file name (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
19935 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message file names.
19939 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
19940 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
19941 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
19943 quota_warn_message = "\
19944 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
19945 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
19946 This message is automatically created \
19947 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
19948 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
19949 a warning threshold that is\n\
19950 set by the system administrator.\n"
19954 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
19955 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
19956 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
19957 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
19958 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
19959 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
19960 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
19961 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
19962 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
19966 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
19968 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
19969 percent sign is ignored.
19971 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
19972 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
19973 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
19974 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
19975 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
19976 &'From:'& line, the default is:
19978 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
19980 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
19981 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
19984 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
19985 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
19989 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
19990 .cindex "envelope sender"
19991 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
19992 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
19993 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
19994 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
19995 for details of batch SMTP.
19998 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
19999 .cindex "carriage return"
20001 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
20002 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
20003 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
20004 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
20007 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
20008 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
20009 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
20010 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
20011 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
20012 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
20016 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
20017 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
20018 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
20019 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
20020 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
20021 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
20024 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
20025 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
20026 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
20027 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
20028 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
20030 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
20031 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
20032 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
20033 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
20035 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
20036 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
20037 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
20038 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
20039 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
20042 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
20043 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
20046 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
20047 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
20048 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
20049 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
20050 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
20051 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
20052 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
20054 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20055 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
20056 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
20057 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
20060 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
20061 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
20062 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
20065 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
20066 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
20067 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
20068 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
20069 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
20070 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
20071 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
20072 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
20073 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
20075 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
20076 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
20077 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
20078 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
20083 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
20084 .cindex "appending to a file"
20085 .cindex "file" "appending"
20086 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
20089 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
20093 .cindex "directory creation"
20094 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
20095 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
20096 &%directory_mode%& option.
20099 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
20100 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
20104 .cindex "file" "locking"
20105 .cindex "locking files"
20106 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
20107 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
20108 reliably over NFS, as follows:
20111 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
20112 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
20113 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
20115 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock file name.
20117 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
20118 Unlink the hitching post name.
20120 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
20121 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
20122 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
20123 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
20125 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
20126 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
20127 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
20128 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
20129 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
20130 it before trying again.
20134 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
20135 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
20136 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
20139 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
20140 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
20141 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
20142 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
20143 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
20144 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
20145 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
20146 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
20147 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
20151 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
20152 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
20153 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
20154 delivery is deferred.
20157 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
20158 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
20159 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
20163 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
20164 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
20165 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
20168 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
20169 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
20170 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
20173 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
20174 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
20175 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
20176 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
20177 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
20178 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
20179 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
20180 that prevents link following.
20183 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
20184 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
20185 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
20186 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
20187 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
20190 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
20193 .cindex "file" "locking"
20194 .cindex "locking files"
20195 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
20196 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
20197 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
20198 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
20199 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
20201 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
20203 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
20204 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
20205 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
20207 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
20208 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
20209 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
20211 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
20212 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
20213 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
20214 delivery is deferred.
20216 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
20217 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
20218 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
20219 immediately. It retries up to
20221 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
20223 times (rounded up).
20226 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
20227 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
20230 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
20231 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
20232 .cindex "&""From""& line"
20233 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
20234 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
20235 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
20236 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
20237 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
20238 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
20239 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
20241 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
20242 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
20243 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
20244 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
20245 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
20246 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
20247 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
20249 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
20250 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
20251 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
20252 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
20255 .cindex "maildir format"
20256 .cindex "mailstore format"
20257 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
20258 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
20259 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
20260 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
20261 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
20263 .cindex "directory creation"
20264 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
20265 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
20266 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
20267 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
20268 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
20269 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
20274 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
20275 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
20276 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
20277 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
20278 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
20279 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
20280 &_new_& subdirectory.
20282 In the file name, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
20283 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
20284 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
20285 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
20286 file name. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
20287 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
20288 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
20290 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
20291 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
20292 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
20293 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
20294 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
20295 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
20296 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
20297 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
20299 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
20300 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
20301 folders. Consider this example:
20303 maildir_format = true
20304 directory = /var/mail/$local_part\
20305 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
20306 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
20307 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
20309 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
20310 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
20311 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
20312 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
20313 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
20314 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
20316 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
20317 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
20318 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
20319 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
20320 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
20322 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
20323 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
20324 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
20326 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
20327 .cindex "maildir++"
20328 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
20329 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
20330 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
20331 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
20332 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
20333 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
20334 amount of space used.
20336 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
20337 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
20338 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
20339 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
20340 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
20341 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
20346 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
20347 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
20348 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
20349 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
20350 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
20351 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
20353 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
20354 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
20355 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
20356 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
20357 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
20358 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
20359 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
20360 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
20361 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
20366 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
20367 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
20368 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
20369 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
20370 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
20371 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
20372 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
20373 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
20374 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
20376 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
20377 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
20378 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
20379 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
20380 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
20381 need to know the quota.
20383 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
20384 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
20386 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
20387 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
20388 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
20392 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
20393 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
20394 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
20395 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
20396 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
20397 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
20398 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
20399 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
20401 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
20402 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
20403 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
20404 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
20405 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
20406 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
20408 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
20409 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
20410 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
20411 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
20412 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
20413 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
20415 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
20416 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
20417 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
20418 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
20421 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
20422 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
20423 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
20424 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
20425 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
20427 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
20429 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
20430 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
20431 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
20432 .ecindex IIDapptra1
20433 .ecindex IIDapptra2
20440 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20441 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20443 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
20444 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
20445 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
20446 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
20447 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
20448 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
20449 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
20450 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
20452 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
20453 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
20454 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
20455 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
20456 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
20459 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
20460 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
20461 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
20462 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
20463 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
20465 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
20466 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
20467 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
20468 transport is run as a consequence of a
20470 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
20471 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
20472 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
20473 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
20474 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
20475 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
20477 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
20478 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
20479 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
20480 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
20482 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
20483 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
20484 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
20485 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
20486 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
20487 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
20488 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
20490 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
20491 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
20492 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
20493 the transport defers.
20494 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
20495 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
20497 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
20498 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
20499 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
20500 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
20502 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
20503 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
20504 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
20505 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
20506 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
20507 problems. They are just discarded.
20511 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
20512 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
20514 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
20515 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
20516 message when the message is specified by the transport.
20519 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
20520 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
20521 when the message is specified by the transport.
20524 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
20525 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
20526 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
20527 string comes first.
20530 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
20531 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
20532 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
20535 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
20536 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
20537 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
20540 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
20541 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
20542 specified by the transport.
20545 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
20546 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
20547 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
20548 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
20551 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
20552 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
20553 the message is specified by the transport.
20556 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
20557 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
20561 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
20562 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
20563 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
20564 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
20565 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
20569 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
20570 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
20571 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
20572 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
20574 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
20575 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty file name, the message
20576 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
20577 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
20578 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
20579 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
20580 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
20583 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
20584 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
20585 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
20586 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
20587 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
20589 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
20590 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
20591 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
20592 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
20593 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
20594 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
20597 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
20598 See &%once%& above.
20601 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
20602 See &%once%& above.
20603 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
20606 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
20607 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
20608 specified by the transport.
20611 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
20612 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
20613 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
20614 configuration option.
20617 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
20618 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
20619 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
20620 automatic responses. For example:
20622 subject = Re: $h_subject:
20624 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
20625 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
20626 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
20627 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
20632 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
20633 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
20634 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
20635 the text comes first.
20638 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
20639 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
20640 when the message is specified by the transport.
20641 .ecindex IIDauttra1
20642 .ecindex IIDauttra2
20647 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20648 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20650 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
20651 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
20652 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
20653 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
20654 .cindex "LMTP" "over a socket"
20655 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
20657 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
20658 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
20659 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
20660 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
20661 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
20662 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
20666 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
20667 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
20668 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
20671 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
20672 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20675 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
20676 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
20677 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
20678 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
20679 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20682 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
20683 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
20684 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
20685 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
20686 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
20687 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
20690 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
20691 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
20692 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
20693 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
20694 in its response to the LHLO command.
20696 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
20697 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
20698 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
20699 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
20702 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
20703 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
20704 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. &new("Delivery
20705 is deferred, and will be tried again later.") Here is an example of a typical
20710 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
20714 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
20715 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
20719 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20720 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20722 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
20723 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
20724 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
20725 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
20726 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
20727 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
20728 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
20729 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
20733 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
20734 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
20735 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
20736 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
20737 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
20739 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20740 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
20741 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
20742 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
20743 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
20744 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
20745 that are routed to the transport.
20747 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
20748 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
20749 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
20750 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If only
20751 one address is being transported (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or
20752 only one address was redirected to this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains
20753 the local part that was redirected.
20757 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
20758 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
20759 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
20761 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
20762 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
20763 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
20764 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
20765 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
20766 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
20767 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
20770 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
20771 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
20772 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
20773 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
20774 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
20779 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
20780 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
20781 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
20782 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
20783 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
20784 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
20785 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
20786 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
20787 &"local delivery failed"&.
20789 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
20790 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
20791 value is the return code minus 128.
20793 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
20794 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
20795 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
20796 a non-existent command may be the problem.
20798 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
20799 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
20800 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
20801 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
20802 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
20803 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
20804 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
20809 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
20810 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
20811 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
20812 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
20813 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
20816 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
20817 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
20818 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
20819 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
20821 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
20822 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
20823 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
20824 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
20825 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
20827 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
20829 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
20830 arguments. You have to write
20832 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
20834 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
20835 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
20836 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
20837 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
20838 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
20839 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
20842 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
20845 .cindex "transport" "filter"
20846 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
20847 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
20848 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
20849 &`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
20850 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
20851 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
20852 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
20853 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
20854 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
20856 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
20857 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
20858 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
20859 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
20860 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
20861 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
20862 control what is done with it.
20864 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
20865 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
20866 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
20867 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
20868 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
20869 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
20870 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
20871 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
20872 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
20873 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
20874 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
20878 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
20879 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
20880 .cindex "environment for pipe transport"
20881 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
20882 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
20883 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
20886 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
20887 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
20888 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
20889 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
20890 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
20891 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
20892 &`LOGNAME `& see below
20893 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
20894 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
20895 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
20896 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
20897 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
20898 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
20899 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
20900 &`USER `& see below
20902 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
20903 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
20904 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
20905 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
20906 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
20907 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
20908 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
20911 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
20912 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
20913 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
20917 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
20918 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
20919 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
20920 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
20923 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
20924 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
20928 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
20929 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
20930 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
20931 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
20932 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
20933 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
20934 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
20935 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
20936 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
20937 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
20938 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
20941 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
20943 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
20944 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
20945 &%use_shell%& is set.
20948 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
20949 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20952 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
20953 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
20954 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
20957 .option check_string pipe string unset
20958 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
20959 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
20960 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
20961 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
20962 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
20963 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
20964 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
20968 .option command pipe string&!! unset
20969 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
20970 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
20971 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
20972 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
20973 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
20974 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
20977 .option environment pipe string&!! unset
20978 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
20979 .cindex "environment for &(pipe)& transport"
20980 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
20981 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
20982 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
20983 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
20986 .option escape_string pipe string unset
20987 See &%check_string%& above.
20990 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
20991 .cindex "exec failure"
20992 .cindex "failure of exec"
20993 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
20994 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
20995 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
20996 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
20997 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
21000 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
21001 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
21002 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
21003 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
21004 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
21005 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
21007 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
21008 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
21010 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
21011 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
21012 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
21013 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
21014 and any output was produced, the first line of it is written to the main log.
21017 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
21018 If this option is set, and the command returns any output, and also ends with a
21019 return code that is neither zero nor one of the return codes listed in
21020 &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery failed), the first line of output is
21021 written to the main log. This option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive.
21022 Only one of them may be set.
21026 .option log_output pipe boolean false
21027 If this option is set and the command returns any output, the first line of
21028 output is written to the main log, whatever the return code. This option and
21029 &%log_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
21033 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
21034 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
21035 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
21036 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
21037 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
21038 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
21039 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
21040 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
21043 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
21044 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
21045 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
21048 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
21052 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
21053 .cindex "&""From""& line"
21054 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
21055 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
21056 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
21062 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21063 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
21067 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
21068 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
21069 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
21070 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
21075 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
21076 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
21080 .option path pipe string "see below"
21081 This option specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
21082 variable of the subprocess. The default is:
21086 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
21087 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
21088 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
21091 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
21092 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
21093 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
21094 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
21095 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
21096 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
21097 accept the message is used.
21100 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
21101 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
21102 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
21103 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
21104 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
21105 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
21108 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
21109 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
21110 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
21111 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
21112 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
21113 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
21114 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
21118 .option return_output pipe boolean false
21119 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
21120 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
21121 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
21122 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
21123 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
21124 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
21125 of them may be set.
21129 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
21130 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
21131 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
21132 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
21133 and &%return_output%& is not set,
21134 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
21135 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
21136 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
21137 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
21138 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
21139 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
21140 and 73, respectively.
21143 .option timeout pipe time 1h
21144 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
21145 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
21146 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
21147 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
21148 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
21149 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
21151 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
21152 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
21153 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
21154 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
21155 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
21156 delivery to be deferred.
21158 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
21159 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
21162 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
21163 .cindex "envelope sender"
21164 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
21165 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
21166 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
21167 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
21168 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
21170 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
21171 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
21172 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
21173 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
21174 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
21175 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
21179 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
21180 .cindex "carriage return"
21182 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
21183 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
21184 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
21185 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
21188 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
21189 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
21190 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
21191 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
21192 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
21196 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
21197 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
21198 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
21199 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
21200 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
21201 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
21202 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
21203 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
21204 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
21209 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
21210 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
21211 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
21212 .cindex "external local delivery"
21213 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
21214 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
21215 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
21216 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
21217 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
21218 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
21219 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
21220 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
21221 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
21222 configuration for &%procmail%&:
21227 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part
21231 check_string = "From "
21232 escape_string = ">From "
21240 transport = procmail_pipe
21242 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
21243 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
21244 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
21245 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
21246 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
21247 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
21249 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
21253 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
21254 use a shell to run pipe commands.
21257 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
21258 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
21261 local_delivery_cyrus:
21263 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
21264 -m ${substr_1:$local_part_suffix} -- $local_part
21276 local_part_suffix = .*
21277 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
21279 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
21280 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
21282 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
21283 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
21286 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21287 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21289 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
21290 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
21291 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
21292 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
21293 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
21294 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
21295 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
21296 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
21299 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
21300 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
21304 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
21305 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
21306 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
21307 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
21308 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
21309 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
21310 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
21312 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
21313 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
21314 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
21315 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
21316 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
21317 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
21322 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
21323 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
21324 no further messages are sent over that connection.
21328 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
21330 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21331 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
21332 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
21333 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
21334 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
21335 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
21336 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
21337 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
21341 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
21342 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
21343 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
21344 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_cipher$&
21345 and &$tls_peerdn$& are the values that were set when the message was received.
21346 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
21347 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these two
21348 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
21349 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
21350 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
21351 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
21355 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
21356 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
21357 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
21360 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
21361 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
21362 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
21363 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
21364 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
21365 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
21366 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
21367 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
21369 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
21370 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
21371 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
21372 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
21373 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
21374 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
21375 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
21376 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
21377 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
21380 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
21382 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
21383 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
21384 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
21385 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
21386 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
21390 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
21391 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
21392 &$tls_cipher$&, and &$tls_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
21393 particular connection.
21396 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
21397 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
21398 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
21399 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
21401 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
21402 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
21403 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
21405 authenticated_sender = $local_part
21407 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
21408 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
21410 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
21411 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
21415 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
21416 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
21417 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
21418 authenticated as a client.
21421 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
21422 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
21423 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
21424 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
21427 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
21428 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
21429 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
21430 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
21431 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
21432 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
21433 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
21436 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
21437 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
21438 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
21439 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
21440 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
21441 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
21442 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
21446 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
21447 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
21448 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
21449 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
21452 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
21453 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
21454 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
21457 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
21458 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
21459 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
21460 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
21461 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
21462 unhappy at this prospect, so...
21464 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
21465 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
21466 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
21467 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
21468 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
21469 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
21470 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
21471 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
21475 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
21476 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
21477 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
21478 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
21479 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
21482 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
21483 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
21484 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
21485 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
21490 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
21491 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
21492 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
21493 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
21494 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
21495 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
21496 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
21497 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
21499 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
21500 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
21501 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
21502 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
21503 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
21504 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
21506 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
21507 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
21508 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
21509 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
21510 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
21512 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
21513 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
21514 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
21515 copy of the message is sent.
21517 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
21518 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
21519 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
21520 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
21524 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
21525 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
21526 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
21529 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
21530 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
21531 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
21532 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
21533 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
21534 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
21536 .option gnutls_require_kx main string unset
21537 This option controls the key exchange mechanisms when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
21538 client. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
21540 .option gnutls_require_mac main string unset
21541 This option controls the MAC algorithms when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
21542 client. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
21544 .option gnutls_require_protocols main string unset
21545 This option controls the protocols when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
21546 client. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
21548 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
21549 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
21550 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
21551 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
21552 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
21553 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
21554 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
21559 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
21560 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
21561 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
21562 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
21563 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
21564 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
21565 interface address, you could use this:
21567 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
21568 {$primary_hostname}}
21570 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
21573 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
21574 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
21575 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
21576 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
21577 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
21578 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
21580 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
21581 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
21582 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
21583 &%hosts_override%& is set.
21585 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
21586 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
21587 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
21588 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
21589 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
21590 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
21591 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
21593 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
21594 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
21595 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
21596 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
21597 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
21598 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
21599 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
21602 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
21603 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
21606 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
21607 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
21608 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
21609 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
21610 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
21611 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
21612 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
21613 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
21614 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
21615 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
21618 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
21619 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
21620 Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
21621 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
21624 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
21625 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
21626 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
21627 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
21630 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
21631 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
21632 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
21633 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
21634 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
21635 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
21636 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
21637 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
21640 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
21641 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
21642 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
21647 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
21648 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
21649 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
21650 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
21651 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
21652 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
21653 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
21654 explanation of when this might be needed.
21657 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
21658 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
21659 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
21660 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
21661 &%fallback_hosts%&.
21664 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
21665 .cindex "randomized host list"
21666 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
21667 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
21668 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
21669 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
21670 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
21671 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
21672 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
21673 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
21675 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
21676 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
21677 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
21678 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
21680 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
21682 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
21683 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
21684 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
21686 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
21687 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
21688 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
21689 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
21690 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
21691 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
21692 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
21693 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
21694 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
21697 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
21698 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
21699 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
21700 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
21701 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
21702 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
21704 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
21705 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
21706 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
21707 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
21708 connects. If authentication fails, Exim will try to transfer the message
21709 unauthenticated. See also &%hosts_require_auth%&, and chapter
21710 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
21712 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
21713 .cindex "bind IP address"
21714 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
21716 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21717 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
21718 call. &new("The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
21719 &`eth0`&.") Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
21720 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
21721 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
21722 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
21723 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
21726 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
21727 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
21728 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
21729 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
21730 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
21731 separator can be changed in the usual way. For example:
21733 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
21735 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
21736 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
21737 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
21738 interface to use if the host has more than one.
21741 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
21742 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
21743 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
21744 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
21745 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
21746 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
21747 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
21748 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
21749 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
21750 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
21754 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
21755 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
21756 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
21757 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
21758 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
21760 .option max_rcpt smtp integer 100
21761 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
21762 This option limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
21763 SMTP message transaction. Each set of addresses is treated independently, and
21764 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
21768 .option multi_domain smtp boolean true
21769 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21770 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
21771 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
21772 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
21773 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
21774 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
21775 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
21778 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
21779 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
21780 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
21781 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
21782 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
21783 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
21784 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
21785 variable that contains an outgoing port.
21787 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
21788 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
21789 normally &"smtp"&, but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"&, the default is
21790 &"lmtp"&. If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
21795 .option protocol smtp string smtp
21796 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
21797 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
21798 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
21799 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
21800 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
21801 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
21804 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean true
21805 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
21806 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
21807 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
21808 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
21809 addresses is not affected.
21811 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
21812 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
21813 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
21814 Exim to use only the host name. This should normally be done on a separate
21815 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, set up specially to handle the dialup
21819 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
21820 .cindex "serializing connections"
21821 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
21822 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
21823 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
21824 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
21825 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
21826 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
21827 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
21829 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
21830 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
21831 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
21832 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
21833 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
21834 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
21836 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
21837 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
21838 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
21839 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
21840 are used for ETRN serialization.
21843 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
21844 .cindex "SMTP" "SIZE"
21845 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
21846 .cindex "size" "of message"
21847 .cindex "transport" "filter"
21848 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
21849 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
21850 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
21851 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
21852 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
21853 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
21854 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
21856 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
21857 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
21860 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
21861 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
21862 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
21864 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21865 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
21866 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
21867 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
21868 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
21871 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
21872 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
21873 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
21874 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
21878 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
21879 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
21880 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
21881 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
21882 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
21885 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
21886 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
21888 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21889 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
21890 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
21891 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
21892 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
21893 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
21894 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
21895 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
21898 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
21899 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
21900 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
21902 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21903 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
21904 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
21905 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
21906 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
21907 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
21908 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
21909 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
21910 ciphers is a preference order.
21914 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
21915 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
21916 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
21917 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
21918 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
21919 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
21920 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
21921 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
21922 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
21923 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
21927 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! unset
21928 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
21929 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
21931 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
21932 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file containing
21933 permitted server certificates, for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
21934 Alternatively, if you are using OpenSSL, you can set
21935 &%tls_verify_certificates%& to the name of a directory containing certificate
21936 files. This does not work with GnuTLS; the option must be set to the name of a
21937 single file if you are using GnuTLS. The values of &$host$& and
21938 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
21939 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
21944 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
21946 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
21947 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
21948 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
21949 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
21950 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
21953 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
21954 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
21955 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
21956 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
21959 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
21960 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
21961 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
21963 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
21964 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
21965 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
21966 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
21967 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
21969 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
21970 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
21971 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
21972 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
21973 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
21974 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
21975 see below for an exception).
21977 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
21978 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
21979 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
21980 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
21981 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
21983 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
21984 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
21985 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
21986 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
21987 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
21988 reached their retry times.
21990 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
21991 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
21992 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
21993 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
21994 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
21995 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
21996 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
21997 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
21998 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
21999 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
22002 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
22003 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
22004 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
22005 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
22006 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
22007 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
22009 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
22010 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
22011 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
22012 possible IP addresses have been tried.
22013 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
22014 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
22020 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22021 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22023 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
22024 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
22025 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
22026 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
22027 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
22028 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
22030 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
22031 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
22032 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
22033 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
22034 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
22035 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
22036 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
22038 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
22039 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
22040 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
22041 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
22044 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
22045 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
22046 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
22047 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
22049 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
22050 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
22051 facility; you do not have to use it.
22053 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
22054 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
22055 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
22056 address to which it applies.
22058 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
22059 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
22060 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
22061 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
22062 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
22063 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
22066 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
22067 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
22068 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
22069 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
22072 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
22073 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
22074 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
22075 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
22076 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
22079 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
22080 illustrated by these examples:
22083 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
22084 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
22085 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
22086 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
22088 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
22089 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
22094 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
22095 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
22096 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
22097 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
22098 message's processing.
22100 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
22101 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
22102 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
22103 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
22104 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
22105 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
22106 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
22107 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
22108 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
22110 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22111 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22112 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
22113 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
22114 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
22115 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
22116 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
22117 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
22118 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
22119 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
22121 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
22122 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
22123 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
22124 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
22125 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
22126 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
22128 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
22129 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
22130 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
22132 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
22133 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
22134 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
22135 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
22136 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
22137 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
22138 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
22139 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
22140 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
22142 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
22143 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
22149 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
22150 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
22151 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
22152 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
22153 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
22154 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
22155 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
22156 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
22157 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
22158 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
22160 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
22162 might produce the output
22164 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22165 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22166 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22167 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22168 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22169 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22170 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
22171 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
22173 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
22174 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
22175 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
22176 set for a particular transport.
22179 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
22180 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
22181 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
22184 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
22186 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
22187 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
22188 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
22189 any colons must be doubled, of course).
22191 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
22192 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
22193 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
22194 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
22197 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
22198 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
22199 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
22201 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
22202 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
22203 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
22204 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
22205 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
22206 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
22207 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
22209 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22210 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22211 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
22212 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
22213 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
22217 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
22218 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
22221 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
22222 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
22223 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
22224 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
22225 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
22226 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
22227 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
22228 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
22229 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
22231 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
22232 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
22233 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
22235 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
22236 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
22237 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
22238 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
22239 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
22240 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
22241 of pattern they are set as follows:
22244 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
22245 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
22246 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
22249 *queen@*.fict.example
22251 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
22253 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
22257 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
22258 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
22261 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
22262 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
22263 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
22264 rewriting rule of the form
22266 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
22268 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
22274 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
22275 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
22276 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
22277 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
22278 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
22282 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
22283 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
22284 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
22285 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
22286 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
22288 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
22290 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
22293 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22294 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22295 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
22296 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
22297 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
22298 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
22299 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
22300 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
22301 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
22302 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
22303 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
22304 entry written to the panic log.
22308 .section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
22309 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
22312 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
22315 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
22317 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
22320 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
22321 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
22325 .section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
22327 .cindex "rewriting" "flags"
22328 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
22329 &<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
22330 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
22331 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
22332 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
22334 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
22335 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
22336 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
22337 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
22338 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
22339 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
22340 &`h`& rewrite all headers
22341 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
22342 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
22343 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
22345 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
22346 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
22349 .section "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" "SECTrewriteS"
22350 .cindex "SMTP" "rewriting malformed addresses"
22351 .cindex "RCPT" "rewriting argument of"
22352 .cindex "MAIL" "rewriting argument of"
22353 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
22354 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
22355 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
22356 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
22357 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
22359 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22360 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22361 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
22362 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
22363 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
22364 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
22365 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
22366 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
22369 .section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
22370 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
22371 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
22372 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
22375 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
22376 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
22377 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
22379 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
22380 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
22381 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
22382 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
22384 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
22385 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
22386 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
22388 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
22389 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
22390 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
22391 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
22393 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
22397 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
22400 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
22401 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
22402 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
22403 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
22404 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
22405 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
22406 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
22407 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which defaults to ISO-8859-1.
22409 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
22410 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
22414 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
22415 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
22417 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
22418 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
22419 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
22421 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
22422 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
22423 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
22424 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
22425 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
22426 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
22427 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
22428 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
22430 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
22431 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
22433 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
22435 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
22436 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
22438 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
22439 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
22440 messages that originate outside the local host:
22442 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
22443 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
22445 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
22448 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
22449 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
22450 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
22451 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
22452 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
22453 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
22454 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
22455 components. For example, the rule
22457 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
22459 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
22460 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
22461 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
22462 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
22463 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
22464 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
22465 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
22472 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22473 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22475 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
22476 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
22477 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
22479 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
22480 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
22481 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
22482 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
22483 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
22484 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
22485 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
22486 address, domain and error.
22489 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
22490 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
22491 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
22492 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
22493 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
22494 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
22495 log selector is set, the message
22496 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
22497 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
22498 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
22499 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
22501 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
22502 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
22503 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
22504 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
22505 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
22506 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
22507 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
22508 domain are maintained independently.
22510 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
22511 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
22512 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
22513 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
22514 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
22515 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
22516 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
22517 the local address is reached.
22519 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
22520 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
22521 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
22522 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
22523 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
22525 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
22526 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
22527 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
22528 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
22529 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
22530 messages that it should now be retaining.
22534 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
22535 .cindex "retry" "rules"
22536 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
22537 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
22538 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
22539 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
22540 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
22541 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
22542 message's sender, respectively.
22545 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
22546 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
22547 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
22548 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
22549 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
22550 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
22553 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
22555 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
22558 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
22560 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
22561 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
22564 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
22565 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a routing rule pattern, it
22566 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
22567 expressions work in address lists.
22569 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
22570 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
22574 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
22575 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
22576 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
22577 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
22578 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
22579 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
22580 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
22581 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
22582 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
22584 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
22585 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
22586 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
22587 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
22590 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
22591 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
22592 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
22593 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
22594 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
22595 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
22596 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
22597 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
22598 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
22599 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
22604 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
22606 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
22607 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
22608 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
22609 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
22610 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
22611 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
22613 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
22617 and the retry rules are
22619 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
22620 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
22622 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
22623 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
22624 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
22625 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
22626 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
22627 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
22629 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
22630 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
22631 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
22632 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
22634 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
22635 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
22636 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
22638 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
22640 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
22641 textual form of the IP address.
22643 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
22644 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
22645 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
22646 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
22649 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
22650 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
22651 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
22653 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
22654 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
22655 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
22657 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
22658 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
22660 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
22661 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
22664 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
22665 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
22666 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
22667 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
22668 retry rule of this form:
22670 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
22672 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
22673 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
22676 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
22677 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
22678 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
22679 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
22681 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
22682 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
22684 .vitem &%refused_A%&
22685 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
22688 A connection was refused.
22690 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
22691 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
22693 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
22694 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
22696 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
22697 A connection attempt timed out.
22699 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
22700 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
22701 obtained from an MX record.
22703 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
22704 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
22705 obtained from an MX record.
22708 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
22710 .vitem &%tls_required%&
22711 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
22712 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
22713 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
22716 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
22719 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
22720 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
22721 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
22722 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
22723 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
22724 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
22728 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
22729 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
22730 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
22731 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
22732 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
22736 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
22737 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
22738 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
22740 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
22741 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
22742 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
22743 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
22744 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
22745 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
22746 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
22748 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
22749 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
22752 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
22753 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
22754 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
22759 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
22760 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
22761 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
22762 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
22763 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
22766 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
22768 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
22770 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
22772 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
22773 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
22776 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
22778 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
22779 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
22780 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
22781 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
22782 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
22784 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
22785 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
22787 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
22789 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
22790 list is never matched.
22796 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
22797 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
22798 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
22799 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
22801 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
22803 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
22804 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
22805 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
22806 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
22807 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
22809 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
22810 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
22811 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
22812 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
22813 The available algorithms are:
22816 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
22819 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
22820 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
22821 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
22823 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
22824 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
22825 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
22826 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
22827 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
22828 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
22829 queue processing times.
22832 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
22833 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
22834 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
22835 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
22836 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
22837 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
22838 interval is found. The main configuration variable
22839 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
22840 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
22841 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
22842 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
22843 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
22845 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
22846 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
22847 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
22848 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
22849 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
22850 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
22853 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
22854 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
22855 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
22856 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
22857 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
22858 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
22859 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
22860 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
22861 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
22862 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
22863 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
22864 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
22866 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
22867 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
22868 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
22869 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
22870 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
22871 deliveries that have been deferred.
22874 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
22875 Here are some example retry rules:
22877 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
22878 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
22879 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
22880 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
22881 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
22882 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
22884 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
22885 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
22886 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
22887 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
22888 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
22889 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
22890 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
22893 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
22894 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
22895 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
22896 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
22897 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
22899 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
22900 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
22901 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
22902 were not obtained from an MX record.
22904 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
22905 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
22906 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
22907 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
22908 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
22912 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
22913 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
22914 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
22915 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
22916 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
22917 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
22918 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
22919 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
22920 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
22921 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
22922 failing for the first time.
22924 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
22925 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
22926 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
22927 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
22929 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
22930 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
22931 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
22936 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
22937 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
22938 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
22939 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
22940 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
22941 default retry rule:
22943 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
22945 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
22946 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
22947 failure for the recipient address that counts.
22949 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
22950 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
22951 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
22952 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
22953 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
22955 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
22956 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
22957 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
22959 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
22960 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
22961 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
22962 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
22963 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
22964 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
22965 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
22966 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
22968 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
22969 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
22970 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
22971 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
22972 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
22975 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
22976 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
22977 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
22978 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
22979 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
22980 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
22981 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
22982 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
22983 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
22986 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
22987 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
22988 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
22989 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
22990 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
22991 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
22992 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
22993 failing messages remain on the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
22996 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
22997 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
22998 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
22999 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
23000 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
23001 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
23002 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
23003 time out the address.
23005 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
23006 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
23007 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
23008 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
23009 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
23010 considered immediately.
23011 .ecindex IIDretconf1
23012 .ecindex IIDregconf2
23019 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23020 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23022 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
23023 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
23024 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
23025 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's run time configuration is concerned
23026 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
23027 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
23028 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
23029 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
23030 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
23033 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
23034 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
23037 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
23038 the client's EHLO command.
23040 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
23041 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
23043 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
23044 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
23045 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
23046 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
23047 with the AUTH command.
23049 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
23051 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
23052 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
23053 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
23056 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
23057 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
23058 unauthenticated connection.
23061 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
23062 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
23063 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
23064 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
23066 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
23067 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
23068 &`Connected to server.example.`&
23069 &`Escape character is '^]'.`&
23070 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
23071 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
23072 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
23073 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
23078 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
23079 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
23080 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
23081 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
23082 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
23083 included by setting
23086 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
23090 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
23091 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
23092 the Cyrus SASL authentication library. The third can be configured to support
23093 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
23094 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs. The fourth authenticator
23095 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
23097 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
23098 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
23099 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
23100 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
23101 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
23102 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
23103 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
23105 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
23106 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
23107 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
23108 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
23109 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
23110 both sets of options, is required. For example:
23114 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23115 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
23117 client_secret = secret2
23119 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
23120 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
23122 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
23123 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
23124 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
23129 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
23130 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
23131 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
23134 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23135 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
23136 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
23137 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
23138 encrypted by a setting such as:
23140 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_cipher}{}}
23142 (Older documentation incorrectly states that &$tls_cipher$& contains the cipher
23143 used for incoming messages. In fact, during SMTP delivery, it contains the
23144 cipher used for the delivery.)
23148 .option driver authenticators string unset
23149 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
23150 authenticators is to be used.
23153 .option public_name authenticators string unset
23154 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
23155 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
23156 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
23157 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
23158 defaults to the driver's instance name.
23161 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23162 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
23163 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
23164 mechanism is not advertised.
23165 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
23166 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
23167 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
23170 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23171 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
23172 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
23175 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
23176 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
23177 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
23178 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
23179 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
23180 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
23181 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
23182 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
23183 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
23187 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
23188 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
23189 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
23190 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
23191 out the values of variables.
23192 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
23193 output, and Exim carries on processing.
23196 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
23197 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
23198 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
23199 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
23200 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
23201 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
23202 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
23203 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
23204 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
23207 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23208 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
23209 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
23210 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
23211 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
23212 remembered for later use.
23213 How it is used is described in the following section.
23219 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
23220 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
23221 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
23222 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
23223 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
23227 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
23228 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
23230 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
23232 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
23233 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
23234 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
23235 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
23236 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
23237 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
23238 given for the MAIL command.
23240 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
23241 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
23244 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
23245 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
23246 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
23247 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
23248 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
23249 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
23250 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
23255 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
23256 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
23257 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
23258 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
23260 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
23261 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
23262 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
23263 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
23264 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
23269 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
23270 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
23271 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
23272 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
23276 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
23278 It the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
23279 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
23282 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
23283 the mechanisms are advertised.
23285 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
23286 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
23287 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
23288 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
23289 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
23290 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
23291 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
23293 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
23295 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
23297 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
23298 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
23299 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
23302 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
23304 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
23305 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
23306 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
23308 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
23309 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
23310 command. This is the case if
23313 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
23315 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
23317 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
23318 server authenticators.
23322 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
23323 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
23324 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
23326 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
23327 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
23328 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
23329 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
23330 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
23331 rejected with a 504 error.
23333 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
23334 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
23335 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
23336 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
23337 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
23338 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
23339 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
23340 no successful authentication.
23345 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
23346 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
23347 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
23348 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
23349 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
23350 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
23351 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
23355 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
23357 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
23358 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
23359 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
23360 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
23361 command line to run this script on such data might be
23363 encode '\0user\0password'
23365 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
23366 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
23367 whose code value is zero.
23369 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
23370 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
23371 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
23372 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
23374 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
23375 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
23376 example, a command such as
23378 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
23380 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
23382 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to do produce
23383 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
23385 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
23387 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
23388 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
23389 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
23390 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
23394 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
23395 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
23396 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
23397 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
23398 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
23399 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
23402 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
23403 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
23404 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
23405 of the authenticator.
23408 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23409 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
23410 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
23411 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
23412 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
23413 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
23414 delivery to be deferred.
23416 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
23417 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
23418 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
23421 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
23422 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
23423 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
23424 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
23425 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
23426 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
23427 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
23428 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
23429 deliver the message unauthenticated.
23432 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
23433 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
23434 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
23435 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
23436 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
23437 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
23438 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
23439 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
23440 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
23441 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
23442 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
23443 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
23444 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
23451 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23452 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23454 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
23455 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
23456 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
23457 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
23458 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
23459 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
23460 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
23461 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
23462 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
23463 connections as you do for login accounts.
23465 .section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
23466 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
23467 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
23469 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
23470 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
23471 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
23473 .option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
23474 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
23475 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
23478 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
23479 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23480 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23481 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
23482 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23483 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
23484 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23486 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
23487 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
23488 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
23489 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
23490 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
23491 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
23492 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
23494 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
23495 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
23496 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
23497 string expansions that also use them for other things.
23499 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
23500 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
23501 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
23503 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
23504 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
23505 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
23506 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
23507 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
23508 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
23509 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
23510 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
23511 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
23512 string as the error text.
23514 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
23515 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
23516 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
23520 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
23521 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
23522 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
23523 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
23524 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
23525 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
23526 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
23527 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
23529 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
23530 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
23531 configured as follows:
23535 public_name = PLAIN
23537 server_condition = \
23538 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
23539 server_set_id = $auth2
23541 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
23542 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
23543 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
23544 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
23546 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
23547 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
23548 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
23549 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
23553 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
23555 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
23557 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
23558 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
23562 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
23563 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
23565 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
23566 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
23567 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
23568 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
23569 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
23571 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
23572 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
23573 authenticating clients it could make sense.
23575 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
23576 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
23577 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
23578 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
23579 This is an incorrect example:
23581 server_condition = \
23582 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
23584 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
23585 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
23586 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
23587 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
23588 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
23589 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
23590 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
23592 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
23593 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
23595 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
23596 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
23597 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
23598 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
23599 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
23602 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
23603 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
23604 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
23605 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
23606 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
23607 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
23608 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
23612 public_name = LOGIN
23613 server_prompts = User Name : Password
23614 server_condition = \
23615 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
23616 server_set_id = $auth1
23618 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
23619 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
23620 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
23621 strings are used to obtain two data items.
23623 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
23624 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
23625 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
23626 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
23627 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
23631 public_name = LOGIN
23632 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
23633 server_condition = ${if ldapauth \
23634 {user="cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
23635 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
23636 ldap://ldap.example.org/}}
23637 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
23639 Note the use of the &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator to correctly quote the DN for
23640 authentication. However, the basic &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the
23641 LDAP quoting operators, is the correct one to use for the password, because
23642 quoting is needed only to make the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the
23643 LDAP level, the password is an uninterpreted string.
23647 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
23648 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
23649 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
23650 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
23651 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
23657 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
23658 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
23659 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
23661 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
23662 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
23663 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
23664 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
23667 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
23668 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
23669 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
23670 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
23671 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
23672 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
23673 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
23674 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
23675 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
23676 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
23677 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
23678 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
23680 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
23681 splitting takes priority and happens first.
23683 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
23684 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
23685 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
23686 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
23689 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
23690 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
23694 public_name = PLAIN
23695 client_send = ^username^mysecret
23697 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
23698 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs. A similar example
23699 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
23703 public_name = LOGIN
23704 client_send = : username : mysecret
23706 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
23707 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
23709 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
23710 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
23715 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23716 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23718 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
23719 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
23720 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
23721 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
23722 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5 mechanism"
23723 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
23724 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
23725 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
23726 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
23727 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
23728 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
23729 available in plain text at either end.
23732 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
23733 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
23734 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
23735 authenticator as a server:
23737 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
23738 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
23739 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
23740 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
23741 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
23742 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
23743 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
23744 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
23745 returned to the client.
23747 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
23748 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
23749 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
23750 numeric variables for other things.
23752 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
23753 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
23754 user name, authentication fails.
23758 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23759 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
23760 server_set_id = $auth1
23762 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
23763 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
23764 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
23765 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
23769 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23770 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
23772 server_set_id = $auth1
23774 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
23775 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
23778 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
23779 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
23780 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
23784 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
23785 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
23786 computing the response to the server's challenge.
23789 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
23790 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
23791 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
23795 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23796 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
23797 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
23798 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
23799 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
23800 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
23801 send the message to the current server.
23803 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
23808 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23810 client_secret = secret
23812 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
23813 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
23817 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23818 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23820 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
23821 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
23822 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
23823 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
23825 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick of A L
23826 Digital Ltd (&url(http://www.aldigital.co.uk)).
23828 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
23829 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
23830 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
23831 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
23832 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
23834 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
23835 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
23836 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
23837 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
23839 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example in GSSAPI
23840 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
23841 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
23842 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
23843 depending on the driver you are using.
23845 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
23846 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
23847 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
23848 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
23849 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
23850 implementation. For example, for Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
23851 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
23852 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
23853 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
23856 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
23857 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
23858 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
23859 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
23860 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
23861 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
23865 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
23866 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
23867 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
23868 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
23871 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
23872 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
23873 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
23874 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
23878 driver = cyrus_sasl
23879 public_name = X-ANYTHING
23880 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
23881 server_set_id = $auth1
23884 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string unset
23885 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
23888 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
23889 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
23892 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
23893 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
23894 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
23895 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
23898 driver = cyrus_sasl
23899 public_name = CRAM-MD5
23900 server_set_id = $auth1
23903 driver = cyrus_sasl
23904 public_name = PLAIN
23905 server_set_id = $auth1
23907 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
23908 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
23909 but it is present in many binary distributions.
23910 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
23911 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
23916 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23917 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23918 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
23919 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
23920 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
23921 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
23922 Dovecot POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
23923 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
23924 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
23925 authenticator only. There is only one option:
23927 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
23929 This option must specify the socket that is the interface to Dovecot
23930 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
23931 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
23932 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
23936 public_name = PLAIN
23937 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
23938 server_set_id = $auth1
23943 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
23944 server_set_id = $auth1
23946 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
23947 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
23948 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
23949 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
23950 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
23951 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
23952 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
23953 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
23956 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23957 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23959 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
23960 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
23961 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
23962 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
23963 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
23964 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
23965 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
23966 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
23967 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
23968 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
23969 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
23970 taken from the Samba project (&url(http://www.samba.org)). The code for the
23971 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
23975 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
23976 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
23978 The server sends back a challenge.
23980 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
23981 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
23984 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
23988 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
23989 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
23990 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
23992 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
23993 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
23994 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
23995 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
23996 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
23997 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
23998 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
23999 for other things. For example:
24004 server_password = \
24005 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
24007 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
24008 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
24014 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
24015 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
24016 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
24020 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
24021 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
24024 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
24025 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
24028 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
24029 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
24030 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
24036 client_username = msn/msn_username
24037 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
24038 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
24040 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
24041 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
24047 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24048 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24050 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
24051 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
24052 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
24053 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
24054 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
24057 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
24058 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
24059 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
24060 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
24061 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
24062 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
24063 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
24064 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
24065 certificates are used.
24067 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
24068 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
24069 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
24070 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
24071 between them is encrypted.
24073 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
24074 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
24075 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
24076 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
24079 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
24080 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
24081 in order to get TLS to work.
24085 .section "Support for the legacy &""ssmtp""& (aka &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
24087 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
24088 .cindex "smtps protocol"
24089 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
24090 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
24091 Early implementations of encrypted SMTP used a different TCP port from normal
24092 SMTP, and expected an encryption negotiation to start immediately, instead of
24093 waiting for a STARTTLS command from the client using the standard SMTP
24094 port. The protocol was called &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, and port 465 was
24095 allocated for this purpose.
24097 This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardized, but there are
24098 still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
24099 the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& global option. Its value must be a list of port
24100 numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
24102 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
24104 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
24105 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
24106 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
24107 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
24108 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
24111 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
24112 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the legacy behaviour for all ports.
24119 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
24120 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
24121 The first TLS support in Exim was implemented using OpenSSL. Support for GnuTLS
24122 followed later, when the first versions of GnuTLS were released. To build Exim
24123 to use GnuTLS, you need to set
24127 in Local/Makefile, in addition to
24131 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
24132 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
24134 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
24137 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must contain the name of a file, not the
24138 name of a directory (for OpenSSL it can be either).
24140 The &%tls_dhparam%& option is ignored, because early versions of GnuTLS had no
24141 facility for varying its Diffie-Hellman parameters. I understand that this has
24142 changed, but Exim has not been updated to provide this facility.
24144 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
24145 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
24146 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
24147 affects the value of the &$tls_peerdn$& variable.
24149 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
24150 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS uses underscores, for example: RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is
24151 more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present in a cipher list. To make
24152 life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens for OpenSSL and hyphens to
24153 underscores for GnuTLS when processing lists of cipher suites in the
24154 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
24157 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
24158 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
24162 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECID181"
24163 GnuTLS uses RSA and D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
24164 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
24165 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
24166 &_gnutls-params_&. The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
24167 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the RSA and D-H
24168 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
24169 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
24170 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
24171 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
24172 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
24174 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
24175 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
24176 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
24177 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
24178 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
24179 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
24180 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
24181 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
24183 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
24184 in &_gnutls-params_& in PEM format, which means that they can be generated
24185 externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
24187 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
24188 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
24189 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
24190 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
24194 # chown exim:exim new-params
24195 # chmod 0400 new-params
24196 # certtool --generate-privkey --bits 512 >new-params
24197 # echo "" >>new-params
24198 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 1024 >> new-params
24199 # mv new-params gnutls-params
24201 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
24202 stalling is removed.
24205 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
24206 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
24207 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
24208 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
24209 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
24210 are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
24211 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
24212 directly to this function call. The following quotation from the OpenSSL
24213 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
24216 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
24218 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
24219 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
24220 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
24223 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
24224 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
24225 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
24229 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
24232 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
24233 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
24236 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
24237 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
24239 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
24240 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
24243 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
24244 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
24245 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
24246 not be moved to the end of the list.
24251 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
24253 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
24254 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
24255 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
24256 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
24257 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
24258 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
24259 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to specify separate lists of permitted key
24260 exchange methods, main cipher algorithms, MAC algorithms, and protocols.
24261 Unfortunately, these lists are numerical, and the library does not have a
24262 function for turning names into numbers. Consequently, lists of recognized
24263 names have to be built into the application. The permitted key exchange
24264 methods, ciphers, and MAC algorithms may be used in any combination to form a
24265 cipher suite. This is unlike OpenSSL, where complete cipher suite names are
24266 passed to its control function.
24268 For compatibility with OpenSSL, the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option can be set
24269 to complete cipher suite names such as RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA, but for GnuTLS this
24270 option controls only the cipher algorithms. Exim searches each item in the
24271 list for the name of an available algorithm. For example, if the list
24272 contains RSA_AES_SHA, then AES is recognized, and the behaviour is exactly
24273 the same as if just AES were given.
24275 .oindex "&%gnutls_require_kx%&"
24276 .oindex "&%gnutls_require_mac%&"
24277 .oindex "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&"
24278 There are additional options called &%gnutls_require_kx%&,
24279 &%gnutls_require_mac%&, and &%gnutls_require_protocols%& that can be used to
24280 restrict the key exchange methods, MAC algorithms, and protocols, respectively.
24281 These options are ignored if OpenSSL is in use.
24283 All four options are available as global options, controlling how Exim
24284 behaves as a server, and also as options of the &(smtp)& transport, controlling
24285 how Exim behaves as a client. All the values are string expanded. After
24286 expansion, the values must be colon-separated lists, though the separator
24287 can be changed in the usual way.
24289 Each of the four lists starts out with a default set of algorithms. If the
24290 first item in a list does &'not'& start with an exclamation mark, all the
24291 default items are deleted. In this case, only those that are explicitly
24292 specified can be used. If the first item in a list &'does'& start with an
24293 exclamation mark, the defaults are left on the list.
24295 Then, any item that starts with an exclamation mark causes the relevant
24296 entry to be removed from the list, and any item that does not start with an
24297 exclamation mark causes a new entry to be added to the list. Unrecognized
24298 items in the list are ignored. Thus:
24300 tls_require_ciphers = !ARCFOUR
24302 allows all the defaults except ARCFOUR, whereas
24304 tls_require_ciphers = AES : 3DES
24306 allows only cipher suites that use AES or 3DES.
24308 For &%tls_require_ciphers%& the recognized names are AES_256, AES_128, AES
24309 (both of the preceding), 3DES, ARCFOUR_128, ARCFOUR_40, and ARCFOUR (both of
24310 the preceding). The default list does not contain all of these; it just has
24311 AES_256, AES_128, 3DES, and ARCFOUR_128.
24313 For &%gnutls_require_kx%&, the recognized names are DHE_RSA, RSA (which
24314 includes DHE_RSA), DHE_DSS, and DHE (which includes both DHE_RSA and
24315 DHE_DSS). The default list contains RSA, DHE_DSS, DHE_RSA.
24317 For &%gnutls_require_mac%&, the recognized names are SHA (synonym SHA1), and
24318 MD5. The default list contains SHA, MD5.
24320 For &%gnutls_require_protocols%&, the recognized names are TLS1 and SSL3.
24321 The default list contains TLS1, SSL3.
24323 In a server, the order of items in these lists is unimportant. The server
24324 advertises the availability of all the relevant cipher suites. However, in a
24325 client, the order in the &%tls_require_ciphers%& list specifies a preference
24326 order for the cipher algorithms. The first one in the client's list that is
24327 also advertised by the server is tried first. The default order is as listed
24332 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
24333 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
24334 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
24335 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
24336 but not to any others. The default value of this option is unset, which means
24337 that STARTTLS is not advertised at all. This default is chosen because you
24338 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available, and also it is
24339 sensible for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
24341 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
24342 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
24343 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
24346 554 Security failure
24348 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
24349 rejected with a 554 error code.
24351 To enable TLS operations on a server, you must set &%tls_advertise_hosts%& to
24352 match some hosts. You can, of course, set it to * to match all hosts.
24353 However, this is not all you need to do. TLS sessions to a server won't work
24354 without some further configuration at the server end.
24356 It is rumoured that all existing clients that support TLS/SSL use RSA
24357 encryption. To make this work you need to set, in the server,
24359 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
24360 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
24362 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
24363 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
24364 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
24365 that goes with it. These files need to be readable by the Exim user, and must
24366 always be given as full path names. They can be the same file if both the
24367 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
24368 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
24369 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
24370 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
24371 the server's certificate.
24373 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
24374 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
24375 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
24377 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
24378 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
24379 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
24382 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
24383 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
24384 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
24386 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
24388 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
24389 with the parameters contained in the file. This increases the set of cipher
24390 suites that the server supports. See the command
24394 for a way of generating this data. At present, &%tls_dhparam%& is used only
24395 when Exim is linked with OpenSSL. It is ignored if GnuTLS is being used.
24397 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
24398 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
24399 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
24400 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
24401 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
24403 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
24404 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
24405 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
24406 The variable &$tls_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
24407 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
24408 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
24409 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
24410 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
24411 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
24412 &new("(For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_cipher$& is reset &-- see section
24416 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
24417 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
24418 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
24419 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
24420 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
24421 documentation for more details.
24425 .section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
24426 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
24427 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
24428 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
24429 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
24430 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
24431 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
24432 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
24433 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
24434 expected certificates. These must be available in a file or,
24435 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, identified by
24436 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
24438 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
24441 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
24442 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
24443 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
24445 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
24447 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
24449 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
24450 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
24451 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
24452 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
24453 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
24454 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
24455 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
24456 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
24457 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
24458 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
24460 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
24461 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
24462 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
24463 &$tls_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
24465 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
24466 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
24467 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
24468 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
24469 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
24470 certificate is supplied, &$tls_peerdn$& is empty.
24473 .section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
24474 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
24475 .cindex "revocation list"
24476 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
24477 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
24478 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
24479 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
24480 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
24481 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
24485 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
24486 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
24487 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
24488 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
24489 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
24490 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
24491 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
24492 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
24493 within the &(smtp)& transport.
24495 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
24496 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
24497 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
24498 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
24499 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
24501 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
24502 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
24503 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
24504 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
24505 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
24508 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
24509 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
24510 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
24511 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
24512 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
24513 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
24514 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
24515 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
24516 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
24517 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
24520 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
24521 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
24522 if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
24523 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client. &*Note*&:
24524 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
24525 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
24526 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
24529 If &%tls_verify_certificates%& is set, it must name a file or,
24530 for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, that contains a collection of
24531 expected server certificates. The client verifies the server's certificate
24532 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
24533 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
24536 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
24537 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
24538 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
24539 alternative hosts, if any.
24542 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
24543 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
24544 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
24545 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
24546 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
24549 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
24550 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
24551 Before an SMTP connection is established, the &$tls_cipher$& and &$tls_peerdn$&
24552 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
24553 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
24554 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
24555 outgoing connection.
24560 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
24562 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
24563 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
24564 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
24565 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
24566 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
24567 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
24568 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
24569 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, Exim shuts down an existing TLS
24570 session before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
24571 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
24572 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
24574 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
24575 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
24576 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
24577 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
24578 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
24579 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
24580 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
24581 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
24582 and delay other deliveries to that host.
24584 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
24585 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
24586 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
24587 information is recorded.
24589 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
24590 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
24591 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
24596 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
24597 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
24598 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
24599 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities. This is not the
24600 place to give a tutorial, especially as I do not know very much about it
24601 myself. Some helpful introduction can be found in the FAQ for the SSL addition
24602 to Apache, currently at
24604 &url(http://www.modssl.org/docs/2.7/ssl_faq.html#ToC24)
24606 Other parts of the &'modssl'& documentation are also helpful, and have
24607 links to further files.
24608 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
24609 0-201-61598-3), contains both introductory and more in-depth descriptions.
24610 Some sample programs taken from the book are available from
24612 &url(http://www.rtfm.com/openssl-examples/)
24616 .section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
24617 The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
24618 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
24619 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
24620 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
24621 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
24622 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
24623 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
24624 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
24625 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
24626 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
24627 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
24628 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
24631 .section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
24632 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
24633 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
24634 with OpenSSL, like this:
24636 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
24639 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
24640 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
24641 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
24642 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
24643 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
24644 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
24645 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
24647 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
24648 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
24649 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
24651 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
24652 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
24653 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
24654 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
24655 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
24656 signed with that self-signed certificate.
24658 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
24659 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
24660 Open-source PKI book, available online at
24661 &url(http://ospkibook.sourceforge.net/).
24662 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
24663 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
24667 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24668 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24670 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
24671 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
24672 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
24673 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
24674 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
24675 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the run time
24676 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
24677 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
24678 one very small ACL:
24682 accept hosts = one.host.only
24684 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
24685 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
24687 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
24688 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
24689 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
24690 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
24691 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
24692 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
24693 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
24694 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
24697 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
24698 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
24699 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
24700 The host &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a service for checking your
24701 relaying configuration (see section &<<SECTcheralcon>>& for more details).
24705 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
24706 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
24707 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
24708 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
24709 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
24710 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
24711 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
24712 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
24713 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
24714 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
24715 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
24716 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
24717 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
24718 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
24719 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
24720 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
24721 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
24722 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
24725 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
24726 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
24727 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
24728 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
24729 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
24730 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
24731 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
24732 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
24733 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
24734 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
24735 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
24736 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
24737 .irow &new(&%acl_smtp_notquit%&) "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
24738 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
24739 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
24740 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
24741 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
24742 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
24745 For example, if you set
24747 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
24749 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
24750 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
24751 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
24752 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
24753 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
24754 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
24755 testing as possible at RCPT time.
24758 .section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
24759 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
24760 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
24761 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
24762 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
24763 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
24764 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
24765 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
24766 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
24767 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
24768 in any of these ACLs.
24770 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
24771 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
24772 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
24773 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
24774 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
24775 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
24776 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
24777 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
24779 control = suppress_local_fixups
24781 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
24782 run, it is too late.
24784 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
24785 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
24787 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
24788 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
24789 temporary error for these kinds of message.
24792 .section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
24793 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
24794 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
24795 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
24796 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
24797 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
24798 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
24799 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
24800 &%smtp_banner%& option.
24803 .section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
24804 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
24805 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
24806 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
24807 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
24808 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
24809 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
24810 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
24811 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
24813 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
24814 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
24815 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
24816 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
24820 .section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
24821 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
24822 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
24823 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
24824 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
24825 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
24826 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
24827 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
24828 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
24829 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
24831 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
24832 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
24833 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
24834 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
24835 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
24836 associated with the DATA command.
24838 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
24839 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
24840 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
24841 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
24842 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
24846 .section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
24847 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
24848 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
24851 .section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
24852 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
24853 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
24854 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
24855 does not in fact control any access. For this reason, the only verbs that are
24856 permitted are &%accept%& and &%warn%&.
24858 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
24859 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
24860 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
24861 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
24863 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
24864 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
24866 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
24867 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
24870 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
24871 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
24872 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
24873 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
24874 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
24879 .section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
24880 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%smtp_notquit_acl%&, is run in most cases when
24881 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is is bad
24882 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
24883 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
24884 situation even worse.
24886 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
24887 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
24888 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
24891 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
24892 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
24893 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
24894 connection. The possible values are:
24896 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
24897 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
24898 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
24899 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
24900 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
24901 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
24902 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
24903 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
24904 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
24905 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
24907 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
24908 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
24909 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
24910 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
24911 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
24916 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
24917 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
24918 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
24919 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
24921 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
24922 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
24924 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
24925 providing an RFC 4409 message submission service on port 587 and a
24926 non-standard &"smtps"& service on port 465. You can use a string
24927 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
24928 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
24930 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
24931 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
24932 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
24935 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a file name, and reads its
24936 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
24937 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
24938 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
24939 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
24940 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
24942 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
24943 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
24944 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
24946 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
24947 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
24948 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
24949 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
24951 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
24952 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
24953 matches the string.
24955 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
24956 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
24957 want to have something like
24959 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
24961 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
24962 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
24968 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
24969 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
24970 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
24971 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
24972 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
24973 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
24974 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
24975 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
24976 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
24978 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
24979 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
24980 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
24983 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
24984 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
24985 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
24986 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
24988 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
24989 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
24990 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
24991 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
24992 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
24993 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
24994 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
24997 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
24998 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
24999 recipients; it may create new recipients.
25003 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
25004 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
25005 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
25006 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
25007 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
25008 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
25010 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
25011 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
25012 used to accept or reject anything.
25014 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
25015 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
25016 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
25017 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
25019 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, and
25020 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%&), the action when the ACL is not defined is &"deny"&.
25021 This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be defined in order to receive any
25022 messages over an SMTP connection. For an example, see the ACL in the default
25023 configuration file.
25028 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
25029 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
25031 .vindex &$local_part$&
25032 .vindex &$sender_address$&
25033 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
25034 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
25035 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
25036 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
25037 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
25038 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
25039 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
25040 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
25042 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
25043 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
25044 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
25047 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
25048 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
25049 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
25050 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
25051 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
25054 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
25055 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
25056 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
25057 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
25058 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
25059 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
25060 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
25061 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
25067 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
25068 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
25069 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
25070 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
25071 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
25072 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
25073 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
25074 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
25075 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
25076 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
25077 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
25078 unencrypted connections.
25081 accept encrypted = *
25082 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
25084 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
25086 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
25087 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
25088 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
25089 option to do this.)
25093 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
25094 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
25095 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
25096 An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
25097 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
25098 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
25099 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
25101 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
25102 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
25103 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
25106 deny dnslists = list1.example
25107 dnslists = list2.example
25109 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
25110 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
25111 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
25112 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
25113 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
25116 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
25117 The ACL verbs are as follows:
25120 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
25121 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
25122 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
25123 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
25124 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
25125 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
25126 check a RCPT command:
25128 accept domains = +local_domains
25132 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
25133 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
25134 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
25135 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
25138 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
25139 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
25140 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
25143 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
25144 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
25145 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
25146 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
25147 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
25148 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
25150 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
25151 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
25153 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
25154 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
25155 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
25157 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
25158 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
25159 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
25164 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
25165 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
25166 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
25167 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
25168 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
25169 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
25170 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
25174 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
25175 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
25176 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
25179 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
25181 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
25185 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
25186 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
25187 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
25188 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
25189 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
25190 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
25191 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
25192 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
25193 do not appear in the log line when the &%log_recipients%& log selector is set.
25195 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
25196 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
25197 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
25201 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
25202 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
25203 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
25205 drop message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
25206 condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
25208 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
25209 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
25212 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
25213 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
25214 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
25215 example, when checking a RCPT command,
25217 require message = Sender did not verify
25220 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
25221 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
25222 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
25223 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
25226 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
25227 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
25228 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
25229 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
25230 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
25231 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
25232 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
25234 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
25235 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
25236 &%logwrite%&, and &%add_header%&) that appear before the first failing
25237 condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
25238 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
25240 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
25241 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
25242 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
25243 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
25244 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
25245 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
25249 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
25250 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
25251 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
25252 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
25254 warn !verify = sender
25255 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
25259 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
25261 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
25262 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
25263 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
25264 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
25265 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
25269 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
25270 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
25271 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
25272 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
25273 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
25274 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
25275 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
25276 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
25277 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
25278 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
25280 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
25281 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
25282 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
25283 on the same SMTP connection.
25285 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
25286 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
25287 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
25290 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
25291 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
25292 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
25294 accept hosts = whatever
25295 set acl_m4 = some value
25296 accept authenticated = *
25297 set acl_c_auth = yes
25299 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
25300 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
25301 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
25303 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
25304 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
25305 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
25306 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
25307 error is generated.
25309 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
25310 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
25313 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
25314 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
25315 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
25316 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
25318 deny domains = *.dom.example
25319 !verify = recipient
25321 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
25322 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
25323 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
25324 two statements are equivalent:
25326 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
25327 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
25329 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
25330 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
25332 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
25333 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
25334 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
25336 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
25337 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
25338 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
25339 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
25341 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
25342 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
25343 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
25344 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
25345 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
25346 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
25347 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
25349 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
25350 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
25351 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
25352 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
25353 message is handled.
25355 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement important, because the
25356 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
25357 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
25358 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
25360 require message = Can't verify sender
25362 message = Can't verify recipient
25364 message = This message cannot be used
25366 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
25367 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
25368 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
25369 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
25370 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
25371 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
25373 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
25374 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
25375 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
25376 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
25379 !senders = *@my.domain.example
25380 message = Invalid sender from client host
25382 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
25383 by which time Exim has set up the message.
25387 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
25388 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
25389 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
25392 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25393 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
25394 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
25395 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
25397 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25398 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
25399 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
25400 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
25401 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
25402 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
25403 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
25404 write rather ugly lines like this:
25406 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
25408 Instead, all you need is
25410 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
25413 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25414 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
25415 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
25416 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
25417 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
25418 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
25419 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
25420 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
25422 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
25423 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
25424 in several different ways. For example:
25426 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
25427 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
25428 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
25432 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
25434 accept ...some conditions
25435 control = queue_only
25437 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
25438 other words, when the conditions are all true.
25441 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
25443 accept ...some conditions...
25444 control = queue_only
25445 ...some more conditions...
25447 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
25448 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
25449 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
25453 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
25454 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
25457 warn ...some conditions...
25461 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
25462 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
25466 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
25467 &%require%& verb. For example:
25469 require control = no_multiline_responses
25473 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
25474 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
25476 This modifier may appear in any ACL. It causes Exim to wait for the time
25477 interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the &%-bh%&
25478 option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is output
25479 instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay happens
25480 as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending output is
25481 flushed before the delay is imposed.
25483 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
25486 deny ...some conditions...
25489 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
25490 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
25493 ...some conditions...
25495 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
25496 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
25498 warn ...some conditions...
25504 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
25505 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
25506 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
25507 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
25508 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
25509 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
25510 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
25514 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
25515 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
25516 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
25517 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
25518 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
25519 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
25520 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
25523 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25524 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
25525 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
25526 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
25528 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_cipher
25529 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
25531 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
25534 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
25535 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
25537 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
25538 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
25539 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
25542 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
25543 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
25544 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
25545 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
25546 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
25547 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
25550 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
25551 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
25552 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
25555 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
25556 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
25557 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
25558 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
25559 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
25560 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
25562 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
25563 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
25564 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
25565 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
25566 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
25567 logging rejections.
25570 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
25571 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
25572 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
25573 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
25574 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
25575 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
25576 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
25577 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
25579 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
25580 &` log_reject_target =`&
25582 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
25583 permanent and temporary rejections.
25586 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25587 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
25588 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
25589 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
25590 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
25591 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
25592 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
25595 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
25596 &` control = freeze`&
25597 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
25599 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
25600 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
25601 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
25604 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
25605 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
25609 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
25610 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
25611 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
25612 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
25613 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
25614 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
25615 &%accept%& for details.)
25617 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
25618 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
25619 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
25620 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
25621 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
25623 require message = Host not recognized
25626 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
25629 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
25630 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
25631 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
25632 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
25633 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
25634 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
25635 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
25636 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
25637 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
25640 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
25641 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
25642 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
25644 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
25645 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
25647 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
25648 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
25649 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
25652 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
25653 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
25655 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
25656 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
25657 anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
25660 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
25661 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
25662 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
25663 However, the original message is available in the variable
25664 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
25665 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
25666 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
25667 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
25669 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
25670 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
25671 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
25672 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
25673 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
25674 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
25678 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
25679 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
25680 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
25681 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
25688 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
25689 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
25690 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
25693 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
25694 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
25695 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
25696 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
25697 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
25698 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
25699 not work without it. For example:
25701 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
25702 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
25704 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
25705 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
25706 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
25707 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
25708 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
25711 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
25712 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
25713 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
25714 .cindex "case of local parts"
25715 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
25716 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
25717 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
25718 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
25719 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
25720 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
25723 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
25724 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
25725 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
25726 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
25727 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
25729 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
25730 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
25733 warn control = caseful_local_part
25734 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
25736 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
25738 control = caselower_local_part
25740 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
25741 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
25743 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
25744 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
25745 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
25746 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
25747 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
25748 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
25749 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
25750 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
25752 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
25753 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
25754 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
25755 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
25756 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
25757 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
25761 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
25762 .cindex "fake defer"
25763 .cindex "defer, fake"
25764 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
25765 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
25766 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
25767 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
25768 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
25770 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
25771 .cindex "fake rejection"
25772 .cindex "rejection, fake"
25773 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
25774 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
25775 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
25776 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
25777 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
25778 the same SMTP connection.
25780 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
25781 message is supplied, the following is used:
25783 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
25784 550-kept for evaluation.
25785 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
25786 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
25788 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
25790 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
25791 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
25792 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
25793 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
25794 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
25795 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
25798 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
25799 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
25800 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
25801 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
25803 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
25804 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
25805 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
25806 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
25807 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
25808 disables such output flushing.
25810 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
25811 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
25812 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
25813 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
25814 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
25815 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
25817 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
25818 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
25819 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
25820 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
25821 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
25822 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
25823 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
25824 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
25825 to be useful in production.
25827 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
25828 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
25829 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
25830 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
25831 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
25833 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
25834 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
25835 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
25836 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
25837 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
25838 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
25841 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
25842 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
25843 verification failed"&) is sent.
25845 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
25849 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
25850 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
25852 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
25853 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
25854 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
25855 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
25856 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
25857 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
25858 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
25860 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
25861 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
25862 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
25863 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
25864 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
25865 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
25866 runner. No immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
25867 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option. However, the control applies only
25868 to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the
25869 same SMTP connection.
25871 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
25872 .cindex "message" "submission"
25873 .cindex "submission mode"
25874 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
25875 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
25876 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
25877 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
25878 necessary. For example, it add a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
25879 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
25880 late (the message has already been created).
25882 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
25883 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
25884 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
25885 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
25886 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
25888 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
25889 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
25890 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
25891 complement of &`control`& &`=`& &`submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
25892 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
25895 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
25896 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
25898 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
25900 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
25903 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
25904 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
25905 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
25906 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
25909 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
25910 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
25914 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
25915 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
25918 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
25920 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use &`control`& &`=`&
25921 &`suppress_local_fixups`&.
25923 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
25925 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control`& &`=`& &`submission`&.
25930 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
25931 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
25932 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
25933 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
25934 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
25935 to an incoming message, as in this example:
25937 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
25938 dialup.mail-abuse.org
25939 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
25941 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
25942 MIME, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
25943 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
25944 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
25945 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
25948 If the data for the &%add_header%& modifier contains one or more newlines that
25949 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
25950 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
25951 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
25953 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
25954 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
25955 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
25956 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
25957 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
25958 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
25959 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
25960 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
25961 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
25962 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
25963 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
25965 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
25966 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until they are added to the
25967 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
25968 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
25969 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
25970 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
25971 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
25972 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
25973 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
25975 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately it is encountered during the
25976 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
25978 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
25979 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
25981 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
25982 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
25984 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
25985 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
25986 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
25987 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
25990 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
25991 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
25992 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
25993 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
25994 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
25995 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
25996 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
25999 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
26000 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
26001 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
26002 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
26003 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
26005 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
26006 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
26007 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
26008 to be a header name first.) For example:
26010 warn add_header = \
26011 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
26013 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
26014 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
26015 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
26016 up in reverse order.
26018 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
26019 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
26020 system filter or in a router or transport.
26025 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
26026 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
26027 Some of conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
26028 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
26029 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
26030 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26032 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
26033 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
26034 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
26035 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
26036 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
26037 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
26038 The conditions are as follows:
26042 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
26043 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
26044 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
26045 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
26046 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
26047 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
26048 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
26049 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
26050 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
26051 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
26052 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
26054 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
26055 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
26056 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
26057 conditions are tested.
26059 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
26060 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
26061 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
26062 for different local users or different local domains.
26064 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
26065 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
26066 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
26067 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
26068 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
26069 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
26070 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
26075 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
26076 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
26077 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
26078 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
26079 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
26080 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
26081 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
26082 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
26083 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
26084 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
26085 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
26086 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
26089 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
26090 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
26091 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26092 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
26093 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
26094 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
26095 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
26096 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26098 .vitem &*demime&~=&~*&<&'extension&~list'&>
26099 .cindex "&%demime%& ACL condition"
26100 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26101 content-scanning extension. Its use is described in section
26102 &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
26104 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
26105 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
26106 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
26107 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
26108 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
26109 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
26110 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
26111 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
26112 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
26113 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
26115 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
26116 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
26117 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
26118 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
26119 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
26120 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
26121 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
26122 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
26123 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
26126 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
26127 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
26130 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
26131 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
26132 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
26133 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
26134 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
26135 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
26136 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
26142 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'&~host&~list'&>
26143 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
26144 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
26145 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
26146 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
26147 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
26148 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
26150 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
26152 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
26153 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
26154 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
26156 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
26157 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
26158 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
26159 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
26160 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
26161 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
26163 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
26164 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
26166 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
26167 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
26169 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
26170 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
26171 statement can then check the IP address.
26173 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
26174 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
26175 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
26176 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
26178 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
26179 message = $host_data
26181 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
26183 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
26184 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
26185 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
26186 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
26187 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
26188 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
26189 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
26190 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
26191 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
26192 the next &%local_parts%& test.
26194 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
26195 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
26196 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
26197 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
26198 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26199 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
26200 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26202 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
26203 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
26204 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
26205 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26206 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
26207 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
26208 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
26211 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
26212 .cindex "rate limiting"
26213 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
26214 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
26216 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
26217 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
26218 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
26219 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
26220 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
26221 recipient address against a list of recipients.
26223 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
26224 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
26225 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
26226 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26227 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
26228 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
26229 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26231 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
26232 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
26233 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
26234 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
26235 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26236 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
26237 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
26238 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
26239 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
26240 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
26241 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
26242 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
26243 influence the sender checking.
26245 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
26246 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
26248 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
26249 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
26250 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
26251 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
26252 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
26253 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
26257 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
26258 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
26260 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
26261 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
26262 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
26263 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
26264 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
26265 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
26267 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
26268 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26269 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
26270 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
26271 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
26272 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
26273 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
26274 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
26275 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
26276 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
26278 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
26279 .cindex "CSA verification"
26280 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
26281 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
26282 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
26284 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
26285 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26286 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
26287 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
26288 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
26289 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
26290 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
26291 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
26292 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
26293 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
26294 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
26295 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
26296 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
26297 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
26298 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
26300 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
26301 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
26302 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
26303 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
26306 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
26307 !verify = header_sender
26310 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
26311 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26312 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
26313 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
26314 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
26315 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
26316 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
26317 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
26318 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
26319 and &'Bcc:'&). Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
26320 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
26321 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
26324 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
26325 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
26329 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
26330 common as they used to be.
26332 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
26333 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26334 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
26335 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
26336 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
26337 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
26338 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
26339 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
26340 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
26341 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
26342 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
26343 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
26344 independently of this condition.
26346 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
26347 option), this condition is always true.
26350 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
26351 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
26352 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
26353 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
26354 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
26355 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
26356 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
26357 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
26358 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
26360 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
26361 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
26364 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
26365 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26366 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
26367 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
26368 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
26369 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
26370 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
26371 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
26372 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
26373 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
26374 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
26375 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
26376 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
26377 value for the child address.
26379 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup*&
26380 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26381 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
26382 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
26383 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
26384 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
26385 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
26386 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
26387 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
26388 original IP address.
26390 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
26391 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
26393 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
26394 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26395 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
26396 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
26397 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
26398 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
26399 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
26400 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
26401 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
26403 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
26404 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
26405 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
26406 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
26407 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
26408 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
26409 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
26411 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
26412 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
26413 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
26415 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
26416 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
26417 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
26418 verified as a sender.
26423 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
26424 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
26425 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
26426 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
26427 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
26428 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
26429 address in one or more DNS domains. For example, if the calling host's IP
26430 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
26432 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
26433 dialups.mail-abuse.org
26435 the following records are looked up:
26437 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26438 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
26440 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
26441 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
26442 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
26443 use two separate conditions:
26445 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26446 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
26448 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
26449 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
26450 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
26453 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
26454 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
26455 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
26456 following special items in the list:
26458 &`+include_unknown `& behave as if the item is on the list
26459 &`+exclude_unknown `& behave as if the item is not on the list (default)
26460 &`+defer_unknown `& give a temporary error
26462 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
26463 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
26464 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
26465 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
26467 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
26469 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
26470 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
26472 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26473 warn message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
26474 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
26476 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session,
26477 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
26478 connection. Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
26479 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
26483 .section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
26484 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
26485 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
26486 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
26487 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
26489 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
26491 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
26492 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
26493 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
26494 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
26499 .section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
26500 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
26501 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
26502 addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
26503 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
26504 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
26505 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
26507 deny message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
26508 dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
26510 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
26511 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
26512 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
26513 up by this example is
26515 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
26517 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
26518 addresses. For example:
26520 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
26521 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
26523 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
26524 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
26529 .section "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" "SECTmulkeyfor"
26530 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
26531 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
26532 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
26533 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
26534 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
26535 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
26536 either to double the separators like this:
26538 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
26540 or to change the separator character, like this:
26542 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
26544 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
26545 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
26546 occurs. Consider this condition:
26548 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
26550 The DNS lookups that occur are:
26552 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
26553 a.domain.black.list.tld
26555 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
26556 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
26557 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
26558 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
26559 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
26560 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
26561 error for a previous item.
26563 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
26564 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
26566 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
26567 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
26569 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
26570 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
26572 deny message = The mail servers for the domain \
26573 $sender_address_domain \
26574 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
26576 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
26577 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
26578 $sender_address_domain} }} }
26580 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
26581 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
26582 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
26583 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
26585 dnslists = sbl.spahmaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
26587 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
26588 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
26591 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
26592 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
26598 .section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
26599 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
26600 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
26601 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
26602 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
26603 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
26607 127.1.0.3 DUL and RBL
26609 127.1.0.5 RSS and RBL
26610 127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
26611 127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
26613 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
26614 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
26615 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
26618 .section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
26620 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
26621 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
26622 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
26623 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
26624 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
26625 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
26626 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
26627 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
26628 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
26629 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
26630 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
26631 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
26632 cases, for example:
26634 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
26636 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
26637 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
26638 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
26639 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
26641 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
26643 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
26644 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
26647 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
26648 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
26649 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
26650 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
26651 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
26654 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
26655 &-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
26656 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
26658 deny hosts = !+local_networks
26659 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
26661 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
26666 .section "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" "SECTaddmatcon"
26667 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
26668 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
26669 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
26672 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
26674 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
26675 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
26676 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
26677 describes how multiple records are handled.
26679 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
26680 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
26681 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
26683 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
26685 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
26686 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
26687 first. For example:
26689 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
26690 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
26693 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
26694 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
26695 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
26696 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
26697 tested. For example:
26699 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
26701 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
26702 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
26703 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
26705 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
26707 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
26712 .section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
26713 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
26716 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
26718 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
26719 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
26721 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
26723 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
26724 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
26725 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
26726 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
26728 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
26729 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
26731 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
26732 previous example is precisely equivalent to
26734 deny dnslists = a.b.c
26735 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
26737 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
26738 Consider this example:
26740 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
26742 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
26745 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
26747 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
26749 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
26750 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
26751 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
26753 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
26758 .section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
26759 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
26760 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
26761 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
26762 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
26763 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
26765 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
26767 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
26768 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
26769 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
26770 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
26771 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
26772 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
26775 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
26776 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
26777 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
26779 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
26780 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
26783 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
26785 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
26786 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
26788 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
26790 for the condition to be true.
26793 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
26794 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
26796 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
26797 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
26799 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
26801 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
26802 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
26804 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true there is at least one
26805 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
26807 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
26809 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
26810 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
26812 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
26814 for the condition to be false.
26816 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
26817 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
26822 .section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
26823 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
26824 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
26825 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
26826 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
26827 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
26828 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
26829 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
26830 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
26833 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
26834 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
26835 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
26836 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
26837 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
26838 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
26839 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
26842 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
26843 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
26845 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
26846 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
26848 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
26849 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
26850 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
26851 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
26852 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
26853 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
26855 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
26856 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
26857 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
26859 reject dnslists = \
26860 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
26861 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
26862 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
26863 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
26865 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
26866 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
26867 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
26871 .section "DNS lists and IPv6" "SECTmorednslistslast"
26872 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
26873 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
26874 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
26875 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
26876 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
26878 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
26879 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
26881 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
26882 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
26883 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
26885 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
26887 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
26888 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
26890 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
26891 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
26893 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
26894 dnslists = some.list.example
26897 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
26898 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
26899 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
26900 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
26901 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
26902 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
26903 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
26904 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
26905 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
26906 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
26908 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
26910 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
26911 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
26913 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
26914 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
26915 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
26918 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
26919 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
26920 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
26921 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
26922 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
26923 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
26924 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
26925 changing its overall sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
26926 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
26928 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
26929 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
26930 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
26931 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
26933 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
26934 sending rate. This data is stored in a database maintained by Exim in its spool
26935 directory, alongside the retry and other hints databases. The default key is
26936 &$sender_host_address$&, which applies the limit to each client host IP address.
26937 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
26938 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
26939 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
26940 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
26941 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
26942 authenticated, and you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition.
26945 If you want to limit the rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can
26946 use the key &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in
26950 Internally, Exim includes the smoothing constant &'p'& and the options in the
26951 lookup key because they alter the meaning of the stored data. This is not true
26952 for the limit &'m'&, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will
26953 still remember clients' past behaviour, but if you alter the other ratelimit
26954 parameters Exim forgets past behaviour.
26957 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to three options. One option
26958 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, and the second specifies how Exim
26959 handles excessively fast clients. The third option can be &`noupdate`&, to
26960 disable updating of the ratelimiting database (see section &<<rearatdat>>&).
26961 The options are separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may
26962 appear in any order.
26965 .section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
26966 The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate.
26968 The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
26969 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified.
26971 The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. Note that it is
26972 best to use this option in the DATA ACL; if it is used in an earlier ACL it
26973 relies on the SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or
26974 completely missing. You can follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K,
26975 M, or G to specify limits in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
26977 The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
26978 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the SMTP command rate. The
26979 alias &%per_rcpt%& is provided for use in the RCPT ACL instead of &%per_cmd%&
26980 to make it clear that the effect is to limit the rate at which recipients are
26981 accepted. Note that in this case the rate limiting engine will see a message
26982 with many recipients as a large high-speed burst.
26984 .section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratophanfas"
26985 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
26986 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
26987 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& options. This is independent of the other
26988 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
26989 rest of the ACL. The default mode is leaky, which avoids a sender's
26990 over-aggressive retry rate preventing it from getting any email through.
26992 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always updated.
26993 The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate of attempts
26994 to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum &new("it is actually
26995 allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
26996 counter-measures in the ACL until it slows down below the maximum rate.") The
26997 smoothing period determines the time it takes for a high sending rate to decay
26998 exponentially to 37% of its peak value, which means that you can work out the
26999 time (the number of smoothing periods) that a client is subjected to
27000 counter-measures after an over-limit burst with this formula:
27002 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
27004 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
27005 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
27006 client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
27007 the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
27008 counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
27009 email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
27010 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
27012 .section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
27013 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
27014 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
27015 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
27016 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
27017 message. For example:
27019 # Log all senders' rates
27020 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
27021 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
27023 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
27024 # at the decimal point.
27025 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
27026 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
27027 $sender_rate_limit }s
27029 # Keep authenticated users under control
27030 deny authenticated = *
27031 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
27033 # System-wide rate limit
27034 defer message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
27035 ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
27037 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
27038 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
27039 defer message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
27040 messages per $sender_rate_period
27041 ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
27042 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
27043 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
27045 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
27046 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
27047 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
27048 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
27049 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
27050 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
27051 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
27055 .section "Reading ratelimit data without updating" "rearatdat"
27056 .cindex "rate limitint" "reading data without updating"
27057 If the &%noupdate%& option is present on a &%ratelimit%& ACL condition, Exim
27058 computes the rate and checks the limit as normal, but it does not update the
27059 saved data. This means that, in relevant ACLs, it is possible to lookup the
27060 existence of a specified (or auto-generated) ratelimit key without incrementing
27061 the ratelimit counter for that key. In order for this to be useful, another ACL
27062 entry must set the rate for the same key (otherwise it will always be zero).
27066 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict / noupdate
27067 log_message = RATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
27068 (max $sender_rate_limit)
27071 &'... some other logic and tests...'&
27075 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict / per_cmd
27076 condition = ${if le{$sender_rate}{$sender_rate_limit}}
27077 logwrite = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
27078 (max $sender_rate_limit)
27080 In this example, the rate is tested and used to deny access (when it is too
27081 high) in the connect ACL, but the actual computation of the remembered rate
27082 happens later, on a per-command basis, in another ACL.
27087 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
27088 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
27089 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
27090 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
27091 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
27092 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
27093 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
27094 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
27095 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
27097 verify = sender/callout
27098 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
27100 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
27101 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
27102 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
27103 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
27104 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
27105 The available options are as follows:
27108 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
27109 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
27110 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
27112 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
27113 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
27114 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
27115 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
27117 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
27118 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
27120 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
27121 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
27122 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
27123 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
27126 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
27127 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
27128 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
27129 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
27130 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
27131 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
27134 warn !verify = sender
27135 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
27137 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
27138 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
27139 verification failure.
27141 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
27142 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
27145 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
27146 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
27148 &%route%&: Routing failed.
27150 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
27151 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
27152 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
27154 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
27156 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
27159 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
27160 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
27165 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
27166 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
27167 .cindex "callout" "verification"
27168 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
27169 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
27170 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
27171 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
27172 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
27173 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
27174 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
27175 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
27176 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
27179 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
27180 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
27181 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
27182 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
27183 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
27184 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
27186 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
27187 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
27188 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
27189 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
27190 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
27192 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
27193 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
27194 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
27195 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
27196 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
27197 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
27198 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
27199 supplies a host list.
27201 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
27202 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
27203 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
27204 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
27205 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
27206 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
27207 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
27209 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
27210 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
27211 following SMTP commands are sent:
27213 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
27215 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
27218 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
27221 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
27222 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
27223 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
27224 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
27225 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
27226 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
27228 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
27229 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
27230 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
27231 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
27232 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
27234 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
27235 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
27236 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
27237 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
27238 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
27243 .section "Additional parameters for callouts" "CALLaddparcall"
27244 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
27245 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
27246 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
27248 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
27250 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
27251 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
27252 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
27256 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
27257 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
27258 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
27261 verify = sender/callout=5s
27263 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
27264 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
27265 the &%connect%& parameter.
27268 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
27269 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
27270 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
27271 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
27273 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
27275 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
27277 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
27278 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
27279 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
27280 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
27281 updated in this circumstance.
27283 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
27284 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
27285 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
27286 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
27287 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
27288 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
27291 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
27292 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
27293 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
27294 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
27295 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
27296 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
27297 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
27298 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
27299 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
27300 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
27302 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
27304 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
27307 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
27308 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
27309 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
27312 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
27314 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
27315 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
27316 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
27317 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
27318 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
27321 .vitem &*no_cache*&
27322 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
27323 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
27324 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
27326 .vitem &*postmaster*&
27327 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
27328 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
27329 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
27330 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
27331 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
27332 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
27333 made, until the cache record expires.
27335 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
27336 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
27337 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
27340 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
27342 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
27343 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
27345 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
27347 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
27348 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
27349 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
27350 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
27354 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
27355 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
27356 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
27357 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
27358 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
27360 $primary_host_name-$tod_epoch-testing
27362 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
27363 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
27364 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
27365 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
27366 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
27368 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
27369 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
27370 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
27372 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
27374 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
27375 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
27376 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
27377 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
27378 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
27380 .vitem &*use_sender*&
27381 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
27383 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
27385 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
27386 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
27387 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
27388 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
27389 usefulness of callout caching.
27392 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
27393 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
27394 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
27395 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
27396 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
27397 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
27398 these circumstances.
27400 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
27401 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
27402 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
27403 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
27404 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
27405 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
27406 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
27408 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
27409 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
27410 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
27411 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
27416 .section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
27417 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
27418 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
27419 .cindex "caching" "callout"
27420 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
27421 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
27422 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
27423 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
27424 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
27425 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
27427 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
27428 the failure. However, for subsequent failures use the cache data, this message
27431 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
27432 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
27433 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
27435 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
27436 commands up to and including
27440 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
27441 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
27442 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
27443 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
27444 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
27445 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
27446 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
27448 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
27449 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
27450 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
27451 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
27452 will eventually be noticed.
27454 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
27455 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
27456 behaviour will be the same.
27460 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
27461 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
27462 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
27463 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
27464 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
27465 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
27468 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
27470 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
27471 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
27472 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
27473 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
27474 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
27475 550 Sender verification failed
27477 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
27478 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
27479 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
27480 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
27483 verify = sender/no_details
27486 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
27487 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
27488 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
27489 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
27490 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
27491 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
27492 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
27495 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
27496 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
27497 verification also fails.
27499 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
27500 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
27503 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
27504 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
27505 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
27508 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
27510 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
27511 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
27512 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
27513 verification to succeed.
27515 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
27516 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
27517 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
27518 option. For example:
27520 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
27522 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
27523 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
27525 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
27526 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
27527 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
27528 address and a report is output for each of them.
27532 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
27533 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
27534 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
27535 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
27536 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
27537 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
27538 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
27542 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
27543 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
27544 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
27545 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
27546 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
27547 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
27549 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
27550 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
27551 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
27552 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
27555 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
27557 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
27559 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
27560 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
27562 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
27563 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
27566 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
27567 use for the DNS query. The default is:
27569 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
27571 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
27572 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
27573 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
27574 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
27577 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
27579 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
27580 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
27581 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
27583 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
27584 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
27585 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
27586 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
27587 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
27588 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
27589 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
27590 of legitimate HELO domains.
27592 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
27593 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
27594 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
27595 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
27598 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
27600 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
27601 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
27602 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
27607 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
27608 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
27609 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
27610 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
27611 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
27612 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
27613 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
27614 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
27616 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
27617 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
27618 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
27619 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
27620 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
27621 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
27622 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
27624 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
27625 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
27628 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
27629 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
27632 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
27633 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
27636 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
27637 deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
27639 recipients = +batv_senders
27641 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
27642 deny message = Invalid reverse path signature.
27644 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
27645 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
27646 !condition = $prvscheck_result
27648 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
27649 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
27650 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
27651 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
27652 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
27654 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
27655 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
27656 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
27657 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
27658 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
27659 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
27660 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
27662 There are two more issues you must consider when implementing prvs-signing.
27663 Firstly, you need to ensure that prvs-signed addresses are not blocked by your
27664 ACLs. A prvs-signed address contains a slash character, but the default Exim
27665 configuration contains this statement in the RCPT ACL:
27667 deny message = Restricted characters in address
27668 domains = +local_domains
27669 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
27671 This is a conservative rule that blocks local parts that contain slashes. You
27672 should remove the slash in the last line.
27674 Secondly, you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
27675 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
27676 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
27680 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
27682 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
27683 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
27684 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
27687 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
27690 external_smtp_batv:
27692 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
27693 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
27694 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
27695 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
27698 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
27702 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
27703 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
27704 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
27705 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
27706 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
27707 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
27708 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
27709 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
27710 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
27711 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
27713 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
27714 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
27715 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
27716 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
27717 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
27718 same host is fulfilling both functions,
27720 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
27722 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
27723 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
27724 system to arbitrary domains.
27727 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
27728 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
27729 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
27730 example, suppose you want to do the following:
27733 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
27734 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
27735 &'my.dom2.example'&.
27737 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
27738 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
27740 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
27741 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
27745 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
27747 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
27748 domainlist relay_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
27749 hostlist relay_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
27751 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
27755 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_domains
27756 accept hosts = +relay_hosts
27758 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
27759 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
27760 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
27761 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
27762 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
27763 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
27764 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
27768 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
27769 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
27770 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
27771 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
27772 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
27774 For specifically testing for unwanted relaying, the host
27775 &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a useful service. If you telnet to this
27776 host from the host on which Exim is running, using the normal telnet port, you
27777 will see a normal telnet connection message and then quite a long delay. Be
27778 patient. The remote host is making an SMTP connection back to your host, and
27779 trying a number of common probes to test for open relay vulnerability. The
27780 results of the tests will eventually appear on your terminal.
27785 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27786 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27788 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
27789 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
27790 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
27791 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
27792 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
27793 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
27796 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
27797 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
27798 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
27799 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
27800 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
27802 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
27803 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
27804 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
27807 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
27808 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
27810 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
27811 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
27812 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
27814 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
27815 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
27817 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
27820 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
27823 There is another content-scanning configuration option for &_Local/Makefile_&,
27824 called WITH_OLD_DEMIME. If this is set, the old, deprecated &%demime%& ACL
27825 condition is compiled, in addition to all the other content-scanning features.
27827 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
27828 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
27829 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
27830 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
27831 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
27832 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
27834 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
27835 temporarily created in a file called:
27837 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
27839 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
27840 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
27841 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
27842 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
27843 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
27845 control = no_mbox_unspool
27847 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
27848 same directory by default.
27852 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
27853 .cindex "virus scanning"
27854 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
27855 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
27856 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
27857 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
27858 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
27859 in memory and thus are much faster.
27861 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
27862 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in first part of the Exim configuration
27863 file to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
27864 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
27866 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
27868 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
27870 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
27872 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with dollar character, it is expanded
27873 before use. The following scanner types are supported in this release:
27876 .vitem &%aveserver%&
27877 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
27878 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
27879 at &url(http://www.kaspersky.com). This scanner type takes one option,
27880 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
27883 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
27887 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
27888 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
27889 &url(http://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
27890 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
27891 in the MIME ACL. This no longer believed to be necessary. One option is
27892 required: either the path and name of a UNIX socket file, or a hostname or IP
27893 number, and a port, separated by space, as in the second of these examples:
27895 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
27896 av_scanner = clamd:192.168.2.100 1234
27898 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
27899 contributing the code for this scanner.
27902 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
27903 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
27904 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
27905 type takes 3 mandatory options:
27908 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
27909 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
27912 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
27913 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
27914 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
27915 the &"trigger"& expression.
27918 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
27919 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
27920 &"name"& expression.
27923 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
27925 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
27927 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
27928 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
27929 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
27930 configuration setting:
27932 av_scanner = cmdline:\
27933 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
27934 found in file:'(.+)'
27937 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
27938 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(http://www.sald.com/)) interface takes one
27939 argument, either a full path to a UNIX socket, or an IP address and port
27940 separated by white space, as in these examples:
27942 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
27943 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
27945 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
27946 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
27949 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
27950 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(http://www.f-secure.com)) takes one
27951 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
27953 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
27955 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
27956 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
27958 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
27959 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
27960 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
27961 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
27962 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
27965 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
27967 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
27970 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
27971 This is a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users, though some
27972 parts of documentation are now available in English. You can get it at
27973 &url(http://linux.mks.com.pl/). The only option for this scanner type is
27974 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
27975 provided that the demime facility is employed and also provided that mksd has
27976 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
27978 av_scanner = mksd:2
27980 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
27983 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
27984 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
27985 You can get Sophie at &url(http://www.clanfield.info/sophie/). The only option
27986 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
27987 client communication. For example:
27989 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
27991 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
27995 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
27996 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
27999 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
28000 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
28001 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
28002 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
28003 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
28004 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
28007 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
28008 use. It can then be one of
28011 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
28012 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
28015 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
28016 the condition fails immediately.
28018 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
28019 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
28020 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
28023 You can append &`/defer_ok`& to the &%malware%& condition to accept messages
28024 even if there is a problem with the virus scanner. Otherwise, such a problem
28025 causes the ACL to defer.
28027 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
28028 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
28029 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
28030 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
28033 If your virus scanner cannot unpack MIME and TNEF containers itself, you should
28034 use the &%demime%& condition (see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&) before the
28035 &%malware%& condition.
28037 Here is a very simple scanning example:
28039 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
28043 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
28045 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
28047 malware = */defer_ok
28049 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
28050 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
28052 av_scanner = $acl_m0
28054 in the main Exim configuration.
28056 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
28057 set acl_m0 = sophie
28060 deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
28061 set acl_m0 = aveserver
28066 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin" "SECTscanspamass"
28067 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
28068 .cindex "spam scanning"
28069 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
28070 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
28071 score and a report for the message. You can get SpamAssassin at
28072 &url(http://www.spamassassin.org), or, if you have a working Perl
28073 installation, you can use CPAN by running:
28075 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
28077 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
28078 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
28081 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
28082 After having installed and configured SpamAssassin, start the &%spamd%& daemon.
28083 By default, it listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783. If you use another host or
28084 port for &%spamd%&, you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global
28085 part of the Exim configuration as follows (example):
28087 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 387
28089 You do not need to set this option if you use the default. As of version 2.60,
28090 &%spamd%& also supports communication over UNIX sockets. If you want to use
28091 these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute file name instead of a
28094 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
28096 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
28097 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
28098 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
28099 option, separated with colons:
28101 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
28102 192.168.2.11 783 : \
28105 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported. The servers are queried in a random
28106 fashion. When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
28107 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
28110 &*Warning*&: It is not possible to use the UNIX socket connection method with
28111 multiple &%spamd%& servers.
28114 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
28115 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
28117 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
28120 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
28121 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
28122 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
28123 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
28124 However, you must put something on the right-hand side.
28126 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
28127 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
28128 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
28129 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA ACL in order to be able to
28130 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
28133 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
28134 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
28135 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
28138 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
28139 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
28140 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
28143 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
28144 condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
28148 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
28149 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
28150 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
28151 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
28153 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
28154 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
28155 variables. With the exception of &$spam_score_int$&, these are usable only
28156 within ACLs; their values are not retained with the message and so cannot be
28157 used at delivery time.
28160 .vitem &$spam_score$&
28161 The spam score of the message, for example &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
28162 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
28164 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
28165 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
28166 example &"34"& or &"305"&. This is useful for numeric comparisons in
28167 conditions. This variable is special; its value is saved with the message, and
28168 written to Exim's spool file. This means that it can be used during the whole
28169 life of the message on your Exim system, in particular, in routers or
28170 transports during the later delivery phase.
28172 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
28173 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
28174 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
28175 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
28176 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings.
28178 .vitem &$spam_report$&
28179 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
28180 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
28183 The &%spam%& condition caches its results. If you call it again with the same
28184 user name, it does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as
28187 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running the
28188 message through SpamAssassin. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to
28189 the next ACL statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of
28190 the spam condition, like this:
28192 deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
28193 spam = joe/defer_ok
28195 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
28197 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
28200 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
28201 warn spam = nobody:true
28202 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
28203 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
28205 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
28206 # is over threshold
28208 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
28210 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
28211 deny message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
28213 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
28218 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
28219 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
28220 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
28221 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
28222 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
28223 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
28224 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
28225 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
28226 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
28227 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
28230 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
28231 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
28232 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
28233 message contains a &new(&'Content-Type:'&) header line. When a call to a MIME
28234 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
28235 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
28236 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
28238 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
28239 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
28240 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
28241 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
28242 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
28244 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
28245 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
28246 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
28247 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
28248 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
28251 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
28253 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
28257 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
28259 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
28260 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
28261 a sequential file name consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
28262 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
28264 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
28265 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
28266 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
28267 the full path and file name.
28269 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
28270 filename, and the default path is then used.
28272 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
28273 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
28274 a file with its original, proposed filename using
28276 decode = $mime_filename
28278 However, you should keep in mind that &$mime_filename$& might contain
28279 anything. If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
28280 automatically unlinked.
28282 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
28283 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
28284 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
28285 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
28286 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
28288 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
28289 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
28290 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
28292 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
28293 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
28294 available in the MIME ACL:
28297 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
28298 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$&) below, it should
28299 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
28300 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
28301 contains the empty string.
28303 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
28304 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
28305 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
28311 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
28312 case-insensitively.
28314 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
28315 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
28316 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
28317 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
28318 only used for display purposes.
28320 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
28321 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
28322 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
28324 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
28325 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
28326 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
28328 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
28329 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
28330 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
28331 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
28332 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
28334 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
28335 This variable contains the normalized content of the
28336 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
28337 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
28339 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
28340 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
28341 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
28342 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
28346 application/octet-stream
28350 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
28353 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
28354 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
28355 successfully run. It contains the full path and file name of the file
28356 containing the decoded data.
28361 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
28362 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
28363 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
28364 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
28365 RFC2047 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done. If no filename was
28366 found, this variable contains the empty string.
28368 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
28369 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
28370 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
28371 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
28373 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
28374 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
28378 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
28381 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
28382 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
28385 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
28386 and the rest are attachments.
28389 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
28392 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
28393 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
28394 coverletter mail attached to non-HMTL coverletter mail will also be allowed:
28396 deny message = HTML mail is not accepted here
28397 !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
28398 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
28399 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
28401 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
28402 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
28403 &"multipart"&, for example &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
28404 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
28405 want to carry out specific actions on them.
28407 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
28408 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
28409 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
28410 decoding is fully recursive.
28412 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
28413 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
28414 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
28415 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
28416 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
28417 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
28418 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
28423 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
28424 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
28425 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
28426 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
28427 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
28429 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
28430 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
28431 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
28432 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
28433 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
28435 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
28436 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
28437 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
28438 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
28439 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
28440 32K characters are checked.
28442 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
28443 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
28444 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
28445 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
28446 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
28448 deny message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
28449 regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
28451 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
28452 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
28453 matching regular expression.
28455 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
28461 .section "The demime condition" "SECTdemimecond"
28462 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME checking"
28463 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
28464 The &%demime%& ACL condition provides MIME unpacking, sanity checking and file
28465 extension blocking. It is usable only in the DATA and non-SMTP ACLs. The
28466 &%demime%& condition uses a simpler interface to MIME decoding than the MIME
28467 ACL functionality, but provides no additional facilities. Please note that this
28468 condition is deprecated and kept only for backward compatibility. You must set
28469 the WITH_OLD_DEMIME option in &_Local/Makefile_& at build time to be able to
28470 use the &%demime%& condition.
28472 The &%demime%& condition unpacks MIME containers in the message. It detects
28473 errors in MIME containers and can match file extensions found in the message
28474 against a list. Using this facility produces files containing the unpacked MIME
28475 parts of the message in the temporary scan directory. If you do antivirus
28476 scanning, it is recommended that you use the &%demime%& condition before the
28477 antivirus (&%malware%&) condition.
28479 On the right-hand side of the &%demime%& condition you can pass a
28480 colon-separated list of file extensions that it should match against. For
28483 deny message = Found blacklisted file attachment
28484 demime = vbs:com:bat:pif:prf:lnk
28486 If one of the file extensions is found, the condition is true, otherwise it is
28487 false. If there is a temporary error while demimeing (for example, &"disk
28488 full"&), the condition defers, and the message is temporarily rejected (unless
28489 the condition is on a &%warn%& verb).
28491 The right-hand side is expanded before being treated as a list, so you can have
28492 conditions and lookups there. If it expands to an empty string, &"false"&, or
28493 zero (&"0"&), no demimeing is done and the condition is false.
28495 The &%demime%& condition set the following variables:
28498 .vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
28499 .vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
28500 When an error is detected in a MIME container, this variable contains the
28501 severity of the error, as an integer number. The higher the value, the more
28502 severe the error (the current maximum value is 3). If this variable is unset or
28503 zero, no error occurred.
28505 .vitem &$demime_reason$&
28506 .vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
28507 When &$demime_errorlevel$& is greater than zero, this variable contains a
28508 human-readable text string describing the MIME error that occurred.
28512 .vitem &$found_extension$&
28513 .vindex "&$found_extension$&"
28514 When the &%demime%& condition is true, this variable contains the file
28515 extension it found.
28518 Both &$demime_errorlevel$& and &$demime_reason$& are set by the first call of
28519 the &%demime%& condition, and are not changed on subsequent calls.
28521 If you do not want to check for file extensions, but rather use the &%demime%&
28522 condition for unpacking or error checking purposes, pass &"*"& as the
28523 right-hand side value. Here is a more elaborate example of how to use this
28526 # Reject messages with serious MIME container errors
28527 deny message = Found MIME error ($demime_reason).
28529 condition = ${if >{$demime_errorlevel}{2}{1}{0}}
28531 # Reject known virus spreading file extensions.
28532 # Accepting these is pretty much braindead.
28533 deny message = contains $found_extension file (blacklisted).
28534 demime = com:vbs:bat:pif:scr
28536 # Freeze .exe and .doc files. Postmaster can
28537 # examine them and eventually thaw them.
28538 deny log_message = Another $found_extension file.
28547 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28548 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28550 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
28551 "Local scan function"
28552 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
28553 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
28554 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
28555 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
28556 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
28558 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
28559 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
28560 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
28561 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
28562 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
28564 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
28565 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
28566 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
28567 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
28569 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
28570 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
28571 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
28572 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
28574 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
28575 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
28576 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
28577 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
28578 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
28579 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
28580 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
28581 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
28582 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
28586 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
28587 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
28588 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
28589 function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
28590 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
28591 directory, so you might set
28593 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
28595 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&. It is called by
28596 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
28597 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
28598 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
28599 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
28600 _src/local_scan.c_.
28602 If you want to make use of Exim's run time configuration file to set options
28603 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
28605 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
28607 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
28612 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
28613 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
28614 You must include this line near the start of your code:
28616 #include "local_scan.h"
28618 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
28619 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
28620 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
28621 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
28622 It also contains the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
28623 strings and pointers to character strings:
28625 #define CS (char *)
28626 #define CCS (const char *)
28627 #define CSS (char **)
28628 #define US (unsigned char *)
28629 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
28630 #define USS (unsigned char **)
28632 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
28634 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
28636 The arguments are as follows:
28639 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
28640 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
28641 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
28643 The descriptor is positioned at character 19 of the file, which is the first
28644 character of the body itself, because the first 19 characters are the message
28645 id followed by &`-D`& and a newline. If you rewind the file, you should use the
28646 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
28647 case this changes in some future version.
28649 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
28650 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
28653 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
28656 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
28657 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
28658 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
28659 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
28660 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
28661 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
28663 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
28664 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
28665 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
28667 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
28668 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
28669 queued without immediate delivery.
28671 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
28672 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
28673 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
28674 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
28675 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
28678 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
28679 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
28680 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
28683 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
28684 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
28685 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
28686 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
28687 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
28688 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
28689 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
28691 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
28692 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
28693 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
28696 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
28697 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
28698 &%-oe%& command line options.
28702 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
28703 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
28704 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
28705 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
28706 want to do this, you must have the line
28708 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
28710 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
28711 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
28712 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
28715 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
28716 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
28717 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
28718 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
28719 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
28720 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
28722 static int my_integer_option = 42;
28723 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
28725 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
28726 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
28727 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
28730 int local_scan_options_count =
28731 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
28733 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
28734 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
28738 my_string = some string of text...
28740 The available types of option data are as follows:
28743 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
28744 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
28745 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
28746 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
28747 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
28748 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
28751 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
28752 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
28753 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
28754 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
28757 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
28758 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
28761 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
28762 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
28763 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
28764 printed with the suffix K or M.
28766 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
28767 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
28768 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
28769 always output in octal.
28771 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
28772 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
28773 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
28775 .vitem &*opt_time*&
28776 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
28777 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
28780 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
28781 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
28785 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
28787 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
28788 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
28789 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
28790 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
28791 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
28792 C variables are as follows:
28796 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
28798 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
28800 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
28801 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
28804 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
28805 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
28806 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
28807 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
28810 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
28811 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
28812 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
28815 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
28816 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
28820 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
28821 selected, you should use code like this:
28823 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
28824 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
28826 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
28827 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
28828 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
28830 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
28831 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
28834 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
28835 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
28837 .vitem &*uschar&~*headers_charset*&
28838 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
28840 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
28841 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
28842 &%-bh%& command line option.
28844 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
28845 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
28846 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
28848 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
28849 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
28850 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
28851 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
28853 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
28854 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
28855 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
28857 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
28858 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
28860 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
28861 The number of accepted recipients.
28863 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
28864 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
28865 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
28866 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
28867 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
28868 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
28869 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
28870 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
28871 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
28872 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
28873 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
28874 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
28876 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
28877 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
28879 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
28880 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
28881 locally-submitted messages.
28883 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
28884 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
28885 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
28887 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
28888 The name of the sending host, if known.
28890 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
28891 The port on the sending host.
28893 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
28894 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
28896 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
28897 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
28899 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
28900 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
28901 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
28905 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
28906 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
28907 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
28908 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
28913 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
28914 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
28916 .vitem &*int&~type*&
28917 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
28918 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
28919 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
28920 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
28921 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
28922 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
28924 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
28925 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
28928 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
28929 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
28930 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
28935 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
28936 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
28939 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
28940 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
28942 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
28943 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
28944 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
28945 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
28947 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
28948 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
28949 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
28950 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
28951 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
28952 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
28953 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
28954 is NULL for all recipients.
28959 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
28960 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
28961 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
28962 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
28966 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
28967 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
28969 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
28970 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
28971 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
28972 for the process in &%newumask%&.
28974 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
28975 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
28976 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
28977 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
28978 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
28980 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
28982 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
28983 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
28984 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
28985 return value is as follows:
28990 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
28996 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
29002 The process timed out.
29006 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
29009 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
29010 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
29011 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
29012 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
29013 forks a subprocess that is running
29015 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
29017 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
29018 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
29019 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
29020 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
29022 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
29023 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
29024 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
29025 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
29028 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
29029 *sender_authentication)*&
29030 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
29033 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
29035 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
29038 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
29039 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
29040 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
29041 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
29042 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
29044 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
29045 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
29048 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
29049 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
29050 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
29051 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
29052 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
29053 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
29054 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
29055 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
29057 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
29058 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
29059 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
29060 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
29061 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
29062 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
29064 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
29065 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
29066 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
29067 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
29069 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
29070 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
29071 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
29072 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
29073 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
29074 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
29075 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
29076 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
29077 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
29078 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
29080 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
29081 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
29083 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
29084 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
29087 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
29088 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
29089 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
29090 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
29091 match the specification, the function does nothing.
29094 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
29095 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
29096 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
29097 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
29098 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
29099 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
29101 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
29103 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
29104 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
29105 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
29106 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
29107 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
29110 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
29111 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
29112 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
29113 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
29114 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
29115 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
29116 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
29117 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
29119 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
29120 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
29121 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
29123 &`OK `& match succeeded
29124 &`FAIL `& match failed
29125 &`DEFER `& match deferred
29127 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
29128 inability to contact a database.
29130 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
29132 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
29133 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
29134 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
29136 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
29138 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
29139 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
29140 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
29142 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
29144 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
29147 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
29149 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
29150 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
29151 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
29152 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
29153 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
29154 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
29157 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
29159 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
29160 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
29161 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
29162 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
29163 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
29164 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
29167 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
29168 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
29169 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
29170 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
29172 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
29173 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
29174 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
29175 value afterwards. For example:
29177 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
29178 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
29179 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
29182 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
29183 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
29184 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
29185 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
29192 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
29193 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
29194 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
29195 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
29196 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
29197 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
29198 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
29199 binary string is returned with an error message.
29201 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
29202 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
29203 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
29205 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
29206 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
29207 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
29208 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
29209 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
29211 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
29212 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
29213 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
29215 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
29216 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
29217 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
29218 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
29222 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
29223 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
29226 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
29227 The arguments of this function are like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
29228 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
29229 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
29230 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
29231 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
29232 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
29233 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
29236 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
29237 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
29239 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
29240 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
29241 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
29242 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
29243 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
29244 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
29245 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
29247 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
29248 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
29250 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
29251 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
29252 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
29253 multiple output lines.
29255 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
29256 does not automatically flush pending output, and therefore does not test
29257 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
29258 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
29259 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
29260 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
29261 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
29264 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int)*&
29265 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
29266 chunk of memory whose size is given by the argument. Exim bombs out if it ever
29267 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
29269 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int)*&
29270 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
29271 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
29273 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
29276 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
29279 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
29280 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
29281 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
29282 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
29283 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
29284 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
29290 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
29291 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
29292 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
29293 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
29294 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
29295 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
29296 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
29299 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
29300 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
29301 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
29302 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
29304 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
29305 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
29307 store_pool = POOL_PERM
29309 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
29310 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
29311 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
29312 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
29314 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
29315 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
29316 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
29317 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
29324 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29325 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29327 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
29328 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
29329 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
29330 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
29331 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
29332 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
29333 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
29334 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
29336 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
29337 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
29338 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
29339 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
29340 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
29342 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
29343 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
29344 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
29345 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
29346 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
29347 prevent it happening on retries.
29349 .vindex "&$domain$&"
29350 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
29351 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
29352 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
29353 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
29354 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
29355 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
29356 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
29359 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
29360 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
29361 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
29362 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
29363 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
29364 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
29365 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
29367 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
29368 system_filter_user = exim
29370 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
29371 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
29372 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
29373 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
29374 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
29375 by the &%reply%& command.
29378 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
29379 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
29380 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
29381 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
29383 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
29384 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
29388 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
29389 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
29390 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
29391 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
29392 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
29393 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
29396 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
29397 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
29398 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
29399 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
29400 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
29401 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
29402 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
29404 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
29405 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
29406 succeed, it will not be tried again.
29407 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
29408 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
29410 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
29411 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
29412 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
29413 to which users' filter files can refer.
29417 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
29418 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
29419 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
29420 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
29421 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
29425 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
29426 .cindex "freezing messages"
29427 .cindex "message" "freezing"
29428 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
29429 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
29430 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
29431 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
29432 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
29433 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
29434 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
29435 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
29436 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
29438 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
29440 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
29442 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
29443 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
29444 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
29445 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
29446 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
29449 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
29450 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
29451 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
29452 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
29454 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
29455 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
29456 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
29457 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
29458 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
29459 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
29460 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
29461 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
29462 message. For example:
29464 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
29465 because it contains attachments that we are \
29466 not prepared to receive."
29469 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
29470 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
29471 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
29472 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
29473 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
29474 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
29477 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
29478 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
29480 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
29481 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
29482 generated by the filter.
29484 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
29486 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
29487 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
29493 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
29494 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
29499 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
29500 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
29501 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
29502 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
29503 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
29505 headers add <string>
29506 headers remove <string>
29508 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
29509 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
29510 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
29511 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
29512 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
29514 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
29515 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
29516 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
29519 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
29520 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
29523 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
29524 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
29525 space after input continuations is ignored.
29527 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
29528 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
29529 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
29530 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
29531 header with the same name, they are all removed.
29533 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
29534 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
29535 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
29536 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
29537 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
29538 used for all recipients of the message.
29540 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
29541 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
29542 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
29543 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
29544 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
29545 until the message is actually being written (see section
29546 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
29548 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
29549 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
29550 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
29551 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
29552 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
29553 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
29554 modified more than once.
29556 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
29557 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
29560 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
29561 headers remove "Subject"
29562 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
29563 headers remove "Old-Subject"
29568 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
29569 .cindex "envelope sender"
29570 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
29572 errors_to <some address>
29574 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
29575 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
29576 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
29579 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
29581 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
29582 address if its delivery failed.
29586 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
29587 .vindex "&$domain$&"
29588 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
29589 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
29590 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
29591 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
29592 such as &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used, and indeed, the choice of
29593 filter file could be made dependent on them. This is an example of a router
29594 which implements such a filter:
29599 domains = +local_domains
29600 file = /central/filters/$local_part
29605 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
29606 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
29607 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
29608 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
29610 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
29611 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
29612 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
29613 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
29615 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
29616 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
29617 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
29624 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29625 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29627 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
29628 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
29629 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
29630 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
29631 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
29632 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
29633 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
29634 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
29636 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
29637 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
29638 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
29639 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
29640 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
29642 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
29643 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
29644 loopback interface specially in any way.
29646 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
29647 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
29652 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
29653 .cindex "message" "submission"
29654 .cindex "submission mode"
29655 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
29656 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
29657 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
29658 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
29660 control = submission
29662 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
29663 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
29664 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
29665 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
29666 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
29667 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
29669 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
29670 control = submission
29672 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
29673 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
29674 is used to separate options. For example:
29676 control = submission/sender_retain
29678 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
29679 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
29680 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
29681 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
29682 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
29683 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
29684 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
29686 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
29687 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
29690 control = submission/domain=some.domain
29692 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
29693 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
29694 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
29695 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
29697 accept authenticated = *
29698 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
29699 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
29700 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
29702 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
29703 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
29704 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
29706 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
29708 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
29711 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
29713 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
29714 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
29715 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
29716 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
29718 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
29719 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
29720 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
29721 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
29722 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
29723 spoof another's address.
29725 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
29726 .cindex "line endings"
29727 .cindex "carriage return"
29729 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
29730 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
29731 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
29732 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
29733 use CRLF or just CR.
29735 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
29736 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
29737 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
29738 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
29739 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
29740 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
29741 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
29742 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
29746 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
29748 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
29751 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
29752 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
29755 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
29756 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
29757 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
29758 people trying to play silly games.
29760 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
29761 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
29769 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
29770 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
29771 .cindex "address" "qualification"
29772 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
29773 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
29774 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
29775 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
29776 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
29778 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
29779 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
29780 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
29781 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
29782 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
29784 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
29785 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
29786 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
29787 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
29788 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
29789 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
29790 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
29791 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
29796 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
29797 .cindex "&""From""& line"
29798 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
29799 .cindex "sender" "address"
29800 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
29801 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
29802 .cindex "envelope sender"
29803 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
29804 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
29805 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
29806 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
29808 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
29809 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
29811 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
29812 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
29813 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
29814 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
29815 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
29816 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
29817 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
29818 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
29819 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
29821 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
29822 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
29823 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
29824 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
29825 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
29826 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
29827 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
29829 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
29830 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
29831 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
29833 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
29834 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
29835 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
29836 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
29840 .section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
29841 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
29842 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
29843 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
29844 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
29845 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
29846 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
29849 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
29850 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
29853 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
29854 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
29858 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
29859 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
29861 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
29862 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
29863 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
29865 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
29868 For a locally-submitted message,
29869 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
29870 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
29871 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
29872 included in log lines in this case.
29874 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
29875 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
29881 .section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
29882 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
29883 includes the header line:
29885 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
29888 .section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
29889 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
29890 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
29891 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
29892 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
29893 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
29896 .section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
29897 .cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
29898 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
29899 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
29900 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
29902 .section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
29903 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
29904 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
29905 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
29906 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
29907 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
29908 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
29909 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
29913 .section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
29914 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
29915 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
29916 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
29917 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
29918 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
29919 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
29920 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
29924 .section "The From: header line" "SECTthefrohea"
29925 .cindex "&'From:'& header line"
29926 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
29927 .cindex "message" "submission"
29928 .cindex "submission mode"
29929 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
29930 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
29933 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
29934 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
29936 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
29937 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
29939 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
29940 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
29941 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
29943 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
29944 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
29946 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
29947 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
29951 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
29953 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
29954 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
29955 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
29956 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
29957 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
29958 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
29959 &%qualify_domain%&.
29961 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
29962 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
29963 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
29964 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
29967 .section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
29968 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
29969 .cindex "message" "submission"
29970 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
29971 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
29972 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
29973 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
29974 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
29975 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
29976 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
29977 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
29978 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
29979 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
29982 .section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
29983 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
29984 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
29985 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
29986 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
29988 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
29989 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
29990 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
29991 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
29993 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
29994 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
29995 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
29998 .section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
29999 .cindex "&'References:'& header line"
30000 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
30001 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
30002 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
30003 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
30004 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
30005 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
30006 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
30007 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
30008 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
30012 .section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
30013 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
30014 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
30015 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
30016 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
30017 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
30018 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
30019 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
30023 .section "The Sender: header line" "SECTthesenhea"
30024 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
30025 .cindex "message" "submission"
30026 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
30027 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
30028 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
30029 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
30032 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
30033 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
30034 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
30035 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
30036 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
30037 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
30038 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
30039 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
30040 line is added to the message.
30042 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
30043 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
30044 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
30045 options true at the same time.
30047 .cindex "submission mode"
30048 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
30049 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
30050 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
30051 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
30053 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
30054 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
30055 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
30056 created as follows:
30059 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
30060 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
30061 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
30063 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
30064 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
30066 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
30067 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
30070 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
30071 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
30072 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
30073 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
30075 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
30076 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
30077 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
30078 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
30082 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
30083 "SECTheadersaddrem"
30084 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
30085 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
30086 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
30087 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
30088 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
30089 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
30090 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
30092 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
30093 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
30094 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
30095 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
30096 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
30097 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
30099 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
30100 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
30101 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
30103 For both routers and transports, the result of expanding a &%headers_add%&
30104 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
30105 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
30107 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
30108 X-added-second: another added header line
30110 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
30112 The result of expanding &%headers_remove%& must consist of a colon-separated
30113 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
30114 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
30115 not part of the names. For example:
30117 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
30119 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router, its value
30120 is expanded at routing time, and then associated with all addresses that are
30121 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
30122 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
30123 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
30125 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
30126 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
30127 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
30128 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
30130 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
30131 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
30132 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
30135 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
30136 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
30137 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
30138 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
30139 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
30140 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
30141 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
30143 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
30144 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
30145 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
30146 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
30148 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
30149 the following consequences:
30152 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
30153 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
30154 to it, at all times.
30156 Header lines that are added by a router's
30157 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
30158 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
30160 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
30161 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
30163 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
30164 a later router or by a transport.
30166 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
30167 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
30169 headers_remove = subject
30170 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
30174 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
30175 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
30181 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
30182 .cindex "address" "constructed"
30183 .cindex "constructed address"
30184 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
30187 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
30191 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
30193 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
30194 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
30195 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
30196 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
30197 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
30198 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
30199 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
30200 there is no password file entry.
30203 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
30204 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
30205 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
30206 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
30207 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
30208 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
30209 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
30210 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
30214 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
30215 .cindex "case of local parts"
30216 .cindex "local part" "case of"
30217 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
30218 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
30219 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
30220 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
30221 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
30222 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
30225 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
30226 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
30227 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
30228 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
30229 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
30233 domains = +local_domains
30234 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
30235 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
30238 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
30239 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
30240 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
30241 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
30242 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
30246 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
30247 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
30248 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
30249 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
30250 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
30251 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
30252 empty components for compatibility.
30256 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
30257 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
30258 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
30259 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
30260 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
30261 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
30263 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
30264 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
30265 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
30266 example, a header such as
30270 might get rewritten as
30272 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
30274 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
30275 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
30278 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
30279 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
30280 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
30281 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
30282 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
30283 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
30284 .ecindex IIDmesproc
30288 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30289 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30291 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
30292 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
30293 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
30294 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
30295 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
30296 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
30297 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
30300 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
30302 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
30304 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
30307 For mail delivery, the following are available:
30310 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
30312 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
30315 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
30318 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
30319 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
30322 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
30323 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
30324 used to contain the envelope information.
30328 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
30329 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
30330 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
30331 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
30332 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
30335 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
30336 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
30337 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
30338 processing is the same in both cases.
30340 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
30341 parameter is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
30342 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
30343 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
30344 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
30345 .cindex "transport" "filter"
30346 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
30347 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
30350 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
30351 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
30352 required for the transaction.
30354 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
30355 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
30356 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
30358 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
30359 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
30360 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
30362 .cindex "carriage return"
30364 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
30365 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
30366 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
30369 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
30370 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
30371 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
30372 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
30373 of the &%max_rcpts%& option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
30374 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpts%& addresses
30375 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
30376 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
30377 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
30379 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
30380 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
30381 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
30382 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
30384 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
30385 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
30386 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
30387 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
30389 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
30390 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
30391 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
30392 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
30393 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected. If it finds one, it
30394 creates a new Exim process using the &%-MC%& option (which can only be used by
30395 a process running as root or the Exim user) and passes the TCP/IP socket to it
30396 so that it can deliver another message using the same socket. The new process
30397 does only those deliveries that are routed to the connected host, and may in
30398 turn pass the socket on to a third process, and so on.
30400 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
30401 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
30403 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
30404 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
30405 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
30406 square bracket of the IP address.
30411 .section "Errors in outgoing SMTP" "SECToutSMTPerr"
30412 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
30413 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
30414 .cindex "host" "error"
30415 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
30416 message errors, and recipient errors.
30419 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
30420 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
30421 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
30424 Connection refused or timed out,
30426 Any error response code on connection,
30428 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
30430 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
30432 I/O errors at any time,
30434 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
30435 the &"."& at the end of the data.
30438 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
30439 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
30440 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
30441 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
30442 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
30443 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
30444 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
30445 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
30447 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
30448 .cindex "message" "error"
30449 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
30450 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
30451 message errors are:
30454 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
30457 Timeout after MAIL,
30459 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
30460 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
30461 connection at any other time.
30464 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
30465 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
30466 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
30467 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
30468 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
30469 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
30470 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
30471 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
30472 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
30473 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
30475 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
30476 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
30477 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
30480 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
30481 .cindex "recipient" "error"
30482 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
30483 recipient errors are:
30486 Any error response to RCPT,
30488 Timeout after RCPT.
30491 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
30492 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
30493 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
30494 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
30495 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
30496 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
30497 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
30498 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
30499 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
30500 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
30501 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
30502 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
30503 the retry clock is reset.
30505 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
30506 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
30507 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
30508 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
30509 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
30510 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
30511 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
30512 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
30513 recipient's retry time.
30516 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
30517 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
30518 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
30519 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
30520 until the next delivery attempt.
30522 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
30523 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
30524 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
30525 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
30526 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
30529 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
30530 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
30531 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
30532 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
30533 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
30534 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
30535 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
30537 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
30538 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
30539 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
30540 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
30541 then to be treated as a host error.
30543 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
30544 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
30545 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
30546 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
30547 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
30552 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
30553 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
30554 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
30557 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
30558 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
30559 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
30561 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
30563 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
30564 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
30565 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
30566 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
30567 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
30568 stream and exits with an error code.
30570 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
30571 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
30572 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
30573 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
30575 .cindex "carriage return"
30577 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
30578 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
30579 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
30581 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
30582 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
30583 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
30585 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
30586 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
30587 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
30588 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
30589 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
30590 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
30591 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
30592 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
30594 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
30595 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
30596 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
30597 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
30598 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
30599 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
30600 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
30601 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
30602 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
30604 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
30605 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
30606 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
30608 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
30609 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
30610 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
30611 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
30612 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
30614 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
30615 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
30616 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
30617 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
30618 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
30619 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
30620 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
30622 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
30623 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
30624 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
30625 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
30626 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
30628 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
30629 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
30630 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
30631 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
30632 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
30633 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
30634 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
30635 a delivery process.
30637 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
30638 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
30639 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
30640 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
30641 however, available with &'inetd'&.
30643 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
30644 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
30645 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
30646 section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&.
30648 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
30649 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
30650 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
30654 .section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
30655 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
30656 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
30657 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
30658 the error response to the last command. The default value for
30659 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
30660 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
30661 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
30664 .section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
30665 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
30666 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
30667 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
30668 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
30669 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
30670 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
30671 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
30672 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
30673 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
30674 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
30678 .section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
30679 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
30680 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
30681 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
30682 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
30683 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
30684 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
30685 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
30687 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
30688 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
30689 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
30690 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
30691 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
30694 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
30695 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
30696 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
30698 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
30699 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
30700 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
30701 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
30702 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
30707 .section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
30708 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
30709 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
30710 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
30711 If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
30713 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
30714 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
30715 called with the &%-bv%& option.
30717 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
30718 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
30719 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
30720 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
30721 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
30722 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
30723 VRFY verification failures are logged on the main log for consistency with
30728 .section "The ETRN command" "SECTETRN"
30729 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
30730 RFC 1985 describes an SMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
30731 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
30732 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
30733 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
30734 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
30736 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
30737 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
30738 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
30739 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
30740 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
30741 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
30742 argument. For example,
30750 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
30751 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
30752 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
30753 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
30754 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
30756 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
30757 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
30758 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
30759 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
30760 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
30761 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
30762 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
30763 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
30765 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
30766 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
30767 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
30768 whatever the form of its argument. For
30771 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
30772 $sender_host_address
30774 .vindex "&$domain$&"
30775 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
30776 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
30777 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
30778 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
30779 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
30780 for it to change them before running the command.
30784 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
30785 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
30786 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
30787 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
30788 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
30789 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
30790 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
30791 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
30792 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
30793 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
30794 runs for RCPT commands:
30798 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
30802 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
30803 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
30804 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
30805 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
30806 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
30807 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
30808 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
30809 envelope along with the message.
30811 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
30812 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
30813 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
30814 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
30815 can be used to specify it.
30817 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
30818 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
30819 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
30820 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
30821 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
30824 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
30825 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
30826 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
30831 driver = manualroute
30832 transport = smtp_appendfile
30833 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
30837 driver = appendfile
30838 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
30843 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
30844 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
30845 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
30849 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
30850 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
30851 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
30852 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
30853 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
30854 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
30855 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
30856 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
30857 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
30858 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
30860 No policy checking is done for BSMTP input. That is, no ACL is run at anytime.
30861 In this respect it is like non-SMTP local input.
30863 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
30864 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
30865 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
30866 make some use of automatically, for example:
30868 554 Unexpected end of file
30869 Transaction started in line 10
30870 Error detected in line 14
30872 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
30875 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
30876 The error message was:
30878 501 '>' missing at end of address
30880 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
30881 The error was detected in line 12.
30882 The SMTP command at fault was:
30884 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
30886 1 previous message was successfully processed.
30887 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
30889 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
30890 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
30892 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
30893 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
30897 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30898 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30900 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
30901 "Customizing messages"
30902 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains on the queue for more than a
30903 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
30904 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
30905 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
30906 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
30908 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
30909 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
30910 option. Exim also adds the line
30912 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
30914 to all warning and bounce messages,
30917 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
30918 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
30919 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
30920 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
30921 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
30922 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
30923 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
30925 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
30926 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
30927 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
30928 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
30929 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
30932 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
30933 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
30934 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
30935 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
30936 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
30937 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
30938 option, rounded to a whole number.
30940 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
30943 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
30944 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
30946 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
30947 failing addresses with their error messages.
30949 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
30950 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
30952 The fourth item is used to introduce the copy of the message that is returned
30953 as part of the error report.
30955 The fifth item is added after the fourth one if the returned message is
30956 truncated because it is bigger than &%return_size_limit%&.
30958 The sixth item is added after the copy of the original message.
30961 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
30962 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
30963 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
30965 Subject: Mail delivery failed
30966 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
30967 {: returning message to sender}}
30969 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
30971 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
30972 {that you sent }{sent by
30976 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
30977 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
30979 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
30981 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
30984 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
30986 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
30989 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
30990 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
30991 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
30992 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
30993 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
30997 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
30998 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
31000 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
31001 the delayed addresses.
31003 The third item then ends the message.
31006 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
31007 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
31009 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
31010 $warn_message_delay
31012 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
31014 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
31015 {that you sent }{sent by
31019 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
31020 more than $warn_message_delay on the queue on $primary_hostname.
31022 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
31023 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
31024 The date of the message is: $h_date
31026 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
31028 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
31029 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
31030 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
31031 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
31032 the message will be returned to you.
31034 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
31035 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
31036 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
31037 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
31038 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
31039 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
31040 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
31041 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
31047 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31048 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31050 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
31051 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
31052 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
31056 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
31057 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
31058 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
31059 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
31060 routing explicitly:
31062 send_to_smart_host:
31063 driver = manualroute
31064 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
31065 transport = remote_smtp
31067 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
31068 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
31069 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
31070 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
31071 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
31076 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
31077 .cindex "mailing lists"
31078 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
31079 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
31080 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
31082 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
31083 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
31084 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
31085 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
31089 domains = lists.example
31090 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
31093 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
31096 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
31097 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
31098 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
31099 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
31101 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
31102 expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
31105 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
31106 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
31107 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
31108 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
31109 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
31111 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
31112 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
31113 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
31114 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
31115 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
31116 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
31117 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
31118 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
31119 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
31123 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
31124 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
31125 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
31126 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
31127 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
31128 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
31129 addresses are not rigorously checked.
31131 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
31132 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
31133 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
31134 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
31135 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
31139 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
31140 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
31141 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
31142 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
31143 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
31144 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
31145 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
31146 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
31147 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
31148 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
31150 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
31151 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
31152 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
31153 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
31154 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
31155 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
31156 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
31157 pre-existing messages.
31159 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
31160 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
31161 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
31162 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
31163 one level of expansion anyway.
31167 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
31168 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
31169 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
31170 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
31171 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
31172 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
31174 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
31175 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
31179 domains = lists.example
31180 local_part_suffix = -request
31181 file = /usr/lists/$local_part$local_part_suffix
31186 domains = lists.example
31187 senders = ${if exists {/usr/lists/$local_part}\
31188 {lsearch;/usr/lists/$local_part}{*}}
31189 file = /usr/lists/$local_part
31192 errors_to = $local_part-request@lists.example
31197 domains = lists.example
31199 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
31201 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
31202 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
31203 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
31206 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
31207 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
31208 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
31209 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
31210 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
31211 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
31212 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
31213 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
31214 &"unrouteable address"& error.
31216 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
31217 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
31218 the address, giving a suitable error message.
31223 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
31225 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
31226 .cindex "envelope sender"
31227 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(http://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
31228 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
31229 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
31230 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
31231 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
31232 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
31234 .oindex &%errors_to%&
31235 .oindex &%return_path%&
31236 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
31237 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
31238 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
31239 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
31240 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
31241 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
31242 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
31248 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
31249 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
31251 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
31252 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
31253 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
31254 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
31255 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
31256 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
31257 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
31260 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
31262 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
31263 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
31264 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
31265 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
31266 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
31267 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
31269 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
31270 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
31271 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
31272 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
31276 domains = ! +local_domains
31278 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
31279 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
31282 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
31283 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
31284 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
31285 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
31288 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
31289 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
31290 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
31291 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
31292 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
31296 domains = ! +local_domains
31297 transport = remote_smtp
31299 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
31300 {$1-request+$local_part=$domain@your.dom.example}fail}
31303 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
31304 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
31305 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
31306 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
31309 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
31310 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
31311 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
31312 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
31313 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
31314 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
31322 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
31323 .cindex "virtual domains"
31324 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
31325 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
31329 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
31330 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
31331 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
31333 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
31334 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
31335 have login accounts on that host.
31338 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
31339 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
31340 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
31341 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
31342 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
31343 to a router of this form:
31347 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
31348 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain}}
31351 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
31352 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
31353 domain that is being processed. When the router runs, it looks up the local
31354 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
31355 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
31356 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
31358 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias file names
31359 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
31360 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
31361 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
31363 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
31364 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
31365 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
31369 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
31370 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
31371 transport = my_mailboxes
31373 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
31374 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
31375 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
31376 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
31377 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
31381 driver = appendfile
31382 file = /var/mail/$domain/$local_part
31385 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
31386 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
31388 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
31389 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
31390 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
31391 information about the domains.
31395 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
31396 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
31397 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
31398 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
31399 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
31400 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
31401 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
31402 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
31403 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
31404 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
31405 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
31406 example, consider this router:
31411 file = $home/.forward
31412 local_part_suffix = -*
31413 local_part_suffix_optional
31416 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
31417 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
31418 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
31419 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
31421 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
31422 save /home/$local_part/Mail/special
31425 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
31426 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
31427 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
31428 control over which suffixes are valid.
31430 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
31431 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
31437 file = $home/.forward$local_part_suffix
31438 local_part_suffix = -*
31439 local_part_suffix_optional
31442 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
31443 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
31444 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
31445 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
31446 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
31450 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
31451 .cindex "vacation processing"
31452 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
31453 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
31454 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
31455 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
31456 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
31459 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
31460 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
31461 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
31462 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
31464 spqr, vacation-spqr
31467 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
31468 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
31469 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
31470 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
31471 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
31475 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
31476 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
31480 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
31481 .cindex "message" "copying every"
31482 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
31483 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
31484 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
31485 each day's messages.
31487 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
31488 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
31489 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
31490 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
31494 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
31495 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
31496 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
31497 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
31498 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
31499 permanently connected.
31501 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
31502 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
31503 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
31506 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
31507 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
31508 host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
31509 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
31510 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
31511 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
31512 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
31513 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
31515 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
31516 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
31517 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
31518 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
31519 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
31520 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
31523 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
31524 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
31525 intermittent host. For example:
31527 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
31529 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
31530 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
31531 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
31532 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
31533 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
31534 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
31537 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
31538 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
31539 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
31540 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
31541 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
31542 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
31543 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
31547 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
31548 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
31549 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
31550 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
31551 delivered immediately.
31553 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
31554 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
31555 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
31556 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
31557 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
31558 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
31559 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
31560 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
31561 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
31562 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
31563 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
31564 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
31565 single SMTP connection.
31569 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31570 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31572 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
31573 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
31574 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
31575 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
31576 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
31577 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
31578 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
31579 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
31580 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
31581 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
31584 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
31585 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
31586 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
31587 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
31588 email is not desirable.
31590 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
31591 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
31592 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
31593 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
31594 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
31595 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
31596 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
31598 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
31599 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
31600 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
31601 before sending a message to the smart host.
31603 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
31604 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
31605 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
31607 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
31608 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
31609 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
31610 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
31611 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
31612 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
31613 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
31615 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
31619 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
31620 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
31622 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
31623 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
31624 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
31625 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
31626 successful, a zero return code is given.
31628 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
31629 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
31630 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
31631 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
31632 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
31635 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
31636 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
31637 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
31639 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
31640 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
31641 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
31642 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
31643 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
31645 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
31646 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
31647 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
31649 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
31650 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
31651 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
31652 are ever generated.
31654 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
31656 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
31657 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
31658 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
31661 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
31662 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
31663 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
31664 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
31665 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
31666 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
31671 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31672 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
31674 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
31675 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
31676 .cindex "log" "types of"
31677 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
31682 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
31683 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
31684 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
31685 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
31686 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
31687 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
31688 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
31689 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
31691 .cindex "reject log"
31692 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
31693 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
31694 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
31695 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
31696 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
31697 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
31698 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
31699 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
31700 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
31703 .cindex "panic log"
31704 .cindex "system log"
31705 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
31706 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
31707 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
31708 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
31709 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
31710 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
31711 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
31712 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
31713 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
31716 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
31717 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
31718 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
31720 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
31723 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
31724 ways of changing this:
31727 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
31732 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
31734 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
31737 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
31741 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
31742 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
31743 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
31744 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
31745 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
31746 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
31751 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
31752 .cindex "log" "destination"
31753 .cindex "log" "to file"
31754 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
31756 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
31757 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
31758 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
31759 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
31760 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
31761 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
31762 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
31764 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
31765 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the run time
31766 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
31767 references to the host name:
31769 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
31771 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
31772 rather than at run time, because then the setting is available right from the
31773 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
31774 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
31775 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
31778 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
31779 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
31780 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
31781 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
31782 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
31783 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
31784 implying the use of a default path.
31786 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
31787 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
31788 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
31789 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. It no such item exists, log
31790 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
31791 equivalent to the setting:
31793 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
31795 If you do not specify anything at build time or run time, that is where the
31798 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& if datestamped log file names are in
31799 use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
31801 Here are some examples of possible settings:
31803 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
31804 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
31805 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
31806 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
31808 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
31813 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
31814 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
31815 .cindex "cycling logs"
31816 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
31817 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
31818 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
31819 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
31820 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
31821 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
31822 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
31824 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
31825 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
31826 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
31827 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
31828 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
31829 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
31830 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
31831 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
31832 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
31833 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
31834 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
31839 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
31840 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
31841 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
31842 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
31843 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_&.
31844 Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting the
31845 &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& at the point where the
31846 datestamp is required. For example:
31848 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
31849 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
31850 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
31852 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
31853 examples of names generated by the above examples:
31855 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
31856 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
31857 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
31859 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
31860 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
31861 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
31862 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
31864 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
31865 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
31866 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& is removed from the string.
31867 In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following non-alphanumeric
31868 character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric character is
31869 removed. Thus, the three examples above would give these panic log names:
31871 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
31872 /var/log/exim-panic.log
31873 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
31877 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
31878 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
31879 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
31880 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
31881 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
31882 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
31883 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
31884 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
31885 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
31886 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
31887 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
31888 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
31889 the time and host name to each line.
31890 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
31893 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
31895 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
31897 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
31900 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
31901 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
31902 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
31903 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
31905 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
31906 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
31907 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
31908 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
31909 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
31910 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
31911 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
31912 RFC 3164, you should set
31914 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
31916 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
31917 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
31919 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
31920 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
31921 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
31922 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
31923 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
31924 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
31925 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
31926 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
31927 name, and pid as added by syslog:
31929 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
31930 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
31931 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
31932 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
31935 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
31938 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
31939 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
31940 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
31941 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
31943 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
31944 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
31945 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
31946 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
31947 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
31948 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
31950 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
31951 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
31952 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
31955 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
31957 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
31958 without modification.
31960 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
31961 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
31962 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
31967 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
31968 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
31969 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
31970 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
31971 timestamp. The flags are:
31973 &`<=`& message arrival
31974 &`=>`& normal message delivery
31975 &`->`& additional address in same delivery
31976 &`*>`& delivery suppressed by &%-N%&
31977 &`**`& delivery failed; address bounced
31978 &`==`& delivery deferred; temporary problem
31982 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
31983 .cindex "log" "reception line"
31984 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
31985 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
31986 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
31988 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
31989 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
31990 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
31992 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
31993 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
31994 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
31998 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
32002 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
32003 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
32004 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
32005 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
32006 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
32007 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
32008 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
32009 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
32010 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
32011 name in parentheses.
32013 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
32014 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
32015 the log containing text like these examples:
32017 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
32018 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
32020 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
32023 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
32024 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
32027 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
32028 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
32029 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
32030 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
32031 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
32032 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
32033 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
32034 suite that was used.
32036 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
32037 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
32038 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
32039 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
32040 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
32041 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
32042 authenticator name.
32044 .cindex "size" "of message"
32045 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
32046 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
32047 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
32048 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
32051 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
32052 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
32056 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
32057 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
32058 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
32059 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
32060 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into two lines in order
32061 to fit it on the page:
32063 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
32064 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
32065 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
32066 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
32067 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
32069 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
32070 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
32071 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
32072 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
32073 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
32075 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
32076 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
32078 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
32080 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
32081 parentheses afterwards.
32083 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
32084 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
32085 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
32086 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
32087 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the IP address in the log
32088 lines for the second and subsequent messages.
32090 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
32091 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
32093 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
32094 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
32097 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
32098 .cindex "discarded messages"
32099 .cindex "message" "discarded"
32100 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
32101 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
32102 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
32104 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
32105 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
32107 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
32108 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
32110 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
32111 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
32115 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
32116 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
32118 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
32119 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
32121 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
32122 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
32123 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
32125 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
32126 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
32128 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
32129 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
32130 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
32134 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
32135 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
32136 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
32137 following form is logged:
32139 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
32140 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
32142 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
32143 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
32145 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
32146 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
32147 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
32148 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
32149 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
32151 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
32152 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
32153 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
32154 flagged with &`**`&.
32158 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
32159 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
32160 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
32161 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
32162 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
32166 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
32169 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
32171 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
32172 at the end of its processing.
32177 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
32178 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
32179 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
32180 the following table:
32182 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id)
32183 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
32184 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
32185 &`CV `& certificate verification status
32186 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
32187 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
32188 &`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
32189 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
32190 &`H `& host name and IP address
32191 &`I `& local interface used
32192 &`id `& message id for incoming message
32193 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
32194 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
32195 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
32196 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
32197 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
32198 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
32199 &`S `& size of message
32200 &`ST `& shadow transport name
32201 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
32202 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
32203 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
32204 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
32208 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
32209 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
32210 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
32213 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
32214 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
32215 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
32216 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
32217 during the first delivery attempt.
32219 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
32220 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
32221 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
32223 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
32224 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
32225 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
32226 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
32227 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
32230 .cindex "error" "ignored"
32231 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
32234 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
32235 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
32237 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
32238 failed. The delivery was discarded.
32240 A delivery set up by a router configured with
32241 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
32242 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
32246 failed. The delivery was discarded.
32254 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
32255 .cindex "log" "selectors"
32256 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
32257 default logging, or you can request additional logging. The value of
32258 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
32261 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
32263 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
32264 selection marked by asterisks:
32266 &`*acl_warn_skipped `& skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL
32267 &` address_rewrite `& address rewriting
32268 &` all_parents `& all parents in => lines
32269 &` arguments `& command line arguments
32270 &`*connection_reject `& connection rejections
32271 &`*delay_delivery `& immediate delivery delayed
32272 &` deliver_time `& time taken to perform delivery
32273 &` delivery_size `& add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines
32274 &`*dnslist_defer `& defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups
32275 &`*etrn `& ETRN commands
32276 &`*host_lookup_failed `& as it says
32277 &` ident_timeout `& timeout for ident connection
32278 &` incoming_interface `& incoming interface on <= lines
32279 &` incoming_port `& incoming port on <= lines
32280 &`*lost_incoming_connection `& as it says (includes timeouts)
32281 &` outgoing_port `& add remote port to => lines
32282 &`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
32283 &` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
32284 &` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
32285 &` pid `& Exim process id
32286 &` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
32287 &` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
32288 &`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
32289 &`*retry_defer `& &"retry time not reached"&
32290 &` return_path_on_delivery `& put return path on => and ** lines
32291 &` sender_on_delivery `& add sender to => lines
32292 &`*sender_verify_fail `& sender verification failures
32293 &`*size_reject `& rejection because too big
32294 &`*skip_delivery `& delivery skipped in a queue run
32295 &` smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
32296 &` smtp_connection `& SMTP connections
32297 &` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
32298 &` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
32299 &` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
32300 &` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
32301 &` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
32302 &` tls_certificate_verified `& certificate verification status
32303 &`*tls_cipher `& TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines
32304 &` tls_peerdn `& TLS peer DN on <= and => lines
32305 &` unknown_in_list `& DNS lookup failed in list match
32307 &` all `& all of the above
32309 More details on each of these items follows:
32312 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
32313 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
32314 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
32315 this log selector is set.
32317 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
32318 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
32319 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
32320 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
32321 such users cannot access the log).
32323 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
32324 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
32325 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
32326 parentheses between them.
32328 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
32329 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
32330 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
32331 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
32332 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
32333 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
32334 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
32335 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
32336 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
32337 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
32338 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
32339 between the caller and Exim.
32341 .cindex "log" "connection rejections"
32342 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
32343 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
32345 .cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
32346 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
32347 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
32348 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
32349 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
32350 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
32352 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
32353 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
32354 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
32356 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
32357 .cindex "size" "of message"
32358 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
32359 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
32361 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
32362 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
32363 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
32364 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
32365 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
32367 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
32368 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
32369 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
32370 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
32371 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
32372 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
32374 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
32375 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
32376 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
32377 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
32378 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
32380 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
32381 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
32382 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
32383 client's ident port times out.
32385 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
32386 .cindex "interface" "logging"
32387 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
32388 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
32389 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
32390 added to other SMTP log lines, for example &"SMTP connection from"&, and to
32393 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
32394 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
32395 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
32396 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
32397 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
32398 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
32399 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
32400 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
32401 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
32402 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
32403 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
32405 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
32406 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
32407 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
32409 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
32410 .cindex "port" "logging outgoint remote"
32411 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging ougtoing remote port"
32412 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
32413 containing => tags) following the IP address. This option is not included in
32414 the default setting, because for most ordinary configurations, the remote port
32415 number is always 25 (the SMTP port).
32417 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
32418 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
32419 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
32420 immediately after the time and date.
32422 .cindex "log" "queue run"
32423 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
32424 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
32426 .cindex "log" "queue time"
32427 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
32428 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
32429 &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the message, so it
32430 includes reception time as well as the delivery time for the current address.
32431 This means that it may be longer than the difference between the arrival and
32432 delivery log line times, because the arrival log line is not written until the
32433 message has been successfully received.
32435 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
32436 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
32437 example, &`QT=3m45s`&. The clock starts when Exim starts to receive the
32438 message, so it includes reception time as well as the total delivery time.
32440 .cindex "log" "recipients"
32441 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
32442 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
32443 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
32444 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
32446 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
32449 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
32450 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
32451 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
32452 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
32454 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
32455 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
32456 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
32457 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
32458 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
32460 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
32461 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
32462 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
32463 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
32466 .cindex "log" "return path"
32467 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
32468 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
32469 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
32470 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
32472 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
32473 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
32474 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
32475 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
32476 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
32478 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
32479 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
32480 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
32481 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
32484 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
32485 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
32488 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
32489 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
32490 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
32491 queue run because it is frozen or because another process is already delivering
32493 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
32494 The message that is written is &"spool file is locked"&.
32496 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
32497 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
32498 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP dialogue for
32499 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
32500 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
32503 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
32504 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
32505 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an SMTP connection is
32506 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
32507 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
32508 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
32509 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
32510 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
32511 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
32512 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
32514 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
32515 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
32516 reset if the daemon is restarted.
32517 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
32518 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
32519 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
32520 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
32521 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
32523 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
32524 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
32525 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
32526 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
32527 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
32528 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
32530 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
32531 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
32532 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
32533 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
32534 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
32535 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
32536 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
32537 already have their own log lines.
32539 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
32540 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
32541 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
32542 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
32543 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
32544 the same logging options.
32546 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
32547 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
32551 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
32552 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
32553 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
32554 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accep_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
32555 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
32557 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
32558 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
32559 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
32560 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
32561 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
32562 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
32563 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
32564 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
32566 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
32567 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
32568 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
32569 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
32570 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
32571 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
32572 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
32573 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
32574 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
32576 .cindex "log" "subject"
32577 .cindex "subject, logging"
32578 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
32579 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
32580 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
32581 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
32582 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
32584 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
32585 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
32586 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
32587 verified, and &`CV=no`& if not.
32589 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
32590 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
32591 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
32592 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
32594 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
32595 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
32596 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
32597 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
32598 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
32600 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
32601 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
32602 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed.
32606 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
32607 .cindex "message" "log file for"
32608 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
32609 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
32610 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
32611 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
32612 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
32613 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
32614 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
32615 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
32616 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
32617 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
32618 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
32620 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
32621 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
32622 &%message_logs%& option false.
32628 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32629 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
32631 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
32632 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
32633 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
32634 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
32635 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
32637 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
32638 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
32639 "list what Exim processes are doing"
32640 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
32641 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
32642 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
32643 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
32645 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
32646 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
32647 "extract statistics from the log"
32648 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
32649 "check address acceptance from given IP"
32650 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
32651 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
32652 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
32653 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
32654 .irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
32655 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
32658 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
32659 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
32660 &url(http://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
32665 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
32666 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
32667 .cindex "process, querying"
32669 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
32670 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
32671 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
32672 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
32673 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
32674 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
32675 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
32676 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
32678 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
32679 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
32680 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
32683 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
32684 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
32685 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
32686 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
32687 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
32690 &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD `& the command for running &'ps'&
32691 &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG `& the argument for &'ps'&
32692 &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG `& the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output
32693 &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG `& the argument for the &'kill'& command
32695 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
32697 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
32698 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
32699 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
32700 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
32701 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
32702 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
32704 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
32705 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
32709 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
32710 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
32711 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
32712 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
32716 to obtain a queue listing with undelivered recipients only, and then greps the
32717 output to select messages that match given criteria. The following selection
32718 options are available:
32721 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
32722 Match the sender address. The field that is tested is enclosed in angle
32723 brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
32727 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
32728 Match a recipient address. The field that is tested is not enclosed in angle
32731 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
32732 Match against the size field.
32734 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
32735 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
32737 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
32738 Match messages that are older than the given time.
32741 Match only frozen messages.
32744 Match only non-frozen messages.
32747 The following options control the format of the output:
32751 Display only the count of matching messages.
32754 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
32758 Display message ids only.
32761 Brief format &-- one line per message.
32764 Display messages in reverse order.
32767 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
32771 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
32772 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
32773 .cindex "queue" "summary"
32774 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
32775 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages on the queue. Thus, you use it by
32776 running a command such as
32778 exim -bp | exiqsumm
32780 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
32781 it, as in the following example:
32783 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
32785 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
32786 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
32787 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
32788 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
32790 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
32791 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
32792 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
32793 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
32794 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
32795 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
32798 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
32799 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
32800 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
32801 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
32802 level"& addresses).
32807 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
32809 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
32810 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
32811 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
32812 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
32813 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
32814 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
32815 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
32816 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
32817 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
32818 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
32820 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
32822 If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
32824 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
32825 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
32826 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
32828 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
32829 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
32830 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
32831 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
32832 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
32834 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
32835 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
32836 regular expression.
32838 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
32839 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
32841 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
32842 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
32843 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
32846 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
32847 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
32848 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
32849 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
32850 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, visit the web page at
32851 &url(http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/ToolExipickManPage) or run &'exipick'& with
32852 the &%--help%& option.
32855 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
32856 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
32857 .cindex "cycling logs"
32858 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
32859 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
32860 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
32861 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
32862 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
32863 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
32864 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
32866 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
32867 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
32869 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
32870 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
32871 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
32875 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the file names get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
32876 the main log file name is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
32877 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
32878 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
32879 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
32880 logs are handled similarly.
32882 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
32883 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
32884 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
32885 any existing log files.
32887 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
32888 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
32889 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
32890 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
32891 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
32893 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
32895 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
32896 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
32900 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
32901 .cindex "statistics"
32902 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
32903 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
32904 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
32905 Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
32906 LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
32908 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
32909 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
32910 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
32911 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
32912 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
32914 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
32916 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
32917 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
32918 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
32919 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
32920 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
32921 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
32922 also produced per user.
32924 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
32925 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
32926 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
32927 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
32928 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
32930 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
32931 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
32932 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
32933 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
32934 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
32935 an entirely separate message.
32937 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
32938 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
32939 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
32940 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
32941 least one address that failed.
32943 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
32944 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
32945 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
32946 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent on the queue,
32947 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
32948 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
32949 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
32951 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
32952 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
32953 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
32955 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
32956 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
32957 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
32959 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
32962 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
32963 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
32964 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
32965 .cindex "checking access"
32966 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
32967 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
32968 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
32969 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
32970 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
32971 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
32973 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
32974 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
32976 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
32978 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
32979 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
32980 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
32981 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
32984 550 Relay not permitted
32986 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
32987 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
32988 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
32989 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
32992 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
32993 -f himself@there.example
32995 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
32996 mandatory arguments.
32998 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
32999 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
33000 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
33004 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
33005 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
33006 .cindex "building DBM files"
33007 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
33008 .cindex "lower casing"
33009 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
33010 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
33011 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
33012 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
33013 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
33014 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
33016 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
33017 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
33018 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
33019 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
33022 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
33023 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
33024 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
33028 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
33029 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two file
33030 names must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions create
33031 a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
33033 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
33035 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
33036 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
33038 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
33039 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
33040 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
33041 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
33042 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
33043 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the file name.
33045 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
33046 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
33047 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
33048 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
33049 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
33050 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
33051 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
33057 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
33058 .cindex "retry" "times"
33059 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
33060 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
33061 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
33062 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
33063 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
33064 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
33065 output. For example:
33067 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
33068 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
33069 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
33070 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
33071 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
33072 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
33073 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
33074 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
33075 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
33076 past final cutoff time
33078 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
33079 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
33080 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
33081 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
33082 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
33083 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
33086 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
33087 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
33088 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
33089 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
33090 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
33091 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
33095 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
33096 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
33097 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
33098 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
33099 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
33100 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
33101 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
33104 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
33106 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
33109 &'callout'&: the callout cache
33111 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
33113 &'misc'&: other hints data
33116 The &'misc'& database is used for
33119 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
33121 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
33122 &(smtp)& transport)
33127 .section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
33128 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
33129 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
33130 &'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
33131 spool and database names. For example, to dump the retry database:
33133 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
33135 Two lines of output are produced for each entry:
33137 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
33138 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
33140 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
33141 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
33142 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
33143 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
33144 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
33145 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
33146 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
33147 and a textual description of the error.
33149 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
33150 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
33151 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
33154 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
33155 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
33156 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
33157 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
33158 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
33159 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
33164 .section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
33165 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
33166 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
33167 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
33168 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
33169 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
33170 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
33171 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
33172 updated sufficiently often.
33174 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
33175 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
33176 the retry database:
33178 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
33180 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
33181 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
33182 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
33183 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
33184 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
33185 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
33186 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
33187 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
33188 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
33189 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
33190 whenever it removes information from the database.
33192 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
33193 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
33194 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
33195 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
33196 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
33198 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
33199 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
33200 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
33201 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
33202 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
33203 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
33204 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
33207 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
33208 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
33213 .section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
33214 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
33215 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
33216 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
33217 getting round problems in a live system. It has no options, and its interface
33218 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
33219 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
33222 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
33223 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
33224 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
33225 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
33226 by new data, for example:
33230 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
33231 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
33232 used as optional separators.
33237 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
33238 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
33239 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
33240 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
33241 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
33242 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
33243 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
33244 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
33245 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
33246 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
33247 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
33248 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
33249 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
33253 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
33256 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
33259 .vitem &%-interval%&
33260 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
33261 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
33263 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
33264 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
33267 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
33270 Suppress verification output.
33272 .vitem &%-retries%&
33273 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
33274 the lock (default 10).
33276 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
33277 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
33278 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
33279 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
33282 .vitem &%-timeout%&
33283 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
33284 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
33285 default), a non-blocking call is used.
33288 Generate verbose output.
33291 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
33292 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
33293 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
33294 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
33295 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
33296 file does not last for ever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
33297 more than 30 minutes old.
33299 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
33300 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
33301 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
33302 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
33303 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
33304 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
33306 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
33307 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
33308 suppresses all output except error messages.
33312 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
33314 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
33316 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
33317 <&'some commands'&>
33320 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
33321 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
33324 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
33325 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
33327 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
33328 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
33332 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33333 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33335 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
33336 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
33337 .cindex "X-windows"
33338 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
33339 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
33340 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
33341 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
33342 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
33343 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
33344 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
33345 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
33349 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
33350 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
33351 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
33352 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
33353 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
33354 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
33355 parameters are for.
33357 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
33358 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
33359 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
33361 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
33363 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
33364 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
33365 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
33366 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
33367 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
33369 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
33370 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
33372 Eximon*background: gray94
33374 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
33375 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
33376 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
33377 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
33378 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
33379 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
33380 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
33383 Eximon*highlight: gray
33386 .cindex "admin user"
33387 In order to see the contents of messages on the queue, and to operate on them,
33388 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
33390 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
33391 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
33392 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
33393 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
33394 different parts of the display.
33399 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
33400 .cindex "stripchart"
33401 The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
33402 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
33403 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
33404 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
33405 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
33406 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
33407 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
33408 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
33409 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
33411 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
33412 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
33413 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
33414 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
33416 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
33417 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
33418 to a single partition.
33420 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
33421 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
33422 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
33423 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
33424 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
33425 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
33426 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
33431 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
33432 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
33433 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
33434 .cindex "window size"
33435 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
33436 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
33437 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
33438 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
33439 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
33440 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
33442 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
33443 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
33444 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
33445 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
33447 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
33448 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
33449 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
33450 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
33451 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
33452 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
33454 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
33455 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
33456 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
33460 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
33461 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
33462 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
33463 the main log is maintained.
33464 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
33465 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
33466 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
33467 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
33468 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
33470 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
33471 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
33472 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
33473 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
33474 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
33475 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
33476 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
33477 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
33478 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
33479 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
33480 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
33482 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
33483 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
33484 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
33485 It cannot go further back up the log.
33487 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
33488 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
33489 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
33490 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
33491 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
33492 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
33494 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
33495 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
33496 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
33497 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
33498 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
33499 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
33501 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
33502 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
33503 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
33504 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
33505 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
33506 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
33507 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
33508 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
33509 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
33514 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
33515 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
33516 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
33517 are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
33518 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
33519 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
33520 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
33521 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
33522 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
33523 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
33525 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
33526 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages on the queue. To help
33527 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
33528 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
33529 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
33530 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
33531 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
33533 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
33534 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
33535 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
33536 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
33537 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
33538 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
33539 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
33541 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
33542 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
33543 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
33544 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
33546 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
33547 time it has been on the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
33548 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
33549 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
33550 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
33551 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
33552 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
33555 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
33556 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
33558 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
33559 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
33560 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
33561 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
33562 display is updated.
33566 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
33567 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
33568 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
33569 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
33570 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
33573 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
33574 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
33575 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
33576 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
33577 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
33579 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
33581 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
33585 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
33586 in a new text window.
33588 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
33589 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
33590 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
33592 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
33593 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
33594 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
33595 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at run time.
33597 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
33598 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
33599 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
33600 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
33601 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
33603 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
33604 that the message be frozen.
33606 .cindex "thawing messages"
33607 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
33608 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
33609 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
33610 that the message be thawed.
33612 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
33613 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
33614 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
33615 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
33617 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
33618 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
33621 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
33622 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
33623 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
33624 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
33625 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
33626 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
33627 which case no action is taken.
33629 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
33630 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
33631 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
33632 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
33633 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
33634 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
33635 case no action is taken.
33637 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
33638 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
33640 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
33641 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
33642 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
33643 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
33644 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
33645 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
33646 the address is qualified with that domain.
33649 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
33650 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
33651 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
33652 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
33653 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
33654 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
33655 if no output is generated.
33657 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
33658 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
33659 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
33660 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
33662 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
33663 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
33664 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
33671 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33672 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
33674 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
33675 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
33676 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
33677 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
33679 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
33680 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
33681 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
33682 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
33683 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
33684 its security as compared with other MTAs.
33686 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
33687 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
33688 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
33689 as soon as possible.
33692 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
33693 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
33694 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
33695 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
33696 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
33697 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
33700 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
33701 start of any file names used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these file
33702 names are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if the
33703 value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
33704 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
33705 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
33707 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
33708 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
33709 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
33710 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
33712 If ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY is defined, root privilege is retained for &%-C%&
33713 and &%-D%& only if the caller of Exim is root. Without it, the Exim user may
33714 also use &%-C%& and &%-D%& and retain privilege. Setting this option locks out
33715 the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message
33716 reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by
33717 that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain
33718 privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost.
33719 However, root can test reception and delivery using two separate commands.
33720 ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY is not set by default.
33722 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
33725 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
33726 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
33727 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
33728 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
33729 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
33735 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
33737 .cindex "root privilege"
33738 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
33739 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
33740 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
33741 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
33742 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
33743 is required for two things:
33746 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
33747 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
33750 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
33751 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
33755 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
33756 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
33757 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
33758 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
33759 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
33760 group"&. Their values can be changed by the run time configuration, though this
33761 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
33762 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
33764 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
33765 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
33766 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
33768 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
33769 uid and gid in the following cases:
33774 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
33775 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
33776 calling process is not running as root or the Exim user, the uid and gid are
33777 changed to those of the calling process.
33778 However, if ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, only
33779 root callers may use &%-C%& and &%-D%& without losing privilege, and if
33780 DISABLE_D_OPTION is set, the &%-D%& option may not be used at all.
33785 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
33786 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
33789 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
33790 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
33791 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
33792 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
33793 testing address verification
33796 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
33799 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
33800 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
33803 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
33806 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
33807 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
33808 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
33809 will be used during message reception.
33811 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
33812 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
33814 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
33815 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
33816 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
33817 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
33818 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
33819 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
33820 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
33821 generating bounce and warning messages.
33823 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
33824 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
33825 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
33826 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
33828 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
33829 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
33835 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
33836 .cindex "privilege, running without"
33837 .cindex "unprivileged running"
33838 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
33839 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
33840 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
33841 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
33842 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
33843 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
33844 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
33848 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
33849 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
33850 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
33851 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
33853 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
33854 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
33855 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
33856 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
33857 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
33859 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
33860 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
33861 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
33864 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
33865 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
33866 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
33868 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
33869 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
33870 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
33871 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
33872 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
33873 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
33874 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
33875 address this problem at this time.
33877 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
33878 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
33879 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
33880 be used in the most straightforward way.
33882 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
33883 number of restrictions on what you can do:
33886 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
33887 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
33888 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
33889 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
33890 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
33892 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
33893 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
33895 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
33896 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
33897 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
33898 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
33900 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
33901 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
33904 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
33905 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
33906 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
33908 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
33909 owned by the Exim user.
33911 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
33912 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
33913 mailboxes need to be created manually.
33918 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
33919 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
33920 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
33921 gives more security at essentially no cost.
33923 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
33924 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
33929 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
33930 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
33931 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
33935 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
33936 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
33937 .cindex "IP source routing"
33938 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
33939 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
33940 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
33941 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
33945 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
33946 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
33947 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
33952 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
33953 .cindex "trusted users"
33954 .cindex "admin user"
33955 .cindex "privileged user"
33956 .cindex "user" "trusted"
33957 .cindex "user" "admin"
33958 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
33959 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
33960 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
33961 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
33962 permit a remote host to be specified.
33965 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
33966 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
33967 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
33968 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
33969 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
33970 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
33972 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
33973 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
33974 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
33975 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
33976 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
33978 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
33979 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
33980 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
33981 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
33982 includes the contents of files on the spool.
33986 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
33987 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
33988 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
33989 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
33990 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
33991 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
33993 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
33994 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
33995 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
33996 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
33997 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
33998 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
34003 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
34004 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
34005 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
34006 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
34007 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
34008 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
34012 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
34013 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
34014 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
34015 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
34016 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
34021 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
34022 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
34023 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
34024 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
34029 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
34030 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
34031 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
34032 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
34033 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
34037 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
34038 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
34039 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
34040 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
34041 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
34042 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
34043 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
34045 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
34046 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
34051 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
34052 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
34053 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
34054 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
34058 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
34059 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
34060 enough to hold the result.
34061 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
34066 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34067 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34069 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
34070 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
34071 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
34072 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
34073 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
34074 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
34075 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
34076 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
34077 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
34078 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
34079 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
34080 themselves are recoverable.
34082 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
34083 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
34084 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
34087 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
34088 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
34089 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
34090 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
34091 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
34093 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
34094 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
34095 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect. At
34096 present, this value is not used by Exim, but there is no guarantee that this
34097 will always be the case.
34099 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
34101 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
34104 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
34106 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
34107 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
34108 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
34109 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
34110 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
34111 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
34112 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
34113 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
34116 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
34117 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
34118 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
34119 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
34120 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
34121 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
34122 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
34123 normally the Exim user.
34125 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
34126 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
34127 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
34128 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
34129 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
34130 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
34131 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
34132 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
34134 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
34135 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
34136 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
34137 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
34139 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen. These can appear in any
34140 order, and are omitted when not relevant:
34143 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
34144 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
34145 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
34146 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
34147 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
34148 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
34149 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
34150 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
34151 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
34154 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
34155 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
34156 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
34157 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
34158 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
34159 character. It may contain internal newlines.
34161 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
34162 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
34163 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
34164 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
34165 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
34166 character. It may contain internal newlines.
34168 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
34169 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
34170 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
34172 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
34173 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
34174 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
34175 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
34176 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
34178 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
34179 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
34180 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
34181 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
34182 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
34184 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
34185 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
34186 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
34188 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
34189 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
34190 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
34192 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
34193 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is always
34196 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
34197 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
34198 present if the number is greater than zero.
34200 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
34201 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
34202 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
34204 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
34205 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
34206 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
34208 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
34209 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
34212 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
34213 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
34214 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
34217 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
34218 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
34219 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
34220 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
34222 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
34223 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
34224 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
34226 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
34227 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
34228 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
34229 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
34230 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
34231 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
34233 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
34234 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
34235 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
34236 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
34237 supplied by the remote host, if any.
34239 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
34240 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
34241 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
34242 generated messages.
34245 The message is from a local sender.
34247 .vitem &%-localerror%&
34248 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
34250 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
34251 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
34252 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
34253 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
34255 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
34256 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
34257 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
34260 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
34261 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
34264 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
34265 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
34266 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
34268 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
34269 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
34270 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
34272 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
34273 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
34274 of &$spam_score_int$&.
34276 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
34277 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
34278 certificate was verified by the server.
34280 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
34281 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
34282 name of the cipher suite that was used.
34284 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
34285 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
34286 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
34290 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
34291 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
34292 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
34293 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
34294 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
34295 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
34296 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
34297 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
34298 addresses are complete.
34300 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
34301 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
34302 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
34303 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
34304 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
34305 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
34307 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
34308 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
34309 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
34311 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
34312 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
34313 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
34314 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
34318 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
34319 darcy@austen.fict.example
34321 alice@wonderland.fict.example
34323 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
34324 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
34325 line is of the following form:
34327 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
34328 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
34330 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
34331 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
34332 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
34333 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
34334 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
34335 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
34336 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
34337 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
34340 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
34341 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
34342 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
34343 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
34344 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
34348 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
34349 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
34350 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
34351 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
34352 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
34353 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
34354 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
34355 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
34356 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
34357 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
34360 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
34361 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
34362 typical set of headers:
34364 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
34365 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
34366 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
34367 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
34368 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
34369 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
34370 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
34371 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
34372 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
34373 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
34374 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
34376 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
34377 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
34378 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
34379 .ecindex IIDforspo1
34380 .ecindex IIDforspo2
34381 .ecindex IIDforspo3
34386 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34387 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34389 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID12" &&&
34390 "Adding drivers or lookups"
34391 .cindex "adding drivers"
34392 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
34393 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
34394 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
34395 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
34398 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
34399 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
34401 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
34403 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
34405 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
34406 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
34407 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
34409 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
34411 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
34414 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
34415 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
34417 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
34418 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
34419 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
34421 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
34424 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
34425 as for other drivers and lookups.
34428 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
34429 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
34430 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
34431 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
34432 searched using a binary chop procedure.
34434 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
34435 the interface that is expected.
34440 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34441 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34443 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34444 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
34445 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
34446 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
34448 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34453 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
34454 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
34458 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
34459 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
34460 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
34463 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34464 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////